Roland Musical Instrument KR7 5 User Guide

/
O w n e r’s Ma n u a l  
Before using this unit, carefully read the sections entitled: “IMPORTANT SAFETY  
INSTRUCTIONS” (p. 2), “USING THE UNIT SAFELY” (p. 3), and “IMPORTANT NOTES” (p.  
5). These sections provide important information concerning the proper operation of the  
unit. Additionally, in order to feel assured that you have gained a good grasp of every  
feature provided by your new unit, Owner’s Manual should be read in its entirety. The  
manual should be saved and kept on hand as a convenient reference  
Copyright © 2002 ROLAND CORPORATION  
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced in any form without  
the written permission of ROLAND CORPORATION.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USIN G THE UN IT SAFELY  
The  
symbol alerts the user to important instructions  
Used for instructions intended to alert  
the user to the risk of death or severe  
injury should the unit be used  
improperly.  
or warnings.The specific meaning of the symbol is  
determined by the design contained within the  
triangle. In the case of the symbol at left, it is used for  
general cautions, warnings, or alerts to danger.  
Used for instructions intended to alert  
the user to the risk of injury or material  
damage should the unit be used  
improperly.  
The  
symbol alerts the user to items that must never  
be carried out (are forbidden). The specific thing that  
must not be done is indicated by the design contained  
within the circle. In the case of the symbol at left, it  
means that the unit must never be disassembled.  
* Material damage refers to damage or  
other adverse effects caused with  
respect to the home and all its  
furnishings, as well to domestic  
animals or pets.  
The symbol alerts the user to things that must be  
carried out. The specific thing that must be done is  
indicated by the design contained within the circle. In  
the case of the symbol at left, it means that the power-  
cord plug must be unplugged from the outlet.  
001  
009  
Before using this unit, make sure to read the  
instructions below, and the Owners Manual.  
Do not excessively twist or bend the power cord,  
nor place heavy objects on it. Doing so can  
damage the cord, producing severed elements and  
short circuits. Damaged cords are fire and shock  
hazards!  
..........................................................................................................  
002a  
Do not open or perform any internal modifica-  
tions on the unit.  
..........................................................................................................  
010  
This unit, either alone or in combination with an  
amplifier and headphones or speakers, may be  
capable of producing sound levels that could  
cause permanent hearing loss. Do not operate for  
a long period of time at a high volume level, or at  
a level that is uncomfortable. If you experience  
any hearing loss or ringing in the ears, you should  
immediately stop using the unit, and consult an  
audiologist.  
..........................................................................................................  
003  
Do not attempt to repair the unit, or replace parts  
within it (except when this manual provides  
specific instructions directing you to do so). Refer  
all servicing to your retailer, the nearest Roland  
Service Center, or an authorized Roland  
distributor, as listed on the “Information” page.  
..........................................................................................................  
004  
..........................................................................................................  
011  
Never use or store the unit in places that are:  
Do not allow any objects (e.g., flammable material,  
coins, pins); or liquids of any kind (water, soft  
drinks, etc.) to penetrate the unit.  
• Subject to temperature extremes (e.g., direct  
sunlight in an enclosed vehicle, near a heating  
duct, on top of heat-generating equipment); or  
are  
• Damp (e.g., baths, washrooms, on wet floors);  
or are  
..........................................................................................................  
013  
In households with small children, an adult  
should provide supervision until the child is  
capable of following all the rules essential for the  
safe operation of the unit.  
Humid; or are  
• Exposed to rain; or are  
• Dusty; or are  
• Subject to high levels of vibration.  
..........................................................................................................  
..........................................................................................................  
014  
Protect the unit from strong impact.  
(Do not drop it!)  
007  
Make sure you always have the unit placed so it is  
level and sure to remain stable. Never place it on  
stands that could wobble, or on inclined surfaces.  
..........................................................................................................  
015  
..........................................................................................................  
008a  
Do not force the units power-supply cord to share  
an outlet with an unreasonable number of other  
devices. Be especially careful when using  
The unit should be connected to a power supply  
only of the type described in the operating instruc-  
tions, or as marked on the unit.  
extension cords—the total power used by all  
devices you have connected to the extension  
cords outlet must never exceed the power rating  
(watts/ amperes) for the extension cord. Excessive  
loads can cause the insulation on the cord to heat  
up and eventually melt through.  
..........................................................................................................  
008e  
Use only the attached power-supply cord.  
..........................................................................................................  
..........................................................................................................  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
110a  
016  
Whenever you suspect the possibility of lightning  
in your area, pull the plug on the power cord out  
of the outlet.  
Before using the unit in a foreign country, consult  
with your retailer, the nearest Roland Service  
Center, or an authorized Roland distributor, as  
listed on the “Information” page.  
..........................................................................................................  
116  
..........................................................................................................  
026  
Be careful when opening/ closing the lid so you do  
vision is recommended whenever small children  
use the unit.  
Do not put anything that contains water (e.g.,  
flower vases) on this unit. Also, avoid the use of  
insecticides, perfumes, alcohol, nail polish, spray  
cans, etc., near the unit. Swiftly wipe away any  
liquid that spills on the unit using a dry, soft cloth.  
..........................................................................................................  
118  
Should you remove the screws fastening the  
stand, make sure to put them in a safe place out of  
childrens reach, so there is no chance of them  
being swallowed accidentally.  
..........................................................................................................  
101a  
..........................................................................................................  
The unit should be located so that its location or  
position does not interfere with its proper venti-  
lation.  
..........................................................................................................  
102b  
Always grasp only the plug on the power-supply  
cord when plugging into, or unplugging from, an  
outlet or this unit.  
..........................................................................................................  
104  
Try to prevent cords and cables from becoming  
entangled. Also, all cords and cables should be  
placed so they are out of the reach of children.  
..........................................................................................................  
106  
Never climb on top of, nor place heavy objects on  
the unit.  
..........................................................................................................  
107b  
Never handle the power cord or its plugs with wet  
hands when plugging into, or unplugging from,  
an outlet or this unit.  
..........................................................................................................  
108d: Selection  
If you need to move the instrument, take note of  
the precautions listed below. At least two persons  
are required to safely lift and move the unit. It  
should be handled carefully, all the while keeping  
it level. Make sure to have a firm grip, to protect  
yourself from injury and the instrument from  
damage.  
1
• Check to make sure the knob bolts securing the  
unit to the stand have not become loose. Fasten  
them again securely whenever you notice any  
loosening.  
2
3
• Disconnect the power cord.  
• Disconnect all cords coming from external  
devices.  
4
5
7
• Close the lid.  
• Fold down the music stand.  
..........................................................................................................  
109a  
Before cleaning the unit, turn off the power and  
..........................................................................................................  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IMPO RTAN T N O TES  
291b  
In addition to the items listed under “IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS” and “USING THE UNIT SAFELY” on pages 2,  
3 and 4, please read and observe the following:  
358  
Po w e r Su p p ly  
Do not allow objects to remain on top of the keyboard.  
This can be the cause of malfunction, such as keys ceasing  
to produce sound.  
301  
Do not use this unit on the same power circuit with any  
device that will generate line noise (such as an electric  
motor or variable lighting system).  
359  
Do not paste stickers, decals, or the like to this instrument.  
Peeling such matter off the instrument may damage the  
exterior finish.  
307  
Before connecting this unit to other devices, turn off the  
power to all units. This will help prevent malfunctions  
and/ or damage to speakers or other devices.  
Ma in te n a n ce  
308  
401b  
Although the LCD and LEDs are switched off when the  
POWER switch is switched off, this does not mean that the  
unit has been completely disconnected from the source of  
power. If you need to turn off the power completely, first  
turn off the POWER switch, then unplug the power cord  
from the power outlet. For this reason, the outlet into  
which you choose to connect the power cords plug  
should be one that is within easy reach.  
To clean the unit, use a dry, soft cloth; or one that is  
slightly dampened. Try to wipe the entire surface using an  
equal amount of strength, moving the cloth along with the  
grain of the wood. Rubbing too hard in the same area can  
damage the finish.  
402  
Never use benzine, thinners, alcohol or solvents of any  
kind, to avoid the possibility of discoloration and/ or  
deformation.  
Pla ce m e n t  
The pedals of this unit are made of brass.  
351  
Brass eventually darkens as the result of the natural  
oxidization process. If the brass becomes tarnished, polish  
it using commercially available metal polisher.  
Using the unit near power amplifiers (or other equipment  
containing large power transformers) may induce hum.  
To alleviate the problem, change the orientation of this  
unit; or move it farther away from the source of inter-  
ference.  
Fo r KR-5 -PE  
Since your piano has a polished finish that is as delicate as  
that found on finely crafted wooden furniture, it needs  
careful, periodic care. A few important suggestions  
concerning the proper care of the unit follow.  
352a  
This device may interfere with radio and television  
reception. Do not use this device in the vicinity of such  
receivers.  
For dusting, wipe the instrument with a soft cloth  
that has been soaked with water, then squeezed dry.  
Be sure to wipe gently. Even the tiniest grains of sand  
or grit can leave scratches on the surface if too much  
force is applied while wiping.  
Do not use any cleaners or detergents, since they might  
deteriorate the surface of the cabinet, and produce  
cracks. Do not use dusting cloths that contain  
chemicals.  
352b  
Noise may be produced if wireless communications  
devices, such as cell phones, are operated in the vicinity of  
this unit. Such noise could occur when receiving or initi-  
ating a call, or while conversing. Should you experience  
such problems, you should relocate such wireless devices  
so they are at a greater distance from this unit, or switch  
them off.  
353  
Observe the following when using the units floppy disk  
drive. For further details, refer to “Before Using Floppy  
Disks” (p. 6).  
Ad d itio n a l Pre ca u tio n s  
551  
• Do not place the unit near devices that produce a  
strong magnetic field (e.g., loudspeakers).  
Please be aware that the contents of memory can be  
irretrievably lost as a result of a malfunction, or the  
improper operation of the unit. To protect yourself against  
the risk of loosing important data, we recommend that  
you periodically save a backup copy of important data  
you have stored in the units memory on a floppy disk.  
• Install the unit on a solid, level surface.  
• Do not move the unit or subject it to vibration while  
the drive is operating.  
354b  
552  
Do not expose the unit to direct sunlight, place it near  
devices that radiate heat, leave it inside an enclosed  
vehicle, or otherwise subject it to temperature extremes.  
Also, do not allow lighting devices that normally are used  
while their light source is very close to the unit (such as a  
piano light), or powerful spotlights to shine upon the  
same area of the unit for extended periods of time.  
Excessive heat can deform or discolor the unit.  
Unfortunately, it may be impossible to restore the contents  
of data that was stored on a floppy disk once it has been  
lost. Roland Corporation assumes no liability concerning  
such loss of data.  
553  
Use a reasonable amount of care when using the units  
buttons, sliders, or other controls; and when using its jacks  
and connectors. Rough handling can lead to malfunctions.  
355  
554  
To avoid possible breakdown, do not use the unit in a wet  
area, such as an area exposed to rain or other moisture.  
Never strike or apply strong pressure to the display.  
556  
When connecting / disconnecting all cables, grasp the  
connector itself—never pull on the cable. This way you  
will avoid causing shorts, or damage to the cables  
internal elements.  
356  
Do not allow rubber, vinyl, or similar materials to remain  
on the unit for long periods of time. Such objects can  
discolor or otherwise harmfully affect the finish.  
557  
A small amount of heat will radiate from the unit during  
normal operation.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
IMPO RTAN T N O TES  
558a  
Ha n d lin g Flo p p y Disk s  
To avoid disturbing your neighbors, try to keep the units  
volume at reasonable levels. You may prefer to use  
headphones, so you do not need to be concerned about  
those around you (especially when it is late at night).  
651  
Floppy disks contain a plastic disk with a thin coating of  
magnetic storage medium. Microscopic precision is  
required to enable storage of large amounts of data on  
such a small surface area. To preserve their integrity,  
please observe the following when handling floppy disks:  
559b  
When you need to transport the unit, pack it in shock-  
absorbent material. Transporting the unit without doing  
so can cause it to become scratched or damaged, and  
could lead to malfunction.  
Never touch the magnetic medium inside the disk.  
• Do not use or store floppy disks in dirty or dusty areas.  
560  
Do not pull the music stand too far forward when setting/  
releasing its latches.  
• Do not subject floppy disks to temperature extremes  
(e.g., direct sunlight in an enclosed vehicle). Recom-  
mended temperature range: 10 to 50° C (50 to 122° F).  
562  
Use a cable from Roland to make the connection. If using  
some other make of connection cable, please note the  
following precautions.  
• Do not expose floppy disks to strong magnetic fields,  
such as those generated by loudspeakers.  
652  
• Some connection cables contain resistors. Do not use  
cables that incorporate resistors for connecting to this  
unit. The use of such cables can cause the sound level  
to be extremely low, or impossible to hear. For infor-  
mation on cable specifications, contact the manufac-  
turer of the cable.  
Floppy disks have a “write protect” tab which can protect  
the disk from accidental erasure. It is recommended that  
the tab be kept in the PROTECT position, and moved to  
the WRITE position only when you wish to write new  
data onto the disk.  
Rear side of the disk  
Be fo re Usin g Flo p p y Disk s  
Ha n d lin g th e Flo p p y Disk Drive  
W rite  
602  
(can write new data onto disk)  
Install the unit on a solid, level surface in an area free from  
vibration. If the unit must be installed at an angle, be sure  
the installation does not exceed the permissible range:  
upward.  
Pro te ct  
(prevents writing to disk)  
W rite Pro te ct Ta b  
653  
603  
The identification label should be firmly affixed to the  
disk. Should the label come loose while the disk is in the  
drive, it may be difficult to remove the disk.  
Avoid using the unit immediately after it has been moved  
to a location with a level of humidity that is greatly  
different than its former location. Rapid changes in the  
environment can cause condensation to form inside the  
drive, which will adversely affect the operation of the  
drive and/ or damage floppy disks. When the unit has  
been moved, allow it to become accustomed to the new  
environment (allow a few hours) before operating it.  
654  
Store all disks in a safe place to avoid damaging them, and  
to protect them from dust, dirt, and other hazards. By  
using a dirty or dust-ridden disk, you risk damaging the  
disk, as well as causing the disk drive to malfunction.  
655  
Disks containing performance data for this unit should  
always be locked (have their write protect tab slid to the  
“Protect” position) before you insert them into the drive  
on some other unit (except the PR-300, or a product in the  
HP-G, MT, KR, or Atelier families), or into a computers  
drive. Otherwise (if the write protect tab remains in the  
“Write” position), when you perform any disk operations  
using the other devices disk drive (such as checking the  
contents of the disk, or loading data), you risk rendering  
the disk unreadable by this units disk drive.  
604  
To insert a disk, push it gently but firmly into the drive—  
it will click into place. To remove a disk, press the EJECT  
button firmly. Do not use excessive force to remove a disk  
which is lodged in the drive.  
605 modified  
Never eject a disk while reading or writing is in progress,  
since that can damage the magnetic surface of the disk,  
rendering it unusable. (The disk drives indicator will  
light up at full brightness when the drive is busy reading  
or writing data. Ordinarily, the indicator will be less  
brightly lit, or be extinguished.)  
203  
606  
* GS (  
ration.  
) is a registered trademark of Roland Corpo-  
) is a registered trademark of Yamaha Corpo-  
Remove any disk from the drive before powering up or  
down.  
607  
* XG lite (  
To prevent damage to the disk drives heads, always try to  
hold the floppy disk in a level position (not tilted in any  
direction) while inserting it into the drive. Push it in  
firmly, but gently. Never use excessive force.  
ration.  
207  
* Apple and Macintosh are registered trademark of Apple  
Computer, Inc.  
608  
210  
To avoid the risk of malfunction and/ or damage, insert  
only floppy disks into the disk drive. Never insert any  
other type of disk. Avoid getting paper clips, coins, or any  
other foreign objects inside the drive.  
* IBM and IBM PC are registered trademark of International  
Business Machines Corporation.  
220  
* All product names mentioned in this document are trade-  
marks or registered trademarks of their respective owners.  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In tro d u ctio n  
Thank you, and congratulations on your choice of the Roland KR-7/ 5 Intelligent Piano.  
While the KR-7/ 5 Intelligent Piano certainly allows you to achieve authentic piano  
performances, it also features easy-to-use Automatic Accompaniment and numerous  
other useful functions. In order to enjoy reliable performance of your new keyboard for  
many years to come, please take the time to read through this manual in its entirety.  
Ma in Fe a tu re s  
Pia n o So u n d s w ith Rich Re so n a n ce a n d W id e -Ra n g in g  
Ex p re ssive n e ss  
The stereo sampling piano sound generator realistically reproduces even the sound of  
the hammers striking the strings, producing the tones of a high-quality concert grand  
piano.  
Maximum polyphony of 128 notes (KR-7) or 64 notes (KR-5) ensures that you can use the  
pedal freely without running out of notes.  
The KR-7 features a new speaker system, “grand piano presence system,” to provide  
sounds with depth and spatial realism.  
Pu rsu in g th e Pla y in g Fe e l o f a Gra n d Pia n o  
These instruments feature a progressive hammer action keyboard, which duplicates the  
touch of a grand piano, with a heavier touch in the lower register, and a lighter touch in  
the upper register. In addition, on the KR-7, even the distinctive “click” that you feel  
when pressing a key on a grand piano has been faithfully simulated (escapement  
mechanism).  
The pedal is designed for good-feeling response, and allows subtle performance nuances  
to be expressed.  
Ge t Ea sy Re su lts w ith th e Ma in Bu tto n s  
You can play songs, display scores, play the Automatic Accompaniment, select Tones,  
and perform other main KR functions easily by pressing the main buttons found on both  
sides of the screen.  
With the [Select/Listen to a Song] button, you can select over 150 internal songs, from  
songs for piano practice to the latest hits. Pressing the [Score Display] button lets you  
display not only the score for any of the internal songs, but for your own recorded songs  
and songs on floppy disks.  
With the [Music Assistant] button you can select a song you want to play, call up  
Automatic Accompaniment settings that match that song, and while looking at the  
chord score, perform with accompaniment added.  
Thanks to the [Select Various Tones] button, which is used to select suggested Tones  
from the more than 600 internal Tones; the [Song Stylist] button (KR-7), which allows  
you to listen to a variety of arrangements of the internal popular songs, and transform  
them into rock, jazz, or other forms of music; and the [Session Partner] button (KR-7),  
which lets you leave the chords and rhythm to the backing band, and give your  
performances the feel of a group session, you can enjoy playing the KR in a great variety  
of creative ways.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
In tro d u ctio n  
A Va rie ty o f Su p p o rt Fu n ctio n s fo r Fo ste rin g Rich Mu sica l  
Ab ilitie s  
In addition to score displays that let you see note names and fingerings, and a bouncing  
ball that keeps track of the notes currently being played, you can also enjoy other  
powerful practice functions, like repeated practice of a specified segment, and simple  
playback and recording of each hands part–features that only a digital piano can  
provide.  
Other useful practice features include a “Replay” pedal that you can press to stop the  
performance and go back when you have trouble with what youre playing, and “Touch  
the Note,” a function that lets you confirm how a note sounds by touching the note on  
the screen.  
Features geared specifically for young children include “Wonderland,” where kids can  
enjoy touching a variety of instruments; and the “Game,” an ear-training feature which  
helps build their listening abilities with all the fun of a game.  
“ Rh y th m Pa rtn e r” Pro vid e s N a tu ra l-So u n d in g Te m p o  
Along with a wide variety of metronome functions that allow you to change the tone and  
note divisions (patterns), the KR also includes built-in rhythm functions. Now you can  
perform with a natural tempo that matches the rhythm.  
Co n n e cto r fo r Ex te rn a l Disp la y fo r En la rg e d Sco re s a n d Ly rics  
(KR-7 )  
The KR-7 features a built-in connector for external displays.  
By displaying scores and lyrics on a bigger screen, everyone playing in your group  
should be able to get a clear view.  
Ad ju sta b le Mu sic Sta n d (KR-7 )  
In addition to allowing you to adjust the angle of the stand, and move it forward or  
backward, the music holders accommodates even thick score books.  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In tro d u ctio n  
Ho w To Use Th is Ma n u a l  
The KR-7/ 5 Owners Manual consists of two volumes, Quick Start and the Owner’s  
Manual.  
(this volume). This explains how to connect the KRs power cord and how to turn on the  
instruments power.  
After turning on the KRs power, please continue by reading Quick Start.  
By trying out the various procedures while reading the Quick Start, you can easily learn  
how to play the KR and make use of its major functions (especially procedures that  
involve use of the “main buttons”).  
The Owner’s Manual describes procedures, from basic operation to procedures for  
special applications (for example, using the KR as an accompanist and creating songs),  
that will help you master the KRs many performance functions.  
Co n ve n tio n s Use d in Th is Ma n u a l  
This manual uses the following conventions in the interest of simpler, more concise  
instructions.  
• Button names are enclosed in square brackets “[ ]”, as in One Touch Program [Piano]  
button.  
• On screen text is enclosed in angled brackets “< >”, as in <Exit>.  
• The act of lightly contacting the Touch Screen with your finger is called “touching.”  
N O TE  
• An asterisk (*) or a  
at the beginning of a paragraph indicates a note or  
precaution. These should not be ignored.  
• (p. **) refers to pages within the manual.  
• The text incorporates KR-7 screen shots and panel diagrams. Thus, there will be some  
portions where the information differs from that for the KR-5.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Pa n e l De scrip tio n s  
KR-7  
*
The panel diagrams shown in this owner’s manual are those of the KR-7.  
4
5
8 9  
10 11 12 13  
15  
19 20 21  
2
3
1
6
7
14  
16  
17 18  
22  
23  
Power  
1 . [Po w e r] sw itch  
1 3 . [Use r Fu n ctio n ] Bu tto n  
This is used to assign a variety of functions to the Performance  
2 . [Vo lu m e ] k n o b  
Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa d s  
3 . [Brillia n ce ] k n o b  
1 4 . [1 ]–[4 ]  
The operation of each is changed depending on the buttons  
numbered 1 1 1 3 .  
4 . [W o n d e rla n d / Ga m e ] b u tto n  
Here you can learn about instruments while having fun.  
1 5 . Mu sic Sty le b u tto n s  
See the Quick Start  
Pressing the [User] button selects a User Style that youve made  
Ba la n ce  
5 . [Pa rt Ba la n ce ] b u tto n  
1 6 . Fill In b u tto n s  
This adjusts the relative volume levels of each of the  
Inserts a fill-in in an automatic accompaniment and changes the  
6 . [Ba la n ce ] k n o b  
[To Variation] button  
[To Original] button  
Changes the volume balance for sounds played with the  
1 7 . [In tro / En d in g ] b u tto n  
Play an intro or ending during automatic accompaniment (p. 58).  
7 . [Use r Pro g ra m ] b u tto n  
1 8 . [Sta rt/ Sto p ] b u tto n  
Starts and stops automatic accompaniment (p. 58).  
DSP  
8 . [Re ve rb ] b u tto n  
Rh y th m Pa rtn e r  
1 9 . [Me tro n o m e ] b u tto n  
9 . [Ad va n ce d 3 D] b u tto n  
Adds three-dimensional breadth to the accompaniment sounds  
2 0 . Be a t In d ica to r  
1 0 . [Eq u a lize r] b u tto n  
This lights up in correspondence with the beat of the selected  
song or accompaniment.  
2 1 . [Rh y th m ] b u tto n  
1 1 . [Sty le O rch e stra to r] b u tto n  
This is used to change the arrangement type for automatic  
2 2 . Te m p o [-] [+] b u tto n s  
Adjusts the tempo.  
1 2 . [Ph ra se ] Bu tto n  
Press the [-] and [+] buttons at the same time to return to the  
original tempo.  
This is used to play a short phrase with the Performance Pads  
1 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Pa n e l De scrip tio n s  
24  
25  
30  
31  
32  
38  
40 41  
26 27 28  
29  
33 34 35 36 37  
39  
2 3 . Ma in Bu tto n s  
Re co rd / Pla y b a ck  
See the Quick Start  
[Select/Listen to a Song], [Disk] button  
3 1 . [Me n u ] b u tto n  
You can select functions for playing back, recording or editing a  
Use this button to select internal songs or songs from floppy  
3 2 . Tra ck b u tto n s  
[Song Stylist] button  
[Music Assistant] button  
3 3 . [  
(Re se t)] b u tto n  
Resets the song playback-start location to the beginning of the  
song.  
[Score Display] button  
3 4 . [  
(Pla y / Sto p )] b u tto n  
[Session Partner] button  
Starts and stops playback or recording a song.  
[Select Various Tones] button  
3 5 . [  
(Re c)] b u tto n  
When pressed, this button places the instrument in recording  
2 4 . To u ch Scre e n  
This lets you perform a variety of operations just by touching  
3 6 . [  
(Bw d )] b u tto n  
Rewinds the song.  
2 5 . Co n tra st k n o b  
3 7 . [  
(Fw d )] b u tto n  
Fast-forwards the song.  
2 6 . Dia l  
Use this to change on-screen values.  
3 8 . [Tra n sp o se ] b u tto n  
2 7 . [-] [+] b u tto n s  
Transposes the pitch of the keyboard or the song being played  
Allow you to change on-screen values.  
3 9 . [Vo ca l Effe ct] Bu tto n  
2 8 . O n e To u ch Pro g ra m b u tto n  
Applies a variety of effects to vocals from the microphone  
[Piano] button  
4 0 . Disk Drive  
[Arranger] button  
You can insert a floppy disk for playing back or saving songs  
Makes the optimal settings for playing with automatic  
4 1 . Eje ct Bu tto n  
2 9 . [Me lo d y In te llig e n ce ] Bu tto n  
3 0 . [To n e ] b u tto n s  
1 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pa n e l De scrip tio n s  
KR-5  
4
5
8
9
11  
15 16 17  
2
3
1
6
7
10  
12  
13 14  
18  
19  
Power  
1 . [Po w e r] sw itch  
1 1 . Mu sic Sty le b u tto n s  
Pressing the [User] button selects a User Style that youve made  
2 . [Vo lu m e ] k n o b  
1 2 . Fill In b u tto n s  
3 . [Brillia n ce ] k n o b  
Inserts a fill-in in an automatic accompaniment and changes the  
4 . [W o n d e rla n d / Ga m e ] b u tto n  
[To Variation] button  
[To Original] button  
Here you can learn about instruments while having fun.  
See the Quick Start  
1 3 . [In tro / En d in g ] b u tto n  
Play an intro or ending during automatic accompaniment (p. 58).  
Ba la n ce  
1 4 . [Sta rt/ Sto p ] b u tto n  
5 . [Pa rt Ba la n ce ] b u tto n  
Starts and stops automatic accompaniment (p. 58).  
This adjusts the relative volume levels of each of the  
Rh y th m Pa rtn e r  
6 . [Ba la n ce ] k n o b  
1 5 . [Me tro n o m e ] b u tto n  
Changes the volume balance for sounds played with the  
7 . [Use r Pro g ra m ] b u tto n  
1 6 . Be a t In d ica to r  
This lights up in correspondence with the beat of the selected  
song or accompaniment.  
8 . [Re ve rb ] b u tto n  
1 7 . [Rh y th m ] b u tto n  
9 . [Sty le O rch e stra to r/ Use r Fu n ctio n ] b u tto n  
Switch the function of the Performance Pads.  
1 8 . Te m p o [-] [+] b u tto n s  
Adjusts the tempo.  
This is used to change the arrangement type for automatic  
Press the [-] and [+] buttons at the same time to return to the  
original tempo.  
Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa d s  
1 0 . [1 ], [2 ]  
The operation of each is changed depending on the [Style  
Orchestrator/ User Function] button.  
1 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Pa n e l De scrip tio n s  
20  
21  
26  
27  
28  
34  
35 36  
25  
22 23 24  
29 30 31 32 33  
1 9 . Ma in Bu tto n s  
Re co rd / Pla y b a ck  
See the Quick Start  
[Select/Listen to a Song], [Disk] button  
2 7 . [Me n u ] b u tto n  
You can select functions for playing back, recording or editing a  
Use this button to select internal songs or songs from floppy  
2 8 . Tra ck b u tto n s  
[Music Assistant] button  
[Score Display] button  
2 9 . [  
(Re se t)] b u tto n  
Resets the song playback-start location to the beginning of the  
song.  
[Select Various Tones] button  
3 0 . [  
(Pla y / Sto p )] b u tto n  
Starts and stops playback or recording a song.  
2 0 . To u ch Scre e n  
3 1 . [  
(Re c)] b u tto n  
This lets you perform a variety of operations just by touching  
When pressed, this button places the instrument in recording  
2 1 . Co n tra st k n o b  
3 2 . [  
(Bw d )] b u tto n  
Rewinds the song.  
2 2 . Dia l  
Use this to change on-screen values.  
3 3 . [  
(Fw d )] b u tto n  
Fast-forwards the song.  
2 3 . [-] [+] b u tto n s  
Allow you to change on-screen values.  
3 4 . [Tra n sp o se ] b u tto n  
Transposes the pitch of the keyboard or the song being played  
2 4 . O n e To u ch Pro g ra m b u tto n  
[Piano] button  
3 5 . Disk Drive  
[Arranger] button  
You can insert a floppy disk for playing back or saving songs  
Makes the optimal settings for playing with automatic  
3 6 . Eje ct Bu tto n  
2 5 . [Me lo d y In te llig e n ce ] Bu tto n  
2 6 . [To n e ] b u tto n s  
1 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pa n e l De scrip tio n s  
Re a r Pa n e l  
KR-7  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
KR-5  
1 . MIDI O u t/ In co n n e cto rs  
4 . O u tp u t ja ck s  
These can be connected to an external MIDI device to exchange  
These jacks can be connected to your audio system to enjoy  
more powerful sound. They can also be connected to a tape  
recorder or similar device in order to record your performance  
*
There is also a MIDI In connector on the bottom panel. The two MIDI  
In connectors cannot be used simultaneously.  
5 . Ex t Disp la y co n n e cto r (KR-7 )  
Connect an external display. You can put scores on the screen  
2 . Pe d a l co n n e cto r  
3 . In p u t ja ck s  
These jacks can be connected to another sound generating  
device or an audio device, so that the sound of that device will  
Bo tto m Pa n e l  
1 .Co m p u te r co n n e cto r  
KR-7  
KR-5  
You can connect a computer to this  
connector to exchange performance data  
1
2
Computer  
MIDI In  
-
PC 2  
-
PC 1  
5
6
7
Mac  
5
7
MIDI  
2 .Co m p u te r sw itch  
3
4
The setting for this switch made  
depending on the computer connected –  
Mac/ PC-1/ PC-2.  
Phones  
Switches the connections for the MIDI  
*
You cant use the MIDI Out/In connector and  
the Computer connector at the same time.  
5 . Mic In ja ck  
3 . MIDI In co n n e cto r  
An external MIDI device can be connected here to receive  
6 . Ech o k n o b (KR-5 )  
*
There is also a MIDI In connector on the rear panel of the KR-7/5. The  
two MIDI In connectors cannot be used simultaneously.  
7 . Mic Vo lu m e k n o b  
4 . Ph o n e s ja ck s  
1 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Co n te n ts  
Adding Three-Dimensional Breadth to the Sounds You Play  
(Advanced 3D) (KR-7)..............................................................32  
Adjusting the Sound to Achieve the Preferred Tone Quality  
(Equalizer) (KR-7) .....................................................................34  
Performing Using Automatic Accompaniment  
Playing Chords with Simple Fingering  
Using Keywords to Search for Music Styles  
Having the Accompaniment Start Simultaneously When You  
Having a Count Sound Play at the End of the Intro  
Changing the Instrumental Makeup of Music Styles  
Adding Harmony to the Right-Hand Part  
Playing Sounds in the Left Hand During a Performance  
Playing the Piano with Accompaniment Added  
Playing Different Tones with the Left and Right Hands  
Changing the Volume Balance between the Accompaniment  
(Split)..................................................................................................29  
Shifting the Keyboard Pitch in Octave Steps  
(Octave Shift) .............................................................................30  
1 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Co n te n ts  
Touching Notes to Confirm the Sounds  
Copying Sets of User Programs on Disks to the User Memory  
Coping Sets of User Programs Stored in the User Memory  
Simultaneously Switching User Program and Transmitting  
Setting the Tempo by Pressing the Button in Time  
Use Your Voice to Select the Tempo (Vocal Tap Tempo)  
Getting the Most Suitable Part Tones for the Musical Genre  
Recording While Erasing the Previous Recording  
Layering a Recording Over Previously Recorded Sounds  
Transposing Keyboard Sounds and Songs Played Back  
Repeated Recording at the Same Location  
Changing the Tone Settings When Playing Back Songs  
Re-Recording Part of Your Performance  
Composing an Accompaniment By Entering Chords  
Changing the Parts Assigned to the Track Buttons During  
Recording While Selecting the Track Buttons  
1 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Co n te n ts  
Disabling Functions Other Than Piano Performance  
Creating New Styles by Combining Internal Music Styles  
(Panel Lock).....................................................................................157  
Creating a Style from a Song You Composed Yourself  
Performing in Ensemble with MIDI Instruments  
Disconnecting the Internal Sound Generator and Keyboard  
Sending Tone Change Messages (Program Change/ Bank  
Changing How Rapidly Sounds Are Expressed According to  
(KR-7)........................................................................................144  
Sending Recorded Performance Data to a MIDI Device  
Adjusting the Resonant Sounds (String Resonance)  
Changing Music Styles Without Changing the Tone or Tempo  
Assigning Functions to Pedals and Performance Pads  
Changing How Chords Are Played and Specified  
Changing the Screen Message When the Power Is Turned On  
Changing the Settings for Showing Images with the External  
Selecting Images To Be Shown on the KR-7 and External  
Remembering the Settings Even When the Power is Turned  
Index...................................................................... 193  
1 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Be fo re Yo u Sta rt Pla y in g  
Co n n e ct th e Pe d a l Ca b le  
Co n n e ct th e Po w e r Co rd  
Insert the pedal cable into the Pedal connector on the  
Insert the included power cable into the AC inlet on the  
bottom panel of the KR-7/5, and then plug it into an  
electrical outlet.  
rear panel of the KR-7/5.  
fig.00-01  
N O TE  
Be sure to use the supplied power cord.  
fig.00-02  
Co n n e ct th e Sp e a k e r Ca b le  
(KR-7 )  
Se ttin g Up th e Music Sta n d (KR-5 )  
As shown in the diagram, connect the speaker cable  
leading from the speaker box of the stand to the speaker  
connector located on the rear panel of the KR-7.  
fig.00-03  
(1)  
Push the speaker cable in until it clicks into position.  
(2)  
(2)  
KR-7 Rear  
1 . Gently raise the music stand, then secure it in place as  
shown in the figure.  
Speaker connector  
Clip portion  
2 . To collapse the stand, fold in the metal fittings while  
supporting the stand with both hands and gently fold  
down the stand.  
Speaker cable  
N O TE  
Do not place containers holding liquids (such as flower vases),  
insecticide, perfume, alcohol, or similar substances on top of this  
piano.  
N O TE  
Do not apply excessive force to the music stand.  
The speakers of this piano are mounted beneath the upper surface,  
and face upwards. Malfunctions or accidents may occur if liquids  
contact any part of the speakers.  
Se ttin g Up th e Music Sta n d (KR-7 )  
1 . Grasping the music stand with both hands, lift it  
Speakers  
toward you until its in the upright position.  
2 . Use the support on the back of the music stand to keep  
the stand in place.  
The angle of the music stand can be set to any of three  
positions.  
fig.mu_stand  
1
2
1 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
Be fo re Yo u Sta rt Pla y in g  
Ad ju stin g th e Po sitio n o f th e  
O p e n in g / Clo sin g th e Lid  
Mu sic Sta n d  
To open the lid, use both hands to lift it lightly, and  
slide it away from yourself.  
Grasp the music stand with both hands, and pull it  
toward yourself to adjust the position.  
To close the lid, pull it gently toward yourself, and  
lower it softly after it has been fully extended.  
fig.mu_stand2  
fig.00-05  
N O TE  
Fo ld in g Do w n th e Mu sic Sta n d  
When opening and closing the lid, be careful not to let your fingers  
get caught. If small children will be using the KR-7/ 5, adult  
supervision should be provided.  
1 . Grasp the music stand with both hands, and gently  
push it in until it stops.  
N O TE  
2 . Raise the support located on the back of the music  
If you need to move the piano, make sure the lid is closed first to  
prevent accidents.  
stand, then gently fold down the music stand.  
Usin g th e Mu sic Ho ld e rs  
Tu rn in g th e Po w e r O n a n d O ff  
You can use the holders to hold pages in place.  
When not using the holders, leave them folded down.  
fig.mu_stand4  
N O TE  
Turn on power to your various devices in the order specified. By  
turning on devices in the wrong order, you risk causing malfunction  
and/ or damage to speakers and other devices.  
To turn the power on, turn the [Volume] knob all the  
way down, and then press the [Power] switch.  
The power will turn on, and the Power indicator at the  
left front of the KR-7/ 5 will light.  
After a few seconds, you will be able to play the  
keyboard to produce sound.  
Re m o vin g th e Mu sic Sta n d  
You can remove the music stand from the piano.  
Use the [Volume] knob to adjust the volume.  
This allows you to place a notebook computer on the piano.  
N O TE  
Position the music stand so its upright, then remove  
the three screws, as shown.  
This unit is equipped with a protection circuit. A brief interval (a few  
seconds) after power up is required before the unit will operate  
You can remove the screws using a coin.  
fig.mu_stand3  
normally.  
fig.00-06.e  
Power  
N O TE  
Power Indicator  
Be careful not to lose the screws that you removed from the music  
stand, or put them where they might be swallowed by small  
children.  
To turn the power off, turn the [Volume] knob all the  
way to the left, and press the [Power] switch.  
The Power indicator at the left front of the KR-7/ 5 will  
go dark, and the power will be turned off.  
1 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Be fo re Yo u Sta rt Pla y in g  
Ab o u t th e Pe d a ls  
Ad ju stin g th e So u n d ’s  
Vo lu m e a n d Brillia n ce  
The pedals have the following functions, and are used  
mainly for piano performance.  
fig.00-08.e  
Turn the [Volume] knob to adjust the overall volume.  
Turn the [Brilliance] knob to adjust the brightness of  
the sound.  
fig.00-07.e  
Soft Pedal  
Damper Pedal  
Sostenuto Pedal  
Min  
Max  
Mellow  
Bright  
Da m p e r p e d a l (rig h t p e d a l)  
While this pedal is pressed, notes will be sustained even after  
you take your fingers off the keys.  
Co n n e ctin g He a d p h o n e s  
On an acoustic piano, holding down the damper pedal will  
allow the remaining strings to resonate in sympathy with the  
sounds that you played from the keyboard, adding a rich  
resonance.  
The KR-7/ 5 has two jacks for plugging in headphones. This  
allows two people to listen through headphones  
simultaneously, making it very useful for lessons and when  
performing piano pieces for four hands. Additionally, this  
allows you to play without having to worry about bothering  
others around you, even at night.  
The KR-7/ 5 simulates this sympathetic resonance.  
You can change the amount of resonance applied with the damper  
Plug the headphones into the Phones jack located at the  
bottom left of the piano.  
Connecting headphones will automatically mute the  
sound from the internal speakers.  
So ste n u to p e d a l (ce n te r p e d a l)  
This pedal sustains only the sounds of the keys that were  
already played when you pressed the pedal.  
The headphone volume is adjusted by the [Volume]  
knob of the KR-7/ 5.  
fig.00-04.e  
So ft p e d a l (le ft p e d a l)  
Phones jack x 2  
When you hold down this pedal and play the keyboard, the  
sound will have a softer tone.  
Ab o u t th e Ad ju ste r  
P
h
o
n
When you move the KR-7/ 5 or if you feel that the pedals are  
unstable, adjust the adjuster located below the pedals as  
follows.  
N O TE  
Rotate the adjuster to lower it so that it is in firm contact  
with the floor. If there is a gap between the pedals and  
the floor, the pedals may be damaged. In particular  
when placing the instrument on carpet, adjust this so  
that the pedals firmly contact the floor.  
Use Stereo headphones.  
So m e N o te s o n Usin g He a d p h o n e s  
To prevent damage to the cord, handle the headphones  
only by the headset or the plug.  
fig.00-09.j  
Connecting the headphones when the volume of  
connected equipment is turned up may result in damage  
to the headphones. Lower the volume on the KR-7/ 5  
before plugging in the headphones.  
Listening at excessively high volume levels will not only  
damage the headphones, but may also cause hearing  
loss. Use the headphones at a moderate volume level.  
Adjuster  
2 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                                   
Be fo re Yo u Sta rt Pla y in g  
Co n n e ctin g a Micro p h o n e  
Co n n e ctin g a n Ex te rn a l  
Disp la y (KR-7 )  
You can connect a microphone into the Mic In jack, and enjoy  
karaoke with the KR-7/ 5.  
fig.00-10  
You can connect a computer monitor or other such external  
display to the instrument, and display scores and lyrics on  
the larger screen, and display whatever images as you like.  
Mic Volume knob  
Mic Echo knob  
(KR-5)  
For more about the external display settings, refer to  
Mic In jack  
1 . Connect a microphone (sold separately) to the Mic In  
Disp la y s Th a t Ca n Be Co n n e cte d to Th is In stru m e n t  
jack on the lower-right area of the instrument.  
In general, a great many of the VGA monitors and multiscan  
monitors that are available on the market are compatible  
with this instrument. However, before you connect any  
monitor, make sure it meets the following specifications:  
2 . Rotate the [Mic Volume] knob in front of the Mic In  
jack to adjust the volume level for the microphone.  
3 . Rotate the [Mic Echo] knob to adjust the echo level  
Resolution  
640 x 480 pixels  
31.5 kHz  
(KR-5).  
Horizontal scan frequency  
Vertical scan frequency  
Connector  
The KR-7 does not feature an [Mic Echo] knob. When  
you want to adjust the mic echo on the KR-7, refer to  
60 Hz  
3-row, 15-pin D-Sub type  
Analog  
Signal  
So m e N o te s o n Usin g a Micro p h o n e  
N O TE  
Be careful of high volume levels when using mikes late  
at night or early in the morning.  
Confirm that the display to be used is compatible with the  
frequencies mentioned above. Using a display that is not compatible  
with the above frequencies may result in incorrect image output  
when images move, and in certain cases may even damage the  
display.  
When connecting a microphone to the KR-7, be sure to  
lower the volume. If the volume control is too high when  
the microphone is plugged in, noise may be produced by  
the speakers.  
Howling could be produced depending on the location  
of microphones relative to speakers. This can be  
remedied by:  
Ma k in g th e Co n n e ctio n s  
N O TE  
-
-
Changing the orientation of the microphone.  
Relocating microphone at a greater distance from  
speakers.  
To prevent malfunction and/ or damage to speakers or other devices,  
always turn down the volume, and turn off the power on all devices  
before making any connections.  
-
Lowering volume levels.  
D-sub 15 pin  
(Mini)  
D-sub 15 pin  
(Mini)  
Display Cable  
(Sold separately)  
KR-7 Rear  
Ext Display Connector  
External Display  
1 . Turn off the power to the KR-7 and the display to be  
connected.  
2 . Use display cable (sold separately) to connect the  
display to the Ext Display connector on the KR-7.  
3 . Switch on the KR-7.  
4 . Switch on the connected display.  
2 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
Be fo re Yo u Sta rt Pla y in g  
Ab o u t th e To u ch Scre e n  
For more on handling the external display, refer to your displays  
owners manual.  
The KR-7/ 5 makes use of a touch screen.  
This lets you carry out a wide variety of actions just by  
touching the screen lightly.  
You can also remove the music stand, then place the display there so  
that it faces forward. For instructions on removing the music stand,  
N O TE  
The touch screen is operated by touching it lightly with your finger.  
Pressing hard, or using a hard object can damage the touch screen.  
Be careful not to press too hard, and be sure to use only your fingers  
to operate the touch screen.  
N O TE  
The positioning of the touch screen may become displaced due to  
changes in the surrounding environment and over time. If this  
When using the KR-7 with a display placed on it, be sure to  
note the following precautions.  
N O TE  
Do not place items on the touch screen.  
Make sure the display sits stably on the KR-7 before use.  
Do not let the base of the display rest on any of the music  
stands moving parts. Keep the base of the display  
within one of the areas shown by the dotted lines in the  
illustration below.  
Ad ju stin g th e Co n tra st o f th e  
Scre e n  
To adjust the contrast of the screen, turn the Contrast  
Areas for placing the display  
knob located at the right side of the screen.  
If you are placing the display on top of the KR, we  
recommend using a liquid crystal display (LCD). If using  
a cathode ray tube (CRT) display, take extra care to  
ensure that the display rests stably on the instrument.  
Tu rn in g th e Po w e r O ff  
After use, turn off the power using the following procedure.  
1 . Turn the volume all the way down on the KR-7.  
2 . Turn off the KR-7.  
3 . Turn off the connected display.  
2 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Be fo re Yo u Sta rt Pla y in g  
Usin g th e Ma in Ico n s  
Ma in Scre e n s  
With the KR-7/ 5, you can many other screens besides the  
Basic screen to do things. The on-screen graphics that appear  
three dimensional work like buttons. These are called  
“Icons.”  
Pia n o Scre e n  
Immediately after the power is turned on, the Piano screen  
The main icons you can use on these screens are as follows.  
Some screens consist on two or more pages.  
You can display the next page or the previ-  
ous page of the screen by touching these  
icons.  
Touch this to cancel the currently editing  
setting or exit the screen that is currently  
displayed. You can usually display the Ba-  
sic screen by touching <Exit> several times.  
When you select an internal song or music  
files that includes the lyrics data, this icon  
appears in the Piano screen or Basic screen.  
Touch this to display the lyrics.  
Ba sic Scre e n  
The following screen is called Basic screen.  
Song name or  
Tempo  
Beat Measure  
Music Style name  
N O TE  
The explanations in this manual include illustrations that depict  
what should typically be shown by the display. Note, however, that  
your unit may incorporate a newer, enhanced version of the system  
(e.g., includes newer sounds), so what you actually see in the display  
may not always match what appears in the manual.  
The Tone names are  
selected appear.  
These information are  
displayed, when you use the  
automatic accompaniment.  
You can usually display this screen by touching <Exit>  
several times.  
Follow either of the procedures described below to display it.  
Press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button.  
The Basic screen appears and the settings are made for  
automatic accompaniment.  
Press the One Touch Program [Piano] button, then press  
one of the Tone buttons, then touch <Exit>.  
2 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Pla y in g th e Ke y b o a rd Lik e a Pia n o  
(O n e -To u ch Pia n o )  
You can create the optimal settings for a piano performance with the press of a single  
button.  
fig.panel1-1  
1 .  
Press the One Touch Program [Piano] button.  
A “Piano screen” like the one shown below will appear.  
fig.d-piano.eps_60  
Since this instrument faithfully  
reproduces real acoustic piano  
action and response, keys  
played in the top one-and-one-  
half-octave range continue to  
resonate, regardless of the  
damper pedal action, and the  
tone in this range is audibly  
different. The Key Transpose  
to change the range that is  
unaffected by the damper  
pedal.  
When you press the One Touch Program [Piano] button, the KR-7/ 5 will switch to  
the following settings, regardless of the current panel settings.  
keyboard returns to a single section.  
You can change the piano  
performance settings by  
touching <Functions> on the  
screen. For more information,  
The Grand Piano sound is automatically selected.  
Ch a n g in g th e Pia n o So u n d  
Touch the piano lid on the screen, and listen to the tone change as you slide your  
finger or touch  
or  
to open and close the lid.  
This simulates the actual changes in sound that occur when the lid of a grand piano  
is set at different heights.  
When you select an internal  
song or music file that includes  
the lyrics data, <lyrics>  
appears in the Piano screen or  
Basic screen. Touch this to  
display the lyrics.  
2 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Pe rfo rm in g w ith a Va rie ty o f To n e s  
(To n e Bu tto n s)  
The KR-7/ 5 comes with a many built-in instrument sounds and effects. This lets you  
enjoy perform in a wide range of musical styles.  
For more about the names of  
Tones, take a look at the “Tone  
The built-in sounds are called “Tones.” The sounds are organized into six tone  
groups, which are assigned to the [Tone] buttons.  
fig.panel1-2  
1 .  
Press any one of the Tone buttons to select a tone group.  
Youll see that buttons indicator light up.  
The screen displays the tone names included in the tone group youve selected.  
fig.d-tonesel.eps_60  
This screen is called the “Tone selection screen.”  
You can touch <Audition> for an audio demonstration of a particular tone.  
Touch  
to switch the screen and display the next selection.  
You can touch <Search> to find tones according to the search criteria you specify  
2 .  
3 .  
Select a tone, then touch the tone name.  
Youll hear the tone youve selected when you play the keyboard.  
You can use the [-] [+] buttons and the dial to automatically switch pages and select  
tones.  
Touch <Exit>.  
This returns you to the Basic screen or the previous screen.  
2 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Pla y in g Pe rcu ssio n In stru m e n ts o r So u n d Effe cts  
You can use the keyboard to play percussion sounds or effects like sirens and animal  
sounds.  
fig.panel1-2  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Select Various Tones] button and watch the indicator light up.  
Touch <Drums> or <SFX>.  
fig.d-drum.eps_60  
The combination of sounds  
assigned to the keyboard  
varies according to the drum  
Each note of the keyboard will play a different sound.  
You can also have play sounds by touching the screen.  
3 .  
Touch <Exit> several times.  
This returns you to the Basic screen or the previous screen.  
2 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Usin g Ke y w o rd s to Se a rch fo r To n e s (To n e Se a rch )  
You can search for tones that match the conditions you set for instrument or musical  
style. You can also search the tones using the first character of the tone name.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press any Tone button.  
The tone selection screen appears.  
Touch <Search>.  
The following “Tone search screen” appears.  
fig.d-tonesrch1.eps_60  
Co n d itio n Se a rch scre e n  
N a m e Se a rch scre e n  
Touch here to switch these screens.  
In condition search, tones  
satisfying all of the selected  
search criteria are sought.  
Se a rch in g b y Co n d itio n s  
3 .  
4 .  
Touch <Category> or <Genre>, then use the [-] [+] buttons and the dial to  
select the search conditions.  
Touch <Search>.  
The search results appear in the display.  
Touch the tone name to select the tone.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the tone search screen.  
Se a rch in g b y To n e N a m e  
3
Touch <By Name>.  
Touch <By Key> to go to the condition search screen.  
4 .  
Decide which character is to be used for the search.  
Enter the character youre searching for. For example, touching <ABC> in succession  
cycles you through the available choices in that character group (“A”B”C”...).  
Touching <A-0> selects the type of character. Each time you touch <A-0>, the  
character switches between alphabets and numerals.  
The selected character appears in the middle of the screen.  
5 .  
Touch <Search>.  
The search results appear in the display.  
Touch the tone name to select the Tone.  
Touch <Exit> several times to return to the Basic screen or the previous screen.  
2 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Pe rfo rm in g w ith Tw o So u n d s La y e re d  
To g e th e r (La y e r)  
Two tones sounding together when you press a single key is referred to as a “layer  
performance.”  
For instance, its possible to play the Tones for both Piano and Strings simultaneously.  
fig.layer.e  
Gra n d Pia n o 1  
Strin g s  
1 .  
Touch <Layer> at the bottom of the Basic screen.  
fig.d-layer.eps_60  
When you select an internal  
song or music file that includes  
the lyrics data, <lyrics>  
appears in the Basic screen.  
Touch this to display the lyrics.  
The tone that was sounding before you switched to layer performance, plus the tone  
indicated in the lower part of the display, are now played together.  
When you touch Octave  
<-><+> on the tone selection  
screen, the pitch of the  
Here, the tone appearing in the upper part of the display is called the “right-hand  
tone,” and the tone appearing in the lower part of the display is called the “layer  
tone.”  
keyboards sound is changed  
in octave units. To learn more,  
Ch a n g in g th e to n e s  
2 .  
Touch the name of the tone to be changed.  
The tone name will be highlighted in white.  
3 .  
4 .  
When you have selected the tone, touch <Exit>.  
You can vary the volume-level  
balance of the two tones. For  
the Volume Balance for Each  
Performance Part (Part  
The display returns to the Basic screen.  
Ca n ce llin g th e La y e r  
5 .  
Touch <Layer>.  
The <Layer> icon reverts to black, and the layer performance is cancelled.  
Now when you play the keys, only the tone indicated on the screen is sounded.  
2 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Pla y in g Diffe re n t To n e s w ith th e Le ft  
a n d Rig h t Ha n d s (Sp lit)  
Dividing the keyboard into right-hand and left-hand areas, then playing different  
sounds in each section is called “split performance.” The boundary key is called the  
“split point.”  
The split point key is included in the left-hand keyboard area. Each time power to  
the keyboard is turned on, the split point is reset to “F#3.”  
fig.split.e  
Split Point  
You can change the split point;  
Aco u stic Ba ss  
Gra n d Pia n o 1  
1 .  
At the Basic screen, touch <Split>.  
fig.d-split.eps_60  
When you select an internal  
song or music file that includes  
the lyrics data, <lyrics>  
appears in the Basic screen.  
Touch this to display the lyrics.  
The tone sounding prior to the split performance is played in the right-hand section  
of the keyboard, and the tone indicated at the left of the screen is played in the left-  
hand section of the keyboard.  
Here, the tone appearing at the right part of the display is called the “right-hand  
tone,” and the tone appearing at the left part of the display is called the “left-hand  
tone.”  
When you touch Octave  
<-><+> in the tone selection  
screen, the pitch of the  
Ch a n g in g th e To n e s  
keyboards sound is changed  
in octave units. To learn more,  
2 .  
Touch the name of the tone to be changed.  
The tone name will be highlighted in white.  
3 .  
4 .  
When you have selected the tone, touch <Exit>.  
The display returns to the Basic screen.  
You can change the volume  
balance between the left- and  
right-hand parts of the  
Ca n ce llin g th e Sp lit  
the Volume Balance for Each  
Performance Part (Part  
5 .  
Touch <Split>.  
The <Split> icon reverts to black, and the split performance is cancelled.  
When you play the keys, only the tone indicated on the screen is sounded.  
2 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Tu rn in g O n La y e r a n d Sp lit Pe rfo rm a n ce Sim u lta n e o u sly  
Turning on both layer performance and split performance allows you to split the  
When the keyboard has been  
divided into upper and lower  
sections, the damper pedal is  
applied to only the upper  
section. If you want to add  
lingering reverberations to the  
notes of the lower section, see  
“Assigning Functions to  
keyboard into two sections while playing two layered Tones in the right-hand part.  
fig.d-layersplit.eps_60  
(Pedal Setting/ User  
Sh iftin g th e Ke y b o a rd Pitch in O cta ve Ste p s  
(O cta ve Sh ift)  
the pitch of the keyboards sound in octave units. This function is called “Octave  
Shift.”  
You cannot use Octave Shift  
when using a single tone for  
the entire keyboard or in the  
right-hand Tone during layer  
performances.  
For example, when using a layer performance, you can change the pitch of each  
sound and layer the sounds. You can make the pitch of the keyboards left-hand part  
match the pitch of the right-hand part during split performance.  
1 .  
On the Basic screen, touch <Layer> or <Split>.  
The KR-7/ 5 switches to layer performance or split performance.  
2 .  
3 .  
To apply Octave Shift, touch the name of the tone youve selected.  
Press the Tone button to display the Tone selection screen.  
fig.d-octshift.eps_60  
4 .  
Touch Octave <-> or <+> in the lower part of the screen to adjust the  
pitch of the sound.  
Each time you touch <+>, the pitch is raised one octave.  
Each time you touch <->, the pitch is lowered one octave.  
The sound can be changed from two octaves lower than the original sound (-2) to  
two octaves above the original (+2).  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Basic screen or the previous screen.  
3 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ad d in g Re ve rb e ra tio n to th e So u n d (Re ve rb )  
Apply a reverb effect to the notes you play with the KR-7/ 5.  
Reverb makes it sound as if you are playing in a concert hall.  
fig.panel1-3  
1 .  
Press the [Reverb] button and watch the its indicator light up.  
A “Reverb screen” like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-reverb.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
2 .  
Touch an icon to select the performance space.  
;
Display  
Ground  
Explanation  
Wide open space with no reverberations.  
Small room  
Room  
Lounge  
Studio  
Larger room  
A recording studio  
KR-7  
Gymnasium  
Hall  
In a gymnasium  
Large concert hall reverberation  
A domed ballpark  
Dome  
Cave  
Adds the extended reverberations found inside a cave  
GS Room 1  
GS Room 2  
GS Room 3  
GS Hall 1  
GS Hall 2  
Reproduces an indoor-type reverb.  
Provides a clear, expansive reverberation.  
Reproduces the reverberation found in a hall. Gives reverberation  
with a greater sense of depth than GS Room.  
Reproduces a plate echo (reverberation created using the vibrations  
of a metal plate).  
GS Plate  
GS Delay  
A delayed sound that is added to the original, similar to the reflected  
sounds of mountain echoes.  
GS Pan Delay The reflected sounds are panned (shifted) laterally.  
3 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
3 .  
Touch the slider beneath the icons to adjust the effect selected.  
No effect is applied when the  
slider is moved all the way to  
the left. In this case, the  
buttons indicator wont light  
up when you press the  
Touch and slide the knob on the screen to the right for a deeper reverb, and to the  
left for less.  
You can also move the slider with the [-] [+] buttons and the dial.  
Pressing the [-] [+] buttons simultaneously returns the slider to the initial value.  
When you touch <Exit>, the reverb effect is activated, and you return to the previous  
screen.  
[Reverb] button.  
Ca n ce llin g th e Effe ct  
Press the [Reverb] button, and watch the indicator light go out.  
4 .  
The reverb effect is eliminated.  
Ad d in g Th re e -Dim e n sio n a l Bre a d th to th e  
So u n d s Yo u Pla y (Ad va n ce d 3 D) (KR-7 )  
You can add three-dimensional breadth to the sounds you play with automatic  
“Advanced 3D,” you seem to be surrounded by the sound of the performance.  
fig.panel1-4  
1 .  
Press the [Advanced 3D] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The following “Advanced 3D screen” appears.  
fig.d-adv3d.eps_60  
ON  
OFF  
2 .  
Touch the icon to switch the effect on or off for each individual part.  
If all of the parts are switched  
off, the [Advanced 3D]  
Three-dimensional breadth is added to the performance part youve selected.  
When you touch <Exit>, the Advanced 3D effect is activated, and you return to the  
previous screen.  
buttons indicator wont light  
up when you press the button.  
Ca n ce llin g th e Effe ct  
Press the [Advanced 3D] button and watch the indicator goes out.  
3 .  
The Advanced 3D effect is eliminated, and the effect is no longer applied to any of  
the parts.  
3 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Se le ctin g th e to n e to w h ich th e e ffe ct is a p p lie d  
With “Keyboard” in Advanced 3D set to On, you can select the parts to which the 3D  
effect is to be applied when the keyboard is played.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Advanced 3D] button and watch the indicator light up.  
On the Advanced 3D screen, touch <Option>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-adv3dopt.eps_60  
3 .  
Touch <All Parts> or <Layer Part>.  
Display  
Explanation  
The effect is applied to all tones played with the keyboard (the left-  
hand tone, right-hand tone, and layer tone).  
All Parts  
The effect is applied only to the layer part.  
is not applied to the keyboard performance, even if <Keyboard> on  
the Advance 3D screen is set to On.  
Layer Part  
When you touch <Exit>, you return to the Advanced 3D screen.  
3 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ad ju stin g th e So u n d to Ach ie ve th e Pre fe rre d  
To n e Q u a lity (Eq u a lize r) (KR-7 )  
The KR-7 features a built-in, five-band digital equalizer.  
An equalizer boosts or cuts specific sound pitches (frequency ranges) to adjust the  
sound balance for the overall performance. For example, you can boost the highs to  
get a crisper sound, or boost the low end for a more powerful sound.  
You can also adjust the sound to compensate for the acoustical characteristics of the  
performance space.  
If raising the slider for each frequency ends up distorting the sound, you can correct  
the distortion with the Master Level slider.  
1 .  
Press the [Equalizer] button.  
The “Equalizer screen” appears.  
fig.d-eq.eps_60  
When <Flat> is selected (when  
all sliders are at “0”), then even  
when [Equalizer] is pressed,  
the indicator does not light up.  
2 .  
Touch the Type icon to make your selection.  
Display  
Bottom  
Power  
Mild  
Explanation  
This setting greatly boosts the low end.  
Boosts both the low- and high-frequency ranges.  
Lows and highs are restrained for a pleasant-sounding tone.  
This setting slightly boosts the midrange for a simple pop feeling.  
This setting boosts the high frequencies for a brilliant, sparkling sound.  
All slider values are set to “0.”  
Clear  
Bright  
Flat  
User  
3 .  
Touch the slider to make adjustment.  
Settings  
Displayed  
Description  
Value  
Low-frequency range. This is the range of frequen-  
cies for instruments like drums, bass, organ, guitar  
and strings.  
Low  
-
-60–0–60  
-60–0–60  
Mid-low-frequency range. This is the range of fre-  
quencies for lower brass and woodwind instru-  
ments.  
3 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Settings  
Value  
Displayed  
Mid  
Description  
Midrange. This is the range of frequencies where  
most instrument sounds are concentrated.  
-60–0–60  
-60–0–60  
-60–0–60  
Mid-high-frequency range. The ear is most sensi-  
tive to this frequency range.  
-
High-frequency range. These frequencies add bril-  
liance to the sound.  
High  
You can temper the distortion in the sound by low-  
ering the level. Raising the level too much may  
cause the sound to become distorted.  
Master Level  
-60–0–60  
You can also move the slider with the [-] [+] buttons and the dial.  
Pressing the [-] [+] buttons simultaneously returns the slider to “0.”  
When you touch <Exit>, the equalization is placed in effect, and you return to the  
previous screen.  
Ca n ce llin g th e e ffe ct  
4 .  
Press the [Equalizer] button and watch the indicator light go out.  
The equalizer effect is cancelled.  
Sto rin g th e se ttin g s  
You can store adjusted equalizer settings to <User>.  
Even after editing the settings, you can touch <User> to call up your preferred  
settings.  
1 .  
Press the [Equalizer] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The Equalizer screen appears.  
2 .  
3 .  
Adjust the equalizer.  
Touch <Write>.  
The settings are stored.  
Even after editing the settings, you can touch <User> to select the stored settings.  
3 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ad d in g Effe cts to Ea ch To n e a n d Vo ice  
Ap p ly in g Effe cts to th e So u n d (Effe cts)  
You can apply a wide range of different effects to the notes you play on the  
For more on the effect types,  
keyboard.  
1 .  
The “Tone selection screen” appears.  
fig.d-octshift.eps_60  
2 .  
Then, touch <Effects>.  
The “Effect screen” appears.  
fig.d-effects.eps_60  
N O TE  
Selecting a different effect for  
the left-hand Tone than the  
one applied to the right-hand  
Tone and Layer Tone may not  
result in the effect you want.  
Select the same effect as that  
used for the right-hand Tone.  
Ap p ly in g e ffe cts to th e so u n d  
N O TE  
When you select an effect type  
that starts with “GS,” that type  
of effect is also applied for the  
chorus effect for the song or  
that time.  
3 .  
Touch <ON>.  
The effect selected with <Type> will be applied.  
Se ttin g th e Effe ct  
4 .  
5 .  
Touch <Type>  
to select the type of effect.  
Touch <Depth>  
to adjust the amount of effect applied.  
The amount increases as the value is raised.  
You can also move the slider with the [-] [+] buttons and the dial.  
Pressing the [-] [+] buttons simultaneously returns the slider to the initial value.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Tone selection screen.  
3 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ca n ce llin g th e Effe ct  
On the Effects screen, touch <Off>.  
All [Voice] button tones with a  
6 .  
“GS” or “ ” logo appearing  
after the tone name have the  
same effect applied to them. If  
the effect for one of the tones  
About the Effect Settings  
When the effects is set to ON, the appropriate effect is applied for the currently  
selected sound. You can also apply different effect types to each tone (except GS  
with the “GS” or “ ” logo is  
changed, then the effects for  
the other tones with the “GS”  
tones and tones with the “ ” logo). Although turning off the power returns effects  
store the settings even after the power is turned off.  
or “ ” logo are also changed  
automatically.  
Ad d in g Effe cts to Mic Vo ca ls (Vo ca l Effe ct) (KR-7 )  
With a microphone connected, you can add effects to the microphone vocals.  
Adding effects to the vocals is referred to as “Vocal Effect.”  
For details on connecting a  
microphone, refer to  
Ho w to se le ct Vo ca l Effe ct  
fig.panel1-5  
1 .  
Press the [Vocal Effect] button.  
The “Vocal Effects screen” appears.  
fig.d-vocalsfx.eps_60  
2 .  
Touch any one of the icons.  
Icon  
Description  
Page  
Echo  
Adjusts the microphone echo.  
Alters the microphone vocals.  
Adds harmonies to the original voice.  
Transformer  
Harmonist  
3 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Icon  
Description  
Page  
Allows you to start songs and Automatic Accom-  
paniment using your own tempo.  
Vocal Count In  
Vocal Keyboard  
Music Files  
Allows you to produce sounds conforming to the  
vocal scale.  
You can play a specific part as harmony while  
playing back a song.  
3 .  
When you touch <Exit>, the effect is applied and you return to the  
previous screen.  
Ca n ce llin g th e Vo ca l Effe ct  
Press the [Vocal Effect] button and watch the indicator light go out.  
4 .  
The Vocal Effect function is cancelled.  
Ad ju stin g th e Ech o (Ech o )  
1 .  
fig.d-vo-echo.eps_60  
2 .  
3 .  
Touch the bar graph to adjust the amount of echo applied to the vocal.  
Touch the Echo Type <1> or <2> to change the echo type.  
Displayed  
Description  
Adds basic reverberations.  
Adds reverberations for a karaoke-type echo.  
1
2
Touch <Exit> to return to the Vocal Effects screen.  
3 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Alte rin g Vo ca ls (Tra n sfo rm e r)  
When you use the Voice  
Transformer function, the  
resonance setting for the piano  
reset.  
With the KR-7, you can modify the way your voice sounds through the microphone.  
This is called the “Voice Transformer” function.  
1 .  
fig.d-vo-trans.eps_60  
2 .  
Touch any one of the icons.  
Heres what the different icons do.  
Display  
Child  
Explanation  
Transforms the input into the sound of a childs voice.  
Transforms the input sound into the voice of a large animal.  
Transforms the input into the sound of a robots voice.  
Transforms the input into a ducks quacking sound.  
Transforms the input into an alien voice.  
Bear  
Robot  
Duck  
Alien  
Computer  
Female  
Male  
Transforms the input into a voice like that from a computer.  
Transforms male voices into female voices.  
Transforms female voices into male voices.  
3 .  
Sing through the microphone.  
Your voice is transformed according to the item you selected.  
Ca n ce llin g th e Effe ct  
Once again, touch the icon you selected in Step 2.  
4 .  
The Voice Transformer effect is eliminated.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Vocal Effects screen.  
3 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ad d in g Ha rm o n ie s (Ha rm o n ist)  
When you use the Harmonist  
function, the resonance setting  
sometimes be reset. And the  
effects applied to the keyboard  
You can sing with a harmony accompaniment, even when youre playing solo. This  
is called the “Harmonist” function.  
1 .  
fig.d-vo-harmo.eps_60  
2 .  
Touch any one of the icons.  
Heres what the different icons do.  
Display  
Duet  
Explanation  
Provides an effect resembling the sound of two people singing  
the same melody.  
Oct-Up  
Adds another voice one octave higher than the original.  
Adds another voice one octave lower than the original.  
The melody being played on the keyboard becomes the harmony.  
Adds harmony a fifth above the original.  
Oct-Down  
Keyboard  
5th Up  
3rd Up  
Adds harmony a third above the original.  
4th Down  
Chords  
Adds harmony a major fourth below the original.  
Adds harmonies matching the chords designated with the keys.  
Ca n ce llin g th e Effe ct  
Touch the Harmonist type you selected in Step 2 again.  
3 .  
The Harmonist function is cancelled.  
Touch <Exit> to go back to the Vocal Effects screen.  
4 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
En a b lin g th e sta rt o f so n g s a n d a u to m a tic a cco m p a n im e n t w ith th e  
so u n d o f y o u r vo ice (Vo ca l Co u n t-In )  
You can start songs and the Automatic Accompaniment by counting into the  
microphone.  
1 .  
fig.d-vo-coin.eps_60  
2 .  
3 .  
Touch <Arranger> or <Song>.  
Display  
Arranger  
Song  
Explanation  
Automatic Accompaniment starts at the tempo used for the count.  
The song starts at the tempo used for the count.  
Count to four (“One, two, three, four”) into the mic.  
Count out the number of beats per measure in the time signature of the selected song  
or Music Style.  
For example, if you select a time signature of 4/ 4, then count to four; count to three  
when 3/ 4 time is selected.  
The tempo is automatically set according to the interval between the counts as you  
speak into the microphone, and the song begins.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Vocal Effects screen.  
Pla y in g in stru m e n t so u n d s a t vo ca l p itch e s (Vo ca l Ke y b o a rd )  
You can have melodies sung into the microphone played with the KR-7s internal  
Tones.  
1 .  
fig.d-vo-key.eps_60  
4 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
2 .  
3 .  
If the <OFF> icon is selected, touch the <ON> icon.  
When you play the keys while  
using Vocal Keyboard, the  
tone selected for Vocal  
Touch any of the icons to select a Tone.  
You can also select the Tone by pressing the Tone button.  
Keyboard is played.  
When you sing into the microphone, the sung pitches are played using the selected  
Tone.  
Ca n ce llin g th e e ffe ct  
4 .  
Touch <OFF>.  
The Vocal Keyboard function is cancelled.  
Touch <Exit> to go back to the Vocal Effects screen.  
Ad d in g h a rm o n ie s to a sp e cifie d p a rt (Mu sic File s)  
When you sing while playing back a specified song data part, the harmony is added  
using the pitches of the specified part.  
1 .  
2 .  
Select the song to which you want to add harmony.  
If selecting a song on a disk, insert the floppy disk in the disk drive. For more on how  
fig.d-vo-music.eps_60  
3 .  
Touch the icon for the part to which you want to add harmony.  
When you sing into the microphone, harmony is added using the pitches of the  
specified part.  
Ca n ce llin g th e e ffe ct  
Touch the icon you selected in Step 3 again.  
4 .  
The Music Files function is cancelled.  
Touch <Exit> to go back to the Vocal Effects screen.  
4 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
En jo y in g Ka ra o k e Pe rfo rm a n ce s w ith Mu sic File s  
Commercial music files  
1 .  
2 .  
Connect a microphone.  
designed for “karaoke” sing-  
along are also available.  
Adjust the volume level and the amount of echo applied.  
Consult your KR-7/ 5 dealer  
when purchasing music files.  
On the KR-5, adjust the echo with the Echo adjustment knob on the instruments  
3 .  
Select a song.  
If selecting a song on a disk, insert the floppy disk in the disk drive. For instructions  
On the KR-7, lyrics can also be  
shown on an external display.  
4 .  
5 .  
Adjust the tempo as required with the Tempo [-] [+] buttons.  
When you press the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button, the accompaniment starts playing.  
Sing along with the accompaniment.  
You can stop lyrics from being  
When you play back a Music File with lyrics, the lyrics appear on screen.  
6 .  
Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button to stop the accompaniment.  
4 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Usin g th e Me tro n o m e a n d Rh y th m  
(Rh y th m Pa rtn e r)  
During playback of a song, or  
when performing with  
The KR-7/ 5 features a built-in metronome. Additionally, you can have Rhythm  
patterns play, in the same manner as the metronome, just by pressing the [Rhythm]  
button.  
automatic accompaniment, the  
sound of the metronome keeps  
time with the beat of the song  
or accompaniment.  
The combination of the internal metronome and rhythm functions is called “Rhythm  
Partner.”  
fig.panel1-6  
Usin g th e Me tro n o m e  
1 .  
Press the [Metronome] button and watch the indicator light up.  
It is not possible to use the  
simultaneously.  
You will hear the metronome.  
The following “Metronome screen” appears.  
fig.d-metro.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
You can touch <Exit> to have the metronome continue to play while you return to  
the previous screen.  
Sto p p in g th e m e tro n o m e  
2 .  
Press the [Metronome] button once more, and the indicator light goes  
out.  
4 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ch a n g in g th e Me tro n o m e Se ttin g s  
Ad ju stin g th e te m p o  
You can adjust the tempo of the metronome. The tempo of the metronome changes  
automatically if you use an Automatic Accompaniment or play back a song.  
1 .  
Press the Tempo [-] or [+] buttons to adjust a tempo.  
You can also use the dial to  
adjust the tempo. Turn it  
clockwise for a faster tempo, or  
counterclockwise for a slower  
tempo.  
You can adjust the metronome tempo over a range of  
= 20–250.  
The metronome is automatically set to =108 when the power is turned on.  
Pressing the [-] and [+] buttons simultaneously returns the selected song  
accompaniment to the basic tempo.  
De te rm in in g th e te m p o w ith te m p o m a rk s  
You can set the tempo by choosing a tempo indicator, such as “Allegro,” indicated  
on the score.  
1 .  
On the Metronome screen, touch the tempo indicator bar graph.  
The tempo is set to match the tempo mark.  
fig.d-metro.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
Ch a n g in g th e b e a t o f th e m e tro n o m e  
1 .  
2 .  
On the Metronome screen, touch <Beat>.  
The available choices for the beat appear at the bottom of the screen.  
Choose the beat from among the selections by touching your choice.  
You can scroll the display to one side or the other and show other choices for the beat  
When  
is selected,  
by touching  
.
only the upbeat will sound.  
4 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ch a n g in g th e vo lu m e  
The volume of the metronome can be adjusted to ten different levels.  
1 .  
2 .  
On the Metronome screen, touch <Volume>.  
The available choices for the volume level appear at the bottom of the screen.  
Touch the volume icon youve selected.  
When you touch  
, the selection moves to the side, allowing you to access  
other volume levels.  
Choosing  
sets the volume to the lowest level, and choosing  
sets  
it to the highest level.  
Choose  
to silence the metronome sound.  
Ch a n g in g th e Ty p e o f So u n d  
You can change the sound the metronome makes.  
The setting is at “normal metronome sound” when the KR-7/ 5 is powered up.  
1 .  
2 .  
On the Metronome screen, touch <Sound>.  
The available choices for the type of sound appear at the bottom of the screen.  
Touch one of the items in the group to select a metronome sound.  
Displayed  
Description  
Displayed  
Description  
Normal metronome  
sound  
Electronic metronome  
sound  
“1, 2, 3” in Japanese  
Dog and cat sounds  
Triangle and castanet  
“1, 2, 3” in English  
Wood block  
Hand clap  
4 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ch a n g in g th e An im a tio n  
A metronome that moves along with the tempo is usually displayed at the center of  
the Metronome screen. You can change that picture to an animated bouncing ball, or  
other animation.  
1 .  
On the Metronome screen, touch the <Type>.  
The animation type will change.  
Each time you touch the icon, the animation switches between “Metronome,” “Dr.  
KR,” and “Bouncing Ball.”  
Ch a n g in g h o w th e m e tro n o m e b e a t (p a tte rn ) so u n d s  
You can set the Metronome to play at even smaller intervals.  
1 .  
2 .  
On the Metronome screen, touch <Pattern>.  
The available choices for the metronome pattern appear at the bottom of the screen.  
Choose a pattern by touching your choice.  
You can scroll the display to one side or the other and show other pattern choices by  
touching  
.
Displayed  
Description  
Displayed  
Description  
Usual sound  
Dotted half-note intervals  
Dotted quarter-note  
intervals  
Half-note intervals  
Quarter-note intervals  
Eighth-note intervals  
Single back beat added  
Shuffle rhythm added  
Dotted eighth-note  
intervals  
Sixteenth-note intervals  
Triplet rhythm added  
4 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Pla y in g Rh y th m  
The KR-7/ 5 features numerous internal rhythm patterns, which, like the  
You cannot have the  
metronome or automatic  
accompaniment play  
metronome, can be played and stopped with the press of a single button.  
Playing rhythm patterns instead of the metronome lets you enjoy performances that  
feel like live sessions.  
simultaneously with the  
Rhythm. When you start  
playing the metronome or  
automatic accompaniment  
while a Rhythm is playing, the  
Rhythm stops.  
1 .  
Press the [Rhythm] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The Rhythm will sound.  
The following “Rhythm screen” appears.  
fig.d-rhythm.eps_60  
When you touch <Exit>, the Rhythm sound continues to play, as you return to the  
previous screen.  
Sto p p in g th e Rh y th m  
2 .  
Press the [Rhythm] button once more and the indicator light goes out.  
Ch a n g in g th e Rh y th m se ttin g s  
Depending on the beat, there  
may be only one Rhythm to  
choose form.  
Ch a n g in g th e Rh y th m  
1 .  
Touch a Rhythm name on the Rhythm screen.  
The selected Rhythm plays.  
The Rhythms available for selection will depend on the beat.  
Touch  
to switch the screens and show other choices.  
For more on the Rhythm types,  
Ch a n g in g th e b e a t o f Rh y th m  
1 .  
2 .  
In the Rhythm screen, touch <Beat>.  
The available choices for the beat appear at the bottom of the screen.  
Choose the beat by touching your choice.  
You can scroll the display to one side or the other and show other choices by  
touching  
.
4 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 1 Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ch a n g in g th e vo lu m e  
The rhythm volume can be adjusted to ten different levels.  
1 .  
2 .  
On the Rhythm screen, touch <Volume>.  
The available choices for volume level appear at the bottom of the screen.  
Select a volume icon.  
When you touch  
, the selection moves to the side, allowing you to access  
other volume levels.  
Choosing  
sets the volume to the lowest level, and choosing  
sets  
it to the highest level.  
Choose  
to silence the Rhythm sound.  
4 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Mu sic Sty le s a n d Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
W h a t is Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t?  
For instructions on playing the  
Press the KR-7/ 5’s One Touch Program [Arranger] button for Automatic  
Accompaniments optimum settings. Automatic Accompaniment is a function that  
provides you with accompaniment in a variety of musical genres, just by specifying  
chords in the left hand. Automatic Accompaniment lets you play with an orchestra,  
even when performing alone!  
Automatic Accompaniment,  
W h a t Are Mu sic Sty le s?  
Accompaniment patterns in various musical genres are called “Music Styles.”  
There are many different kinds of music around the world, and each has its own  
unique features. What gives jazz or classical music their unmistakable sounds are a  
unique combination of elements like instrumentation, melody, and phrasing, which  
interact to create the musical character.  
Ele m e n ts o f Mu sic Sty le s  
A Music Style consists of a set of six sections called “divisions.”  
Division  
Intro  
Description  
Played at the start of a song.  
Original  
The basic accompaniment pattern.  
Variation  
This is a variation on the Original accompaniment pattern.  
This is a one-measure phrase inserted at a point where the  
mood changes and the accompaniment returns to the original.  
Fill In To Original  
This is a one-measure phrase inserted at a point where the  
mood changes and the accompaniment moves ahead to the  
variation.  
Fill In To  
Variation  
Ending  
The conclusion of a song.  
In addition, Music Styles are built from: “Rhythm,” “Bass,” “Accompaniment 1,”  
“Accompaniment 2,” and “Accompaniment 3.”  
5 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Pe rfo rm in g Usin g Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
(O n e -To u ch Arra n g e r)  
Heres how to create the settings for Automatic Accompaniment.  
fig.panel2-1  
1 .  
Press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button.  
When you select an internal  
song or music file that includes  
the lyrics data, <lyrics>  
The Basic screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-arrbasic.eps_60  
appears in the Piano screen or  
Basic screen. Touch this to  
display the lyrics.  
Normally, when you change a  
Music Style, the tempo and  
tone change to selections that  
go well with the selected  
Music Style. If you do not want  
to change the tempo and tone,  
Styles Without Changing the  
Tone or Tempo (One Touch  
Observe the settings:  
The keyboard is split into left- and right-hand parts, with accompaniment  
chords specified for the left-hand side of the keyboard.  
A tone appropriate for the selected Music Style is chosen.  
The tempo and beat for the selected Music Style is set.  
For instructions on selecting  
Music Styles, refer to  
2 .  
Play a chord on the lower-part of keyboard.  
The accompaniment begins, starting from the intro.  
Play chords with the left hand, and the melody with the right.  
When you change chords in the left hand, the accompaniment also changes.  
fig.arr-split.e  
Split Point (  
)
F
3
For instructions on starting  
and stopping the  
accompaniment, refer to  
The range specifyed a chord  
3 .  
Press the [Intro/Ending] button.  
You can change the range in  
which chords are played.  
After the ending plays, the accompaniment stops.  
5 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Ab o u t Ch o rd s  
A chord is produced when several notes are played simultaneously. Chords are  
indicated by the pitch of the fundamental note of the chord (the root) and the chord  
type, which is determined by the other notes of the chord.  
For example, the C m chord is expressed in terms of the root note “C” and the chord  
type “m” (minor). C m is made up of the three notes “C,” “E ” and “G.”  
“C m” is indicated as the chord name on the Basic screen.  
fig.chord.e  
Cm  
E
Chord Type  
Root Note  
C
G
Root Note  
All chord roots are indicated as a letter, sometimes with  
correspond to the notes shown below.  
or  
added, and  
fig.chord-root.e  
Pla y in g Ch o rd s w ith Sim p le Fin g e rin g  
(Ch o rd In te llig e n ce )  
“Chord Intelligence” is a feature that chooses the accompaniment chords the  
You can cancel the Chord  
Intelligence function. For more  
How Chords Are Played and  
Specified (Arranger Config)”  
moment you play a key.  
To play a “C” chord, for example, you normally have to play the three keys C, E, and  
G. But with Chord Intelligence, you only have to press the C key to start a “C” chord  
accompaniment.  
fig.chord-intel.e  
• How to play chords in the Chord Intelligence mode:  
Major  
Minor  
Ex: C m  
Ex:  
C
Play the root and  
the third key above it.  
Play the chord root.  
For more information about  
chord fingering, refer to the  
Minor Seventh  
Seventh  
Ex: C 7  
Ex: C m7  
Play the root,  
Play the root and  
the third key above it, and  
the second key below it.  
the second key above it.  
Major Seventh  
Diminished  
Ex: C maj 7  
Ex:  
C dim  
Play the root and  
the first key below it.  
Play the root and  
the sixth key above it.  
5 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Vie w in g Ch o rd Fin g e rin g s (Ch o rd Fin d e r)  
Whenever you are not sure how a certain chord is fingered, you can display the notes  
of the chord on the screen.  
1 .  
On the Basic screen, touch <  
>.  
fig.d-arrbasic.eps_60  
2 .  
Touch the root of the chord you want to learn about.  
The chord fingering appears on screen.  
fig.d-crdfind.eps_60  
For example, if you wanted to see the fingering for a C# chord, you would touch  
<C>, then touch <#>.  
Touch <Exit> to go back to the Basic screen.  
5 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Se le ctin g Mu sic Sty le s (Mu sic Sty le Bu tto n s)  
You can select a variety of different Music Styles by pressing the Music Style buttons.  
Music Styles are divided into six groups, with each assigned to one of the Music Style  
buttons.  
fig.panel2-2  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button.  
For more on the Music Style  
names, refer to the “Music  
Press one of the Music Style buttons to select the Music Style group.  
Watch the indicator button light up.  
Six of the Music Styles included in that group are displayed on the screen.  
fig.d-stylesel.eps_60  
This screen is called the “Style Selection screen”.  
You can listen to the Music Style by touching <Audition>.  
Touch  
to switch the screen and display the next selections.  
3 .  
4 .  
Select a Music Style, and touch the Music Style name.  
You can use the [-] [+] buttons and the dial to automatically switch pages and select  
Styles.  
By changing the tempo and  
Tone, you can enjoy  
Touch Preset <A>, <B>, <C>, or <D> in the lower part of the screen.  
performing with a different  
ambience, even in the same  
Music Style.  
When the Music Style is selected, Preset A is selected.  
When any of the Presets from <A> through <D> are selected, the Music Style tempo,  
5 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
5 .  
Touch <Exit>.  
The display returns to the Basic screen.  
When you play a chord in the left-hand part of the keyboard, the selected Music Style  
is automatic.  
Se le ctin g Mu sic Sty le s o n Disk s  
fig.panel2-3  
1 .  
2 .  
If youre using the disk drive  
for the first time, be sure to  
read the important notes on  
p. 6.  
Press the Music Style [User] button.  
fig.d-styldisk.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
When you touch <User/ Disk> on the lower part of the screen, the screen for  
selecting user memory or disk Styles appears.  
When you touch <Preset>, the screen for selecting “Trad/ Kids” Music Styles  
appears.  
3 .  
Touch  
. (KR-7)  
The Music Styles saved on the disk are displayed.  
When you touch <  
>, the Music Styles stored in User memory are displayed.  
4 .  
5 .  
Select a Music Style, and touch the Music Style name.  
Press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button.  
On the KR-7, you can save  
multiple user Styles to user  
memory. Take a look at  
You can now perform in the selected Music Style.  
Music Styles selected from floppy disks are stored until the power is turned off. Even  
after ejecting the floppy disk, by pressing the Music Style [User] button, you can  
perform using the most recently selected Music Style.  
5 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Usin g Ke y w o rd s to Se a rch fo r Mu sic Sty le s  
(Sty le Se a rch )  
You can search for Music Styles that match the tempo of the song, musical genre, or  
other criteria you set.  
Only the KR-7/ 5’s internal  
Music Styles are searchable.  
You can also search Music Styles using the first character of the Style names.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press one of the Music Style buttons.  
Touch <Search>.  
The following “Style Search screen” appears.  
fig.d-stylsrch1.eps_60  
Co n d itio n Se a rch scre e n  
N a m e Se a rch scre e n  
Touch here to switch these screens.  
In a condition search, the KR-  
7/ 5 looks for Music Styles  
satisfying all of the selected  
search criteria.  
Se a rch in g b y Co n d itio n s  
3 .  
4 .  
Touch the parameter you want to set, then use the [-] [+] buttons and the  
dial to select the search conditions.  
Touch <Search>.  
The search results appear in the display.  
Touch a Music Style name to select a Music Style.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Style Search screen.  
Se a rch in g b y Mu sic Sty le n a m e  
3 .  
4 .  
Touch <By Name>.  
Touch <By Key> to return to the Condition Search screen.  
Decide which character youll use for the search.  
The selected character appears in the middle of the screen.  
Enter the character you are searching for. For example, touching <ABC> in  
succession cycles you through the available choices in that character group  
(“A”B”C”...).  
Touch <A-0> to toggle between alphabets and numerals.  
5 .  
Touch <Search>.  
The search results appear on the display.  
Touch a Music Style name to select a Music Style.  
Touch <Exit> several times to return to the Basic screen or the previous screen.  
5 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Pla y in g O n ly Mu sic Sty le Rh y th m Pa tte rn s  
You can also play only the rhythm patterns of Music Styles.  
fig.panel2-4  
N O TE  
1 .  
2 .  
Some Music Styles do not  
include rhythm patterns.  
When you select these Style  
patterns, no rhythm patterns  
are played, even when you  
play on the left side of the  
keyboard.  
Press the One Touch Program [Piano] button.  
The performance is set so that only the rhythm patterns are played.  
3 .  
Press the [Intro/Ending] button.  
The Rhythm part of accompaniment begins, starting from the Intro.  
Just as with regular Automatic Accompaniment, you can add intros and endings by  
pressing the [Intro/ Ending] button, and make changes to the rhythm patterns with  
Ad ju stin g th e Acco m p a n im e n t Te m p o  
fig.panel2-5  
When the Basic screen is displayed, you can use the Tempo [-] [+] buttons or the [-]  
[+] buttons and the dial to change the tempo.  
The tempo is indicated on the upper left of the screen.  
fig.d-arrbasic.eps_60  
Pressing the [-] [+] buttons simultaneously returns the selected Music Style or song  
to the basic tempo.  
You can change the tempo of Automatic Accompaniment even while the  
accompaniment is playing.  
5 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Sta rtin g a n d Sto p p in g th e Acco m p a n im e n t  
Pressing the One Touch Program [Arranger] button activates Sync Start for the  
accompaniment (which starts the accompaniment simultaneously when you play on  
the lower section of the keyboard), and automatically sets an appropriate intro for  
the accompaniment. You can also change the way the accompaniment starts and  
stops.  
fig.panel2-6  
Ha vin g th e Acco m p a n im e n t Sta rt Sim u lta n e o u sly  
W h e n Yo u Pla y th e Ke y b o a rd (Sy n c)  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Intro/Ending] button and [Start/Stop] button simultaneously,  
causing the indicators of both buttons to flash.  
The Sync Start settings go into effect.  
Sync Start is set immediately  
after the One Touch Program  
[Arranger] button is pressed.  
Play a chord on the lower-part of keyboard.  
As you play the keys, the intro and accompaniment begins simultaneously.  
Ch a n g in g th e in tro  
When set for Sync Start (the indicators of both the [Intro/ Ending] button and [Start/  
Stop] button are flashing), you can use the following procedure to change the intro,  
or prevent the intro from playing.  
Sta rtin g w ith o u t a n in tro  
Press the [Intro/Ending] button and watch the indicator go out.  
Now when you play a chord with the keyboard, the accompaniment starts without  
the intro.  
To sta rt w ith a sh o rt in tro a d d e d  
On the Basic screen, touch the Intro/Ending Type <2>.  
fig.d-intro2.eps_60  
Now when you specify a chord with the keyboard, a short intro is played, and the  
accompaniment starts.  
5 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Sta rtin g a t th e p re ss o f a b u tto n  
1 .  
Press the [Intro/Ending] button and [Start/Stop] button simultaneously,  
and the indicators lights go out.  
The Sync Start function is cancelled.  
2 .  
3 .  
Play a chord on the lower part of keyboard.  
Choose the chord to be played when the accompaniment begins playing.  
Press the [Intro/Ending] button or the [Start/Stop] button.  
When you press the [Intro/ Ending] button, the intro plays, and the accompaniment  
starts. When you press the [Start/ Stop] button, the accompaniment starts without  
the intro.  
When you press the [Intro/ Ending] button after touching Intro/ Ending Type <2> on  
the Basic screen, a short intro plays.  
You can change the sound of  
the chord tone and bass tone.  
Chords Are Played and  
Specified (Arranger Config)”  
Chord Tones and Bass Tones  
When you play the keys in the left-hand side of the keyboard while the [Start/ Stop]  
buttons indicator is not lit, chords play. This note is called the “Chord Tone,” and  
the root of the chord being played at the same time is called the “Bass Tone.”  
Sto p p in g Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Sto p p in g w ith a n a d d e d e n d in g  
1 .  
Press the [Intro/Ending] button.  
An ending plays and the Automatic Accompaniment stops.  
When you press the [Intro/ Ending] button after touching Intro/ Ending Type <2> on  
the Basic screen, a short ending plays.  
Sto p p in g a t th e sa m e tim e th e b u tto n is p re sse d  
1 .  
Press the [Start/Stop] button.  
The Automatic Accompaniment stops as soon as you press the button.  
5 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Ha vin g a Co u n t So u n d Pla y a t th e En d o f th e  
In tro (Co u n td o w n )  
If an intro plays before your performance, you can have a count-in sound played to  
the end of the intro, helping you hear when to start playing.  
fig.countdown.e  
When the Intro has finished playing,  
the accompaniment plays.  
Ex: 4/4  
Intro  
1
2
3
4
Count Sound  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Metronome] button and watch the indicator light up.  
If you dont want the metronome to play, press the [Metronome] button and  
indicator light goes out.  
Touch <Countdown>.  
The following “Countdown settings screen” appears.  
fig.d-cntdwn.eps_60  
3 .  
Touch <Switch>  
to set this to “ON.”  
When you press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button, the performance starts,  
and the countdown sound plays at the end of the intro.  
Ca n ce llin g th e co u n td o w n  
1 .  
2 .  
In the Metronome screen, touch <Countdown>.  
For more about settings on the  
Countdown screen, refer to  
Touch <Switch>  
to set this to “OFF.”  
This sets the KR-7/ 5 so that the countdown does not play.  
6 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Mo d ify in g a n Acco m p a n im e n t  
You can add variation to the  
When you use Automatic Accompaniment, you can easily add Fill Ins to the  
accompaniment patterns, change arrangements, and make other changes.  
Automatic Accompaniment by  
assigning different functions to  
the Performance Pads and  
pedals. For more information,  
Pedals and Performance Pads  
(Pedal Setting/ User  
Ch a n g in g th e Acco m p a n im e n t Pa tte rn  
(Fill In Bu tto n s)  
There are two accompaniment patterns: the Original, and a Variation. In addition, a  
fill-in (or short phrase) is added at the points where the accompaniment patterns  
change, which adds more interest to the song. It can be effective to use the simpler  
original pattern for the first half of the song, and the variation pattern for the second  
half.  
What’s a “Fill In”?  
A short improvisational phrase inserted at the bar line is called a “Fill In.”  
The KR-7/ 5 automatically plays the appropriate phrase for the selected Music Style.  
fig.panel2-7  
Press the Fill In [Variation] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The instrument is set so that the variation performance pattern is played.  
Press the Fill In [Original] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The instrument is set so that the original performance pattern is played.  
Pressing these buttons during a performance inserts a one-bar fill-in at the  
appropriate place and time.  
Ad d in g a fill-in w ith o u t ch a n g in g th e a cco m p a n im e n t p a tte rn  
You can play only the fill-in, without changing the accompaniment pattern.  
Press the lit [Original] or [Variation] Fill In button during the performance.  
6 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Ch a n g in g th e In strum e n ta l Ma k e up o f Music Style s  
(Style O rch e stra to r)  
You can change the arrangement of an accompaniment. This function is called “Style  
Orchestrator.” Each Music Style has four different accompaniment arrangements.  
fig.panel2-8  
<KR-7 >  
When you press the [Phrase]  
button or [User Function]  
buttons, the [Style  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Style Orchestrator] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The instrument is set to allow you to change the arrangement with the Performance Pads.  
Orchestrator] buttons  
indicator goes out, and the  
function of the Performance  
Pads changes. For details refer  
Press Performance Pad [1]–[4] to change the arrangement for the  
accompaniment.  
Watch the indicator of the button you pressed light up.  
Pad [1] plays the simplest arrangement, and Pad [4] gives you the most elaborate  
arrangement.  
<KR-5 >  
Press the [Style Orchestrator/User Function] button and watch the  
N O TE  
When simple Music Styles are  
selected, there may be no  
change in the arrangement  
even when you use the Style  
Orchestrator function.  
1 .  
indicator light up.  
This enables you to change the arrangement with the Performance Pad [1] or [2] button.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-phrase.eps_60  
You cannot change the  
orchestration of the Styles with  
the Performance Pad when the  
[Style Orchestrator/ User  
Function] buttons indicator is  
Functions to Pedals and  
Setting/ User Functions)” (p.  
The Style Orchestrator value assigned to the current Pad is indicated.  
Display  
Basic  
Explanation  
This is the simplest arrangement.  
Advanced 1  
Advanced 2  
Full  
This is a more involved arrangement.  
This is the most elavorate arrangement.  
You can change the arrangement assigned to Pad [1] or [2] by touching  
.
6 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
2 .  
3 .  
Touch <Exit>.  
You are returned to the previous screen.  
Press the [1] or [2] button to change the arrangement of the  
accompaniment.  
Pla y in g Ph ra se s (Ph ra se ) (KR-7 )  
fig.panel2-9  
1 .  
Press the [Phrase] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The instrument is set so that phrases play with the Performance Pads.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-phrase.eps_60  
When you switch Music Styles,  
the phrases assigned to the  
Performance Pads are  
switched. If you do not want to  
have the phrase settings  
change when you change  
Music Styles, refer to  
“Changing Music Styles  
Tempo (One Touch Setting)”  
2 .  
3 .  
Touch  
to choose the type of phrase.  
Press one of the Pads.  
The selected phrase plays.  
When the phrase continues playing, press the Pad once more to stop it.  
With certain phrases, the accompaniment stops while the phrase is playing.  
When you touch <Exit>, youre returned to the previous screen, while the same  
function remains assigned to the Pads.  
6 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Ad d in g Ha rm o n y to th e Rig h t-Ha n d  
Pa rt (Me lo d y In te llig e n ce )  
You can add harmony to the notes you play on the keyboard.  
While an Automatic Accompaniment is playing, the matching harmony is  
automatically added to the notes you are playing with the right hand. This function  
is called “Melody Intelligence.”  
fig.panel2-10  
1 .  
Press the [Melody Intelligence] button and watch the indicator light up.  
When you play something on the right-hand section of the keyboard, harmony is  
added.  
The following “Melody Intelligence screen” appears.  
fig.d-melointel.eps_60  
2 .  
3 .  
Select and touch a harmony type.  
Then when you play a melody on the keyboard, a harmony style is automatically  
added.  
With some harmonies, Tones  
may change automatically.  
Also, when you play several  
keys at the same time, in some  
cases harmony may be added  
to one note.  
When you touch <Exit>, youre returned to the previous screen, while the Melody  
Intelligence function remains selected.  
Press the [Melody Intelligence] button once more and the indicator light  
goes out.  
The Melody Intelligence function is cancelled.  
6 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Pla y in g So u n d s in th e Le ft Ha n d Du rin g a  
Pe rfo rm a n ce (Lo w e r To n e )  
Normally, when using Automatic Accompaniment in a performance, sounds are not  
produced by playing the left-hand part of the keyboard. When you touch the  
<Lower> icon, you can have Tones from the left side of the keyboard play  
simultaneously with the Automatic Accompaniment.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button.  
This sets the Automatic Accompaniment.  
On the Basic screen, touch <Lower>.  
Now when you play a chord in the left-hand keyboard area, the notes you play will  
sound, and the accompaniment chord changes.  
fig.d-lower.eps_60  
Sto p p in g th e so u n d in th e le ft-h a n d  
3 .  
Touch <Lower>.  
The <Lower> icon reverts to black, and the left-hand Tones stop playing.  
6 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Pla yin g th e Pia n o w ith Acco m p a n im e n t Ad d e d  
(Pia n o Style Arra n g e r)  
Usually with Automatic Accompaniment, you play chords on the left-hand side of  
the keyboard and the melody on the right-hand side. Chords can also be recognized  
over the entire keyboard, allowing you to perform using Automatic Accompaniment  
without splitting the keyboard. This function is called “Piano Style Arranger.”  
This makes it possible to add an accompaniment automatically as you play a song  
by playing chords in the ordinary way, without giving any thought to the location  
of a keyboard split.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button.  
Touch <Split> to turn the Split function off.  
fig.d-pianist.eps_60  
3 .  
4 .  
Play the keyboard.  
The accompaniment starts when you play a chord anywhere on the keyboard.  
6 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Ad ju stin g th e Vo lu m e Ba la n ce fo r Ea ch  
Pa rt (Ba la n ce )  
You can adjust the volume balance between the accompaniment and the keyboard,  
and the volume balance for each of the parts in a Music Style.  
Ch a n g in g th e Vo lu m e Ba la n ce b e tw e e n th e  
N O TE  
Acco m p a n im e n t a n d th e Ke y b o a rd (Ba la n ce Kn o b )  
When this knob is turned  
completely to the  
You can change the volume balance between a song and accompaniment and the  
notes you play on the keyboard.  
Accompaniment side, no  
sounds from the keyboard are  
audible, even when the keys  
are pressed. You can usually  
leave the knob at the center  
position.  
1 .  
Adjust the volume balance with the Balance knob.  
fig.volbal.e  
Ad ju stin g th e Vo lu m e Ba la n ce fo r Ea ch  
Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa rt (Pa rt Ba la n ce )  
You can adjust the volume of each performance part in a Music Style, and the  
balance between parts when playing multiple Tones on the keyboard.  
fig.panel2-11  
1 .  
Press the [Part Balance] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The following “Part Balance screen” appears.  
Touch  
to switch the two screens.  
fig.d-partbal1.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
Switch the screens  
The volume balance between each of the performance parts in the Music Style is  
indicated.  
6 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Ch a p te r 2 Au to m a tic Acco m p a n im e n t  
Display  
Rhythm  
Performance part  
Music Style Rhythm Part  
Bass  
Accompaniment 1, Accompaniment 2, Accompani-  
Accomp  
Short phrases sounded when the Performance Pads  
Phrase (KR-7)  
fig.d-partbal2.eps_60  
Switch the screens  
This shows the volume balance between each of the keyboards Tones when layer  
Displayed  
Drums  
Tone Part  
Percussion instruments or sound effects played with the keys  
Lower  
Layer  
Upper  
Left-hand Tone  
Layer Tone  
Right-hand Tone  
2 .  
Touch each slider  
to adjust the volume balance.  
You can also make these adjustments by touching the adjustment sliders and then  
using the [-] [+] buttons or the dial.  
Touch <Exit> to go back to the previous screen.  
6 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Pla y in g a So n g  
Now, lets try practicing while playing back internal songs, commercial music files,  
and songs saved to floppy disks.  
You can use rewind or fast-forward to go to any desired measure, and play back  
from that point.  
fig.panel3-1  
Re co rd / Pla y b a ck b u tto n s  
Se le ctin g th e so n g  
When playing back songs on floppy disks, first insert the floppy disk in the disk  
If the floppy disk is being used  
for the first time, refer to p. 6.  
drive.  
1 .  
Press the [Select/Listen to a Song] button.  
The following “Genre Selection screen” appears.  
fig.d-genre.eps_60  
When you touch the genre for the song you want to play, the screen changes.  
When selecting a song from a disk, touch, <Disk>.  
The following “Song Selection screen” appears.  
fig.d-songsel.eps_60  
6 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
When you touch <  
random order.  
>, songs selected from all of the internal songs are played in  
If there is recorded song data,  
the “Delete song” screen  
appears.  
When you touch <  
>, all of the songs in the genre you have selected are played  
in order, starting from the selected song. When the last song is finished, playback  
resumes from the initial song.  
<
<
>: Information for the selected song is displayed.  
>: The selected song is played back. This changes to <  
> while the song  
is played back; playback stops when you touch <  
>< >: The song genre changes.  
>.  
If it’s okay to delete the song,  
touch <OK>. If you do not  
want to delete the song, touch  
<Cancel>, and either save the  
or register the song to the  
<
2 .  
Touch the name of the song to be played back.  
The selected song name appears at “0:.”  
You use the [-] [+] buttons and the dial to select songs.  
Pla y in g b a ck  
Press the [  
N O TE  
When you start playback of  
songs, the measure number on  
the Basic screen appears in  
reverse video. The  
3 .  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
The button indicator lights up, and playback of the song begins.  
Sto p p in g th e So n g  
Press the [  
performance data is being  
loaded while the indication is  
highlighted; please wait a few  
moments for this to be  
4 .  
(Play/Stop)] button once again.  
The button indicator light goes out, and the song stops.  
When the song is finished, playback stops automatically.  
completed.  
Press the [  
(Reset)] button to return to the beginning of the song.  
Song Number <0:>  
Record/Playback Buttons  
fig.composer.e  
In the Song Selection screen,  
the title of the currently  
selected song appears at “0.”  
Song Number “0” is used by  
all genres. Recorded  
performances are also stored to  
“0.” The song in Song Number  
“0” is erased when the power  
is turned off.  
Track buttons:  
Each performance part of the song being played back is assigned to a track button. Use these  
buttons to select the performance parts that are muted or played. For more detailed  
[
(Reset)] button: Returns to the beginning of the song.  
N O TE  
[
(Play/Stop)] button:  
Plays back the song, or if the song is currently being played, it stops the song.  
When using markers to specify  
you can rewind and fast  
forward only within the range  
between Marker A and  
Marker B.  
[
[
(Bwd)] button: Moves back the playback position of the song one measure each time  
the button is pressed. When held down, the song “rewinds” continuously.  
(Fwd)] button: Advances the playback position of the song one measure each time the  
button is pressed. When held down, the song is forwarded continuously.  
[
Holding down the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button and pressing the [  
(Fwd)] button moves  
you to the end of the song.  
7 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Usin g Ke y w o rd s to Se a rch fo r So n g s (So n g Se a rch )  
You can search for songs that match the conditions you set regarding the song tempo  
or genre.  
Only the KR-7/ 5’s internal  
songs are searchable.  
You can also search the songs using the first character of the song name.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Select/Listen to a Song] button.  
Touch <Search>.  
The following “Song Search screen” appears.  
fig.d-songsrch1.eps_60  
Co n d itio n Se a rch scre e n  
N a m e Se a rch scre e n  
Touch here to switch these screens.  
Se a rch in g b y co n d itio n s  
3 .  
Touch the parameter you want to set, then use the [-] [+] buttons and the  
dial to select the search conditions.  
With <Data>, songs are searched according to data included in the internal songs.  
You can use four different criteria in searches: “Chords,” “Lyrics,” “Fingering”  
(fingering numbers), and “Any.” By selecting a song containing any of this data, then  
displaying it in the KR-7/ 5’s score, you can display information about the selected data.  
4 .  
Touch <Search>.  
The search results appear in the display.  
Touch the song name to select the song.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Song Search screen.  
Se a rch in g b y so n g n a m e  
3 .  
4 .  
Touch <By Name>.  
Touch <By Key> to return to the Condition Search screen.  
Decide which character you will use for the search.  
Enter the character you are searching for. For example, touching <ABC> in  
succession cycles you through the available choices in that character group  
(“A”B”C”...).  
Touch <A-0> to toggle between alphabets and numerals.  
The selected character appears in the middle of the screen.  
5 .  
Touch <Search>.  
The search results appear in the display.  
Touch the song name to select the song.  
Touch <Exit> several times to return to the previous screen.  
7 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Registering the Songs You Lik e (Fa vorites)  
You can register songs you are currently practicing or enjoy playing to “Favorites,”  
allowing you to select these songs easily.  
Se le ctin g th e So n g  
On the KR-7, you can also  
register songs on floppy disks  
to the Favorites. For details,  
1 .  
Press the [Select/Listen to a Song] button.  
2 .  
Touch the song name to select the song to be registered.  
Re g iste rin g to Fa vo rite s  
3 .  
Touch <Add>.  
N O TE  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.m-fvrtadd.eps_60  
With the KR-5, you cannot  
register recorded songs or  
songs on disks to the Favorites.  
Only internal songs can be  
registered to the Favorites.  
When you want to clear all of  
the content saved to the  
“Favorites” and restore the  
settings to the original factory  
condition on the KR-5, refer to  
4 .  
Touch <OK>.  
The selected song is registered to Favorites.  
Now you can select the registered song by selecting Favorites for the genre in the  
Song Selection screen.  
7 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Re m o vin g So n g s fro m Fa vo rite s  
This deletes registered songs for Favorites.  
1 .  
In the Song Selection screen, select Favorites for the genre.  
fig.d-song-fvrt.eps_60  
2 .  
3 .  
Touch the name of the song to be deleted.  
Touch <Del>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.m-fvrtdel.eps_60  
4 .  
Touch <OK>.  
The song is deleted.  
7 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Disp la y in g th e Sco re  
The KR-7/ 5 can display scores not only for the internal songs, but for music files and  
performances recorded with the KR-7/ 5. This is very convenient for performing  
while reading the music and for checking songs that have been recorded. When you  
play back a music file with lyrics, the lyrics appear on screen.  
Se le ctin g th e so n g  
When playing back songs on floppy disks, first insert the floppy disk in the disk  
drive.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Select/Listen to a Song] button to select a song.  
Press the [Score Display] button.  
The “Score screen” appears.  
fig.d-score.eps_60  
In some internal songs, the  
fingering is displayed.  
The fingering numbers shown  
in the screen indicate one  
possible fingering.  
Display of the KR-7  
Icon  
Description  
Displays an enlarged score.  
You can also display the note names.  
The score and keyboard are displayed on the KR-7. The  
keyboard is displayed on the KR-5. This allows you to check  
the keys that are pressed for the sounds played back.  
Chord names can be displayed  
in some of the internal songs  
and recorded performances  
using the KR-7/ 5’s Chord  
Selects the part for which the score is displayed.  
* You can specify the track or part to be displayed with  
<Option>  
<Tutor> (KR-7)  
This allows you to practice the song repeatedly while reading  
The left pedal functions as the “Replay.” When you press the  
pedal during the playback of the song, playback stops, and  
when you release the pedal, playback resumes starting at the  
beginning of that measure. When the pedal is pressed in rapid  
succession, playback is returned the same number of  
measures as the number of times the pedal is pressed.  
In situations such as when you want to hear a difficult phrase  
repeated a number of times, you can press the pedal to go to  
an earlier point in the song.  
<Replay>  
7 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
N O TE  
3 .  
Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
No notes are shown in the  
Playback of the song begins, and the score advances along with the progression of  
the performance.  
score if the selected part  
contains no data. To change  
the part being displayed, refer  
N o te s Re g a rd in g th e Sco re Disp la y  
When playback of a song begins,  
appears in the Score screen. While this  
symbol is displayed, performance data is being loaded from floppy disk or  
internal memory. It may take thirty seconds to a minute or more to read the  
data. Please wait.  
The displayed scores are based on music files. Priority is placed on the  
readability of the displayed music, not on the accurate rendition of difficult,  
high-level performances. Thus, there may be discrepancies seen when compared  
with commercially available printed music. The display is not intended for  
viewing advanced songs requiring precisely detailed scores, or complex songs.  
On the score display screen, lyrics and notes may extend beyond the range  
displayed on the screen and may not be visible.  
Playback may start over from the beginning if you display the score or change  
the displayed part during playback of the song.  
To u ch in g N o te s to Co n firm th e So u n d s  
(To u ch th e N o te s)  
In the Score screen, you can have notes played by touching the notes on the screen.  
When you touch <  
> to show the keyboard on the screen, the touched note is  
indicated by the corresponding note on the keyboard. This allows you confirm notes  
by sight, sound, and touch.  
In addition, when you trace part of the score with your finger, the traced segment is  
played back. This allows you to easily play back phrases you like.  
fig.d-score-key.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
7 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Ma k in g De ta ile d Se ttin g s fo r th e Sco re Disp la y  
You can change the part appearing on the score display and change the manner in  
which the score is displayed.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Score Display] button to display the Score screen.  
Touch <Option>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-scoreopt.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
Switch the screens  
3 .  
Touch  
for the parameter being set to select the value.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Score screen.  
Item  
Setting  
Lyrics  
Sets whether or not the lyrics  
appear in the music.  
ON  
The lyrics are displayed.  
In some internal songs, the  
fingering is displayed.  
The fingering numbers shown  
in the screen indicate one  
possible fingering.  
OFF  
ON  
Not displayed.  
Finger Numbers  
Whether or not the fingering  
appears in the music.  
The fingering is displayed.  
Not displayed.  
OFF  
ON  
Chords  
Whether or not chord names  
appear in the music.  
The chord names are displayed.  
Not displayed.  
OFF  
Chord names can be displayed  
in some of the internal songs  
and recorded performances  
using the KR-7/ 5’s Chord  
OFF  
Not displayed.  
C, D, E  
The pitch names (C, D, E) are displayed.  
Pitches  
Sets whether or not the note  
names appear in the music  
when the score is expanded.  
Do, Re, Mi  
(Fixed)  
The pitch names (fixed Do) are dis-  
played.  
Do, Re, Mi  
(Movable)  
The syllable names (movable Do) are dis-  
played.  
Clef L  
Auto  
Display is switched automatically.  
G (treble) clef is displayed in the score.  
F (bass) clef is displayed in the score.  
Display is switched automatically.  
G (treble) clef is displayed in the score.  
F (bass) clef is displayed in the score.  
Key is switched automatically.  
Determines whether a treble or  
bass clef is shown in the score  
for the left-hand part.  
G Clef  
F Clef  
Auto  
Clef R  
Determines whether treble or  
bass clef is shown in the score  
for the right-hand part.  
G Clef  
F Clef  
Auto  
Key  
Score is displayed in the  
specified key.  
b x 5–0–  
# x 6  
Score is displayed in the specified key.  
7 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Item  
Setting  
User Part  
User Track,  
Parts 1–16  
Selects the part to display when “User” is selected as  
the part to be displayed.  
Lower Part  
Lower Track,  
Parts 1–16  
Selects the part to display when “Lower” is selected as  
the part to be displayed.  
Upper Part  
Upper Track,  
Part 1–16  
Selects the part to display when “Upper” is selected as  
the part to be displayed.  
Sa vin g Sco re s a s Im a g e Da ta (KR-7 )  
You can take scores that are displayed on the KR-7 and save them to floppy disks.  
N O TE  
You can also use saved image data to your computer.  
Other than for your own  
personal enjoyment, use of the  
scores that are output without  
the permission of the  
1 .  
Insert the floppy disk onto which you want to save the image data in the  
KR-7’s disk drive.  
Use a floppy disk formatted on the KR-7.  
copyright holder is prohibited  
by law.  
2 .  
3 .  
Press the [Select/Listen to a Song] button to select a song.  
Press the [Score Display] button.  
The Score screen appears.  
4 .  
5 .  
Touch <Option>.  
Touch <Export>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-scorebmp.eps_60  
6 .  
7 .  
Touch  
for each parameter to set the range of the image data.  
N O TE  
Do not remove the floppy disk  
while “save” is in progress.  
Touch <Execute>.  
The score is saved to the floppy disk as image data in BMP (bitmap) format.  
.
7 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Pra cticin g So n g s w ith th e Pra ctice  
Fu n ctio n (KR-7 )  
Try using the KR-7s practice function to practice a song you like.  
This feature makes it simple to specify the segment you want for repeated practice,  
check your own performance against the score, and practice at a slower tempo.  
1 Disp la y in g th e Sco re Scre e n  
Se le ctin g th e so n g  
1 .  
Press the [Select/Listen to a Song] button to select the song you want to  
practice.  
Disp la y in g th e Sco re scre e n  
2 .  
3 .  
Press the [Score Display] button.  
The Score screen appears.  
Touch <Tutor>.  
The following “Tutor screen” appears.  
fig.d-tutor1.eps_60  
N O TE  
When you select this function  
after turning on the power, a  
message screen like the one  
shown in the figure at left  
appears only once.  
2 Pra cticin g  
Liste n in g to a re fe re n ce o f th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
First, listen to the song you are going to practice.  
Once youre familiar with the song, practice it a number of times along with the  
example.  
1 .  
2 .  
Touch <Reference>.  
When the Message screen appears, touch <Close>.  
Touch <  
> on the screen.  
The example performance is played back.  
Touch <  
Touch <  
> or <  
> to rewind or fast forward within the practice range.  
> to return to the beginning of the practice range.  
7 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
When the Transpose function  
tone is sounded when you  
To u ch th e N o te s  
When you touch a note on the Practice screen, the KR-7 plays that note.  
touch notes or <One Note> on  
the screen.  
When you trace along the displayed score with your finger, the KR-7 plays the traced  
segment.  
O n e N o te  
When you touch <  
>, the KR-7 plays the note currently indicated by the  
bouncing ball. When you touch <  
at a time to check the notes.  
> or <  
>, you can return or advance one note  
Re co rd in g Yo u r Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Once you are able to play the song, try recording your own performance.  
Changing the Performance  
Played Back in the Check  
Screen  
3 .  
4 .  
Touch <Rec>.  
When the Message screen appears, touch <Close>.  
You can switch the  
performance that is played  
back by touching the score for  
“User” or “Reference” in the  
Check screen.  
Touch <  
> on the screen.  
Youll hear a count, and recording begins.  
Play along with the accompaniment.  
When the keyboard is  
displayed in the Check screen,  
touch <User> or <Reference>  
to switch the performance to  
be played back.  
Ch e ck in g Yo u r Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Compare your recorded performance with the example.  
5 .  
6 .  
Touch <Check>.  
When the Message screen appears, touch <Close>.  
Touch <  
> on the screen.  
The Check screen display compares the example performance with your own  
performance.  
Analyze and practice any trouble spots.  
3 Ch a n g in g th e p ra ctice se ttin g s  
Immediately after turning on the power, all measures are set for practice at the  
original tempo.  
In the beginning, youll probably want to select specific phrases, and practice that  
material repeatedly at a slower tempo.  
1 .  
Touch <Options>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
7 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
fig.d-tutoropt.eps_60  
Switch the screens  
Parameter  
Value  
Description  
Set  
Left Hand,  
Right Hand,  
Both Hands  
Part  
Selects the part or parts to be practiced.  
When the Transpose function  
tone plays even if “Tone” is set  
to “Do Re Mi.”  
Specifies measures for practice.  
Most of the KR-7’s internal songs have markers set in or-  
der to make repeated practice easier. You can specify the  
markers’ range by touching <Prev> or <Next>.  
Range  
Tempo  
1–  
Original Tempo,  
A Little Slower,  
Slower,  
Selects the practice tempo.  
Much Slower  
When “On” is selected, song accompaniment parts are  
also played back.  
When “Quiet” is selected, song accompaniment parts are  
played back at a lower volume.  
When “Off” is selected, song accompaniment parts are  
muted.  
Accomp  
Tone  
On, Quiet, Off  
Selects the tone played when the notes are touched.  
When “Original” is selected, a original tone for the song is  
selected.  
When “Do Re Mi Voice” is selected, the notes are “sung”  
as “Do-Re-Mi.”  
Do Re Mi,  
Original  
Selects whether the score display or the keyboard display  
is used in demonstrating the example performance and  
your own recorded performance in the Check screen.  
Check  
2 .  
Score, Keyboard  
Touch the icon for the parameter you want to set.  
The selections appear.  
3 .  
Touch the setting icon.  
Repeat Steps 2 and 3 to set each of the parameters.  
Set the tempo, practice range and other variables to the values you prefer.  
4 .  
5 .  
Touch <Audition>.  
The practice range is played back using the selected settings.  
Touch <Exit>.  
Youre returned to the Practice screen.  
8 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Ad ju stin g th e Te m p o  
This changes the song and Music Style tempos.  
If songs seem difficult to play at their original speed, you may find it helpful to first  
practice with the tempo slowed down. Then, after becoming more familiar with the  
song, you can practice it at a gradually faster tempo.  
Changing the tempo has no effect on the pitch of the notes. And you can change the  
tempo even when the song is in progress.  
fig.panel3-2  
Ad ju stin g th e te m p o w ith th e Te m p o [-] [+] b u tto n s  
Pressing the [+] button once increases the tempo by one unit. Holding down the  
button makes the tempo increase continuously.  
Pressing the [-] button once decreases the tempo by one unit. Holding down the  
button makes the tempo decrease continuously.  
Pressing the [-] [+] buttons simultaneously returns the selected Music Style or song  
to the basic tempo.  
Ad ju stin g th e te m p o w ith th e d ia l  
When the tempo is displayed at the upper-left area of the screen (except at the  
Turn the dial clockwise to speed up the tempo.  
Turn the dial counterclockwise to slow the tempo.  
8 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Se ttin g th e Te m p o b y Pre ssin g th e Bu tto n in Tim e  
(Ta p Te m p o )  
You can also set the tempo by pressing the Performance Pad. This feature is called  
“Tap Tempo.” By using the Tap Tempo function, you can quickly set the tempo you  
are thinking of, without specifying the tempo in numerical terms.  
fig.panel3-3  
<KR-7 >  
Assig n in g fu n ctio n s to th e Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa d s  
1 .  
Press the [User Function] button and watch the indicator light up.  
fig.d-usrfunc.eps_60  
You can also assign the Tap  
Tempo function to the pedal,  
and use the pedal to specify  
the tempo. For details, refer to  
“Assigning Functions to  
(Pedal Setting/ User  
2 .  
3 .  
Touch  
for the Performance Pad to which the function is  
assigned, then select “Tap Tempo.”  
Touch <Exit>; the tempo is indicated in the upper left of the screen.  
Sp e cify in g th e Te m p o  
Press the Pad to which “Tap Tempo” is assigned at least twice.  
4 .  
The tempo is set to the rhythm you used when tapping the button.  
8 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
<KR-5 >  
Assig n in g fu n ctio n s to th e Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa d s  
1 .  
Press the [Style Orchestrator/User Function] button and the indicator  
light goes out.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-usrfunc_5.eps_60  
You can also assign the Tap  
Tempo function to the pedal,  
and use the pedal to specify  
the tempo. For details, refer to  
“Assigning Functions to  
(Pedal Setting/ User  
2 .  
3 .  
Touch  
for Performance Pad [1] or [2] to assign “Tap Tempo.”  
Touch <Exit>; the tempo is indicated in the upper left of the screen.  
Sp e cify in g th e Te m p o  
Press the Pad to which “Tap Tempo” is assigned at least twice.  
4 .  
The tempo is set to the rhythm you used when tapping the Pad.  
8 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Use Yo u r Vo ice to Se le ct th e Te m p o  
(Vo ca l Ta p Te m p o ) (KR-7 )  
feature is called “Vocal Tap Tempo.”  
Vocal Tap Tempo does not  
function well when the mic  
volume is too low. Adjust the  
volume level with the Mic  
[Volume] knob.  
1 .  
2 .  
3 .  
Press the [Metronome] button.  
Touch <Vocal Tap>.  
fig.d-vocaltap.eps_60  
You can start the song by  
giving the count through the  
microphone. For more detailed  
the start of songs and  
with the sound of your voice  
4 .  
Count to four (“One, two, three, four”) into the mic.  
The tempo is set to the beat you used speaking into the microphone. The new tempo  
setting is indicated in the screen.  
After setting the tempo, touch <Exit> and youre returned to the Metronome screen.  
Pla y in g Ba ck a t a Fix e d Te m p o (Te m p o Mu te )  
If a song has tempo changes, it helps to practice the song first at a steady tempo.  
Overriding tempo changes is called “Tempo Muting.”  
1 .  
Hold down the [  
[+] buttons.  
(Play/Stop)] button and press one of the Tempo [-]  
When tempo muting is in effect, the tempo display appears in reverse video.  
fig.d-tempmute.eps_60  
When you play back the song, it will play at a constant tempo.  
Ca n ce l th e te m p o m u te se ttin g  
1 .  
Hold down the [  
(Play/Stop)] button and press one of the Tempo [-]  
[+] buttons.  
Tempo muting is canceled.  
Tempo Mute will also be cancelled when you select a different song.  
8 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Ma tch th e Te m p o Be fo re Yo u Be g in  
Pla y in g (Co u n t In )  
When youre playing along with a song, you can listen to the tempo before you start  
playing by adding a count-in.  
This audible count before the song playback is called a “Count-In.”  
fig.panel3-3  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Metronome] button and watch the indicator light up.  
If you are not using the metronome, press the [Metronome] button so its indicator  
goes out.  
Touch <Count In>.  
The following “Count In settings screen” appears.  
fig.d-cntin.eps_60  
You can have a count sound be  
played before the song starts  
playing back by holding down  
the [Reset] button while you  
press the [Play/ Stop]  
3 .  
Touch <Switch>  
to set this to “ON.”  
button.The status of the  
<Count In> settings won't be  
affected by your use of this  
With this setting, two measures count down before the song playback starts.  
Ca n ce llin g th e Co u n t In  
procedure. .  
1 .  
2 .  
In the Metronome screen, touch <Count In>.  
Touch <Switch>  
to set this to “OFF.”  
For more about other settings  
on the Count-In settings  
This sets the KR-7/ 5 so that the count sound is not played.  
8 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Mu tin g So m e Pa rts Be fo re Pla y in g  
(Tra ck Bu tto n s)  
With commercially available music files for piano lessons, the part for each hand can  
be played back independently. This makes it easy to practice hands separately. For  
example, you can follow along with your right hand while you listen to that same  
right-hand part be played, or you can practice the left-hand part while the right-hand  
part plays.  
For more on music files, refer  
A music file for piano lessons may be assigned to the five Track buttons as shown below.  
fig.trackbuttons.e  
Drums/SFX  
Accom-  
Left-hand Right-hand  
paniment  
Part  
Part  
By using these Track buttons, you can eliminate the sound of specific parts. This is  
referred to as “muting.”  
If a single Track button  
includes more than one  
instrument and you want to  
instruments, take a look at  
By recording your own performances to the Track Buttons in this fashion, you can  
1 .  
Se le ctin g th e p a rt th a t y o u ’ll b e p la y in g  
When a single Part is not  
played, it is called “Minus  
One.” Using Minus One, you  
can mute out a particular  
instrument and play the part  
yourself.  
2 .  
Press any one of the Track buttons to make the buttons indicator light go  
dark.  
The sound for the selected part no longer plays.  
For example, when practicing the right hand, press the [4/ Upper] button.  
When you play back the song, the right-hand performance will not sound. Practice  
your right-hand performance along with the left-hand playback.  
When playing back SMF files  
for Roland Piano Digital series  
instruments, and the [3/  
Pla y in g b a ck a so n g  
Press the [ (Play/Stop)] button.  
Lower] button and [4/ Upper]  
button do not correctly control  
the left/ right-hand  
3 .  
performances, please change  
the “Track Assign” settings.  
Parts Assigned to the Track  
Buttons During SMF Playback  
The song will begin playing back.  
The part you selected in step 2 will not sound.  
Once again press the button you selected in step 2. The buttons indicator will light  
up, and the part will be heard once again.  
Even while the song is playing, you can press the track buttons to mute or un-mute  
the sound.  
Sto p p in g th e so n g  
You can adjust the balance  
between the keyboard and  
song volume levels. Check out  
“Adjusting the Volume  
4 .  
Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
The song will stop.  
8 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Se ttin g Ma rk e rs fo r Re p e a te d Pra ctice  
(Ma rk e r)  
By setting markers at points in a song that you want to practice repeatedly, you can  
then easily go to and repeat play back of the selected measures.  
Pla cin g a Ma rk e r w ith in a So n g  
You can place two separate markers (Marker A and Marker B) in one song. These  
markers are placed at the beginning of a measure to make the beginning and end of  
a section of music. Placing markers is a handy way to start playback at the same  
place as many times as you like. You can add markers or move to a marker even  
while playback is in progress.  
Acce ss th e Ma rk e r scre e n  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Menu] button.  
Touch  
to switch the screens.  
Touch <Marker>.  
The Marker screen appears.  
fig.d-marker.eps_60  
Pla cin g Ma rk e rs  
3 .  
4 .  
Go to the measure where you want to set a marker using the [  
and [ (Fwd)] buttons.  
(Bwd)]  
Touch <—> for Marker A.  
Marker A is placed at the beginning of the measure you selected.  
“—” on the screen will change to the number of the measure where you placed the  
marker.  
Markers can also be assigned  
in units of beats rather than  
5 .  
In the same way, touch the Marker B <—> to set Marker B.  
It is not possible to assign marker B to the same location or a measure before marker A.  
8 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Pla y b a ck fro m a Ma rk e r lo ca tio n  
1 .  
At the marker screen, touch the measure number of the marker you want  
to go to.  
fig.d-mark1-5.eps_60  
Playback will start from wherever Marker A or Marker B are set.  
With the song playing back, playback will continue if you touch Marker A or Marker  
B on the Marker screen.  
Era sin g a Ma rk e r  
1 .  
Touch <Clear> for the marker you want to erase.  
fig.d-markclear.eps_60  
The marker disappears and the on-screen display changes to <—>.  
Mo vin g a Ma rk e r  
You can move a marker that has been placed in a song. You can also move the section  
of music defined by Markers A and B forward or back, without changing the number  
of measures of marked.  
1 .  
On the Marker screen, touch  
or  
for the marker to be moved.  
fig.d-mark1-5.eps_60  
When you touch  
When you touch  
, the marker is moved to a previous part of the song.  
, the marker is moved to a later part of the song.  
8 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Mo vin g Ma rk e rs A a n d B w ith o ut ch a n g in g th e in te rva l b e tw e e n th e m  
On the Marker screen, touch or in the middle of the screen.  
1 .  
For example, if you have Marker A set at the beginning of the fifth measure, and  
Marker B set at the beginning of the ninth measure, when you touch  
A is moved to the beginning of the first measure, and Marker B is moved to the  
beginning of the fifth measure.  
, Marker  
Touch  
to shift Marker A to the beginning of the ninth measure and Marker B  
to the beginning of the thirteenth measure.  
fig.markerA-B.e  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1 0  
1 1  
1 2 1 3 1 4 1 5  
1 6  
Measure  
Marker A  
Measure  
Marker B  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1 0  
1 1  
1 2 1 3 1 4 1 5  
1 6  
Marker A  
Marker B  
Pla y in g Ba ck th e Sa m e Pa ssa g e O ve r a n d O ve r  
You can play back a particular passage over and over. This is convenient when you  
want to focus on a passage.  
1 .  
First, set Marker A and Marker B to define the measures you want to  
repeat.  
For instance, suppose you want to play back the passage from the fifth through  
eighth measures over and over. You should place Marker A at the beginning of the  
fifth bar and Marker B at the beginning of the ninth bar.  
fig.d-markrpt.eps_60  
ON  
OFF  
When <Repeat> is On  
• If neither Marker A nor  
Marker B is set, the song is  
played back from the  
2 .  
Touch <Repeat> in the Marker screen.  
beginning to the end.  
• If you only place marker A,  
playback repeats from marker  
A to the end of the song.  
• If you only place marker B,  
playback repeats from the  
beginning of the song to  
marker B.  
The setting is made for repeated playback of the passage from marker A to marker B.  
When you play the song, the marked section of music plays back repeatedly.  
Ca n ce llin g re p e a t p la y b a ck  
3 .  
Touch <Repeat> in the Marker screen, so its highlighted in black.  
Repeat playback is cancelled.  
8 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Tra n sp o sin g Ke y b o a rd So u n d s a n d  
So n g s Pla y e d Ba ck (Tra n sp o se )  
By using the “Transpose function,” you can transpose your performance without  
changing the notes you play. For example, even if the song is in a difficult key with  
many sharps ( ) or flats ( ), you can transpose it to a key that is easier for you to  
read and play.  
You can also use this function to play back a song in a different key.  
When accompanying a vocalist, you can easily transpose the pitch to a range that is  
comfortable for the singer, while still playing the notes as written (i.e., with the same  
fingering positions).  
fig.panel3-4  
1 .  
Press the [Transpose] button.  
A “Transpose screen” like the one below appears.  
fig.d-transpose.eps_60  
2 .  
Touch the Transpose icon.  
Icon  
Target  
Settings Value  
Keyboard sound  
-6–0–+5  
Song to be played back  
-24–0–+24  
-6–0–+5  
Keyboard sounds, songs being played back  
9 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
3 .  
Touch the screen keyboard or  
value.  
,
to select the transposition  
Each time you press  
When you touch  
or  
, it transposes the key by a semitone.  
, a value of “0” is set.  
You can also use the [-] [+] buttons or the dial to change the transposition value.  
When you transpose a song or the keyboard, the [Transpose] buttons indicator  
lights up. As you play the keyboard or play back the song, the notes are transposed.  
When you touch <Exit>, the transposition remains in effect, and youre returned to  
the previous screen.  
Ca n ce llin g Tra n sp o sitio n  
4 .  
Press the [Transpose] button and the indicator light goes out.  
The transposition value reverts  
to “0” when you turn off the  
power or select another song.  
Transposition is cancelled.  
The next time you press the [Transpose] button, illuminating the indicator, the music  
is transposed by the value set here.  
Example: Playing a song in E major while playing the keys  
for C major  
In this example, C is the root note in the key of C major. E, the root of E major, is the  
third in C major. It is up four keys, including the black keys, so touch  
enter “4” for the setting.  
, then  
fig.trans.e  
If you play C E G  
It will sound E G#  
B
9 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
De ta ile d So n g Pla y b a ck Se ttin g s  
Ch a n g in g th e To n e Se ttin g s W h e n Pla y in g Ba ck  
So n g s (Pla y Mo d e )  
For detailed information about  
With the normal setting, GS tones (sounds that are compatible with other GS  
instruments) will normally be used to play back song data. By changing this setting,  
you can play back song using KR-specific tones for certain portions of the data.  
1 .  
Press the [Menu] button.  
The Menu screen appears.  
fig.d-plymode.eps_60  
Touch  
to switch the screens.  
2 .  
Touch <Play Mode>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-plymode.eps_60  
3 .  
Touch the icon to choose the setting.  
Icon  
Description  
Playback uses GS-compatible tones for performances that sound like  
other GS instruments.  
GS  
KR  
Playback uses KR tones for greater expressiveness. However, differ-  
ences may appear when playing back using devices other than the  
KR.  
4 .  
5 .  
Touch <Exit> to go back to the Menu screen.  
After changing this setting, try selecting the song once again.  
9 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Hid in g th e Ly rics (Ly rics)  
Some commercially available music files for use in karaoke, as well as some of the  
internal songs include lyrics data. When you play such music files, the lyrics  
automatically appear in the screen. If you do not want lyrics to appear automatically,  
set this to “OFF.”  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Menu] button.  
The Menu screen appears.  
Touch  
to switch the screens.  
Touch <Lyrics>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-lyric.eps_60  
Even when this is set to “OFF,”  
you can still have the lyrics be  
displayed by touching <lyrics>  
when it appears in the Piano or  
3 .  
4 .  
Touch  
to select the setting.  
The screen may be switched  
when you press the button  
while the Lyrics screen is  
displayed. To have the lyrics  
displayed again, touch  
Display  
Explanation  
Lyrics are displayed automatically (when performance data con-  
taining lyrics is played back).  
ON  
<lyrics> on the Piano or Basic  
screen, or stop playback of the  
Lyrics are not displayed, even if the song data being played back  
contains lyrics data.  
OFF  
song, then press the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Menu screen.  
9 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 3 So n g Pla y b a ck a n d Pra ctice Fu n ctio n s  
Ch a n g in g th e Pa rts Assig n e d to th e Tra ck  
Bu tto n s Du rin g SMF Pla y b a ck (Tra ck Assig n )  
left-hand part is assigned to the [3/ Lower] button, and the right-hand part is  
assigned to the [4/ Upper] button. However, assignment of the right-hand and left-  
hand parts may differ with some SMF data.  
When you select this parameter,  
the message “OK to delete  
song?” may be displayed. Refer  
If you cannot get the right-hand and left-hand parts to work well set on “Auto,” then  
change the setting to “2/ 1 Part” or “3/ 4 Part.”  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Menu] button.  
The Menu screen appears.  
This setting is effective with  
SMF format song data.  
This is not effective with the  
internal songs.  
Touch  
to switch the screens.  
Touch <Track Assign>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-trkasgn.eps_60  
3 .  
4 .  
Touch  
to select the setting.  
Display  
Explanation  
The part assigned to each track will be determined automatically,  
depending on the song data.  
Auto  
Part 1 will be assigned to the right-hand track, part 2 to the left-hand  
track, and part 3 to the user track.  
2/1 Part  
3/4 Part  
Part 4 will be assigned to the right-hand track, part 3 to the left-hand  
track, and part 1 to the user track.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Menu screen.  
After changing this setting, try selecting the song once again.  
9 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
With the KR-7/ 5, you can easily record performances using the five track buttons.  
A recorded performance can be played back to listen to your own playing, or to add  
N O TE  
additional parts.  
Recorded performances are  
discarded when another song  
is selected, or when the power  
is turned off. Be sure to save  
important performances on a  
floppy disk. Take a look at  
You can use the KR-7/ 5 to make the following kinds of recordings.  
Recording just your own keyboard performance (“Recording a New Song  
Recording performances using Automatic Accompaniment  
Recording along with the internal songs and songs on disks  
If th e fo llo w in g scre e n a p p e a rs  
message appears on the screen when you try to choose another song.  
If it’s okay to delete the song, touch <OK>.  
If you do not want to delete the song, touch <Cancel>, and either save the song to a  
9 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Re co rd in g a N e w So n g (N e w So n g )  
This records keyboard performances without the use of the internal songs or  
Automatic Accompaniment.  
fig.panel4-1  
Se ttin g s fo r re co rd in g p e rfo rm a n ce s  
1 .  
2 .  
Press One Touch Program [Piano] button.  
Decide on the tone of the performance.  
Use the Tone buttons and the touch screen to select the tone.  
When you have finished choosing the settings, touch <Exit> to display the Basic  
screen.  
Re co rd in g se ttin g s  
3 .  
Press the [  
(Rec)] button.  
You press the [  
(Rec)] button and the following messages will appear, when a  
song has already been recorded.  
fig.m-rec.eps_60  
If you select <New Song>  
when a song has already been  
recorded, the “OK to delete  
song?” prompt appears in the  
screen. For more detailed  
Touch <New Song>.  
This switches the KR-7/ 5 to the settings required for recording a new song.  
The KR-7/ 5 is put in recording standby.  
To cancel recording, press the [  
(Rec)] button once more.  
4 .  
Decide on the tempo and beat.  
If necessary, press the [Metronome] button to play the metronome.  
When you have finished making the settings, touch <Exit> to display the Basic  
screen.  
Sta rt re co rd in g  
Press the [  
5 .  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
A two-bar count-in plays, then recording starts.  
Even without pressing the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button, recording starts when you  
play the keyboard. There is no count-in played when you start by playing rather than  
pushing the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button.  
9 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
When recording starts, the [  
light up.  
(Play/ Stop)] and [  
(Rec)] buttons’ indicators  
N O TE  
Any performance that has  
been recorded is deleted when  
the power to the KR-7/ 5 is  
turned off. If you do not want  
a performance deleted, then  
save it to a floppy disk or to  
Favorites (KR-7). Refer to  
Sto p re co rd in g  
6 .  
Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
Recording stops.  
The performance is recorded to the [1/ Whole] button.  
Liste n in g to th e Re co rd e d Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Press the [ (Reset)] button, then press the [  
7 .  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
The recorded performance is played back.  
When you press the [ (Play/ Stop)] button, playback stops.  
Track buttons assignments for recorded performances  
When you record only a keyboard performance, the performance will be assigned to  
the track buttons as follows.  
Normal performance (playing a single Tone from the entire keyboard)  
The performance is recorded to the [1/ Whole] button.  
Layer performance  
The performance is recorded to the [1/ Whole] button.  
Split performance  
The left-hand part of the keyboard is recorded to the [3/ Lower] button, and the  
right-hand part of the keyboard is recorded to the [4/ Upper] button.  
Layer performance and Split performance  
The left-hand part of the keyboard is recorded to the [3/ Lower] button, and layer  
performance in the right-hand part of the keyboard is recorded to the [4/ Upper]  
button.  
Drum set or sound effect performance  
Recorded on the [R/ Rhythm] button.  
9 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Re co rd in g W ith Acco m p a n im e n t  
Try recording a performance along with the Automatic Accompaniment.  
Se ttin g s fo r re co rd in g p e rfo rm a n ce s  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button.  
This chooses the setting for Automatic Accompaniment.  
Decide on the Music Style.  
When you have finished choosing the settings, touch <Exit> to display the Basic  
screen.  
Re co rd in g Se ttin g s  
3 .  
Press the [  
(Rec)] button.  
You press the [  
(Rec)] button and the following messages will appear, when a  
song has already been recorded.  
fig.m-rec.eps_60  
If you select <New Song>  
when a song has already been  
recorded, the “OK to delete  
song?” prompt appears in the  
screen. For more detailed  
Touch <New Song>.  
This switches the KR-7/ 5 to the settings required for recording a new song.  
The KR-7/ 5 is put in recording standby.  
To cancel recording, press the [  
(Rec)] button once more.  
4 .  
Decide on the tempo.  
Sta rt re co rd in g  
5 .  
Play a chord on the left-hand part of the keyboard.  
You can change how recording  
is stopped when recording a  
performance with Automatic  
Accompaniment. To learn  
An Automatic Accompaniment intro starts, and recording starts at the same time.  
Sto p re co rd in g  
Press the [Intro/Ending] button.  
6 .  
An ending plays, then the Automatic Accompaniment, and recording stop at the  
same time.  
Liste n in g to th e re co rd e d p e rfo rm a n ce  
Press the [ (Reset)] button, then press the [  
7 .  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
The recorded performance plays back.  
When you press the [ (Play/ Stop)] button, playback stops.  
9 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Track buttons assignments for recorded performances  
Performances that have been recorded using Automatic Accompaniment are  
assigned to the track buttons as shown below.  
Track button  
[R/Rhythm]  
Performance Recorded  
The rhythm part of an Automatic Accompaniment is  
recorded here. In addition, drum sets and effect sounds  
that are selected with the keys in a performance are re-  
corded to this track.  
performance played on the keyboard is recorded here.  
[1/Whole]  
[2/ Bass  
Accomp]  
The Automatic Accompaniment bass part and  
accompaniment part are recorded here.  
When the KR-7/ 5 is set so that sounds from performances  
on the left-hand side of the keyboard are played while the  
performance on the left-hand side of the keyboard is re-  
corded here.  
[3/Lower]  
[4/Upper]  
Your own performance on the right-hand side of the  
keyboard is recorded here.  
Music Styles are composed of  
five parts. For details, refer to  
9 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Re co rd in g Alo n g w ith a So n g  
Try recording along with internal songs and songs on disks.  
Here, record your right-hand performance along with the song accompaniment.  
Se ttin g s fo r re co rd in g p e rfo rm a n ce s  
Select a song before you begin recording.  
When you have selected the song, press the [Score Display] button to display the score.  
1 .  
Decide on the tone and tempo of the performance.  
After choosing the settings, touch <Exit> to display the Basic screen.  
The song tempo is stored  
within the song you selected.  
Re co rd in g se ttin g s  
Press the [ (Rec)] button.  
2 .  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.m-rec.eps_60  
3 .  
Touch <Add On>.  
With this setting, you can record while listening to the selected song.  
Se le ctin g th e tra ck to re co rd  
4 .  
Press the track button for the track that you want to record (i.e., the track  
that you want to play yourself).  
N O TE  
The indicator of the button you pressed will blink, and the KR-7/ 5 enters recording-  
standby mode.  
Only drum sets or SFX set are  
recorded to the [R/ Rhythm]  
button.  
Since in this example we will record the right-hand performance, press the [4/  
Upper] button to make the buttons indicator light blink.  
To cancel recording, press the [  
(Rec)] button once more.  
Sta rt re co rd in g  
Press the [  
5 .  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
A two-bar count-in plays, then recording starts.  
Even without pressing the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button, recording starts when you  
play the keyboard. There is no count-in played when you start by playing the  
keyboard instead of pushing the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button.  
(Play/ Stop)] and [ (Rec)] buttons’ indicators light.  
When recording starts, the [  
Sto p re co rd in g  
6 .  
Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
Recording stops.  
1 0 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Liste n in g to th e re co rd e d p e rfo rm a n ce  
7 .  
Press the [  
(Reset)] button, then press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
The recorded performance is played back.  
Recorded performances are  
recorded to <0: (Song Name)>.  
When you press the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button, recording stops.  
Re co rd in g W h ile Se le ctin g th e Tra ck  
Bu tto n s (Re d o in g Re co rd in g s)  
When you want to re-record, specify the Track button for the performance you want  
to re-record, and then record again.  
When you want to record over  
again after deleting all of the  
previous recording, refer to  
When you select a previously recorded Track button and re-record, everything from  
the point at which you begin recording up to the point where you stop recording will  
be replaced by the newly re-recorded performance.  
1 .  
2 .  
Use the [  
(Bwd)] and [  
(Fwd)] buttons to go to the measure  
where you want to begin recording.  
Press the [  
(Rec)] button.  
The song tempo is stored  
within the song you selected. If  
you want to change the tempo  
of the recorded song, refer to  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.m-rec.eps_60  
3 .  
4 .  
Touch <Add on>.  
Press the Track button for the track you want to re-record.  
The indicator for the selected Track button starts blinking.  
The [  
(Play/ Stop)] buttons indicator flashes, and the KR-7/ 5 is put in  
recording standby.  
To cancel recording, press the [  
(Rec)] button once more.  
5 .  
6 .  
Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button to begin recording.  
Re re co rd in g th e a cco m p a n im e n t p a rt o f a u to m a tic  
a cco m p a n im e n t  
Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button to stop recording.  
If you also want to rerecord the ending of the Automatic Accompaniment, press the  
[Intro/ Ending] button.  
1 0 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Era sin g Re co rd e d Pe rfo rm a n ce s  
You can use the following method to delete a recorded performance.  
1 .  
Hold down the [Select/Listen to a Song] button and press the [  
button.  
(Rec)]  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.m-songdel.eps_60  
2 .  
Touch <OK>.  
This deletes the recorded song.  
When you touch <Cancel>, the previous screen appears and the recorded song is not  
erased.  
Era sin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce o n Sp e cific Tra ck s  
You can select and erase performances on specific tracks.  
1 .  
Hold down the Track button for the track containing the performance  
you want to erase, then press the [ (Rec)] button.  
The Track buttons light goes dark, and the recorded music is erased.  
Ch a n g in g Ho w Re co rd in g Sto p s  
When recording an Automatic Accompaniment performance, you can change the  
accompaniment and the way recording mode stops.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Menu] button and watch the indicator light up.  
The Menu screen appears.  
Touch <Rec Mode>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-recmode.eps_60  
1 0 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
3 .  
Touch <Rec Stop>  
“Composer Stop.”  
to switch between “Arranger Stop” and  
Display  
Explanation  
Recording stops at the same time the Automatic Accompani-  
ment stops.  
Arranger Stop  
Recording does not stop, even when the Automatic Accompa-  
Composer Stop  
niment stops. When you press the [  
ton, recording stops.  
(Play/ Stop)] but-  
Re co rd in g So n g s Sta rtin g w ith Pick u p s  
You can record songs that start with pickup beats (songs that start on a beat other  
than the measures first beat).  
fig.PU.e  
~
Measure  
-2  
PU  
1
Recording begins here  
If the [ (Rec)] buttons indicator is not lit, press the [  
(Rec)] button so the  
indicator is lit.  
The KR-7/ 5 is put in recording standby.  
1 .  
Press the [  
(Bwd)] button one time.  
The measure number in the upper right of the Basic screen changes to “PU,” and the  
KR-7/ 5 is set to record a song starting with a pickup.  
fig.d-pu.eps_60  
Start recording. After a one-measure count, recording begins.  
1 0 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Usin g Flo p p y Disk s  
You can use the KR-7/ 5’s disk drive to save songs to floppy disks and listen to  
commercial music files.  
If youre using the disk drive  
for the first time, be sure to  
read the important notes on  
p. 6.  
In se rtin g a n d Eje ctin g a Flo p p y Disk  
In se rtin g a flo p p y d isk  
1 .  
With the front of the floppy disk facing up, insert the disk in the disk  
drive slot until there is an audible click.  
N O TE  
fig.diskdrive.e  
Never remove the disk while  
it is being read or written.  
Doing so will scratch the  
magnetic surface of the disk,  
making it unusable. (The  
disk drive indicator will light  
brightly while data is being  
read or written. Normally, it  
will be lit dimly or will be  
dark.)  
Indicator  
Eject Button  
Floppy Disk  
Re m o vin g a flo p p y d isk  
Press the Eject button.  
2 .  
N O TE  
The end of the floppy disk comes out of the slot. Grasp the edge of the floppy disk  
and gently pull it out.  
When a floppy disk is  
initialized, all of the data  
saved on the disk is erased.  
If you’re formatting a used  
floppy disk for reuse, be  
sure to check first to make  
sure the disk doesn’t contain  
any data you don’t want to  
lose.  
Fo rm a ttin g Flo p p y Disk s (Fo rm a t)  
A newly purchased floppy disk, or a floppy disk that has been used by another  
device cannot be used as is. Such floppy disks must be “formatted” (initialized) for  
use with the KR-7/ 5.  
If a floppy disk is in a format that doesnt match the format of this unit, you wont be  
able to use that floppy disk.  
fig.panel4-3  
KR-7  
First make sure that the protect tab of the floppy disk is in the “Write (write enable)”  
position.  
fig.DiskProtect.e  
Rear side of the disk  
Write  
(can write new data onto disk)  
Write Protect Tab  
Protect  
(prevents writing to disk)  
1 0 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
1 .  
2 .  
3 .  
Insert the floppy disk into the disk drive.  
Press the [Disk] button.  
Touch <File>.  
A “Song File screen” like the one below appears.  
fig.d-songfile.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
4 .  
Touch <Format Disk>.  
The following screen appears.  
fig.d-format.eps_60  
N O TE  
Dont try to take the floppy  
disk out of the disk drive until  
the formatting process is  
finished.  
5 .  
Touch <OK>.  
N O TE  
If “Error” appears on screen,  
Initialization of the disk begins.  
Touch <Cancel> to go back to the previous screen.  
When initialization is completed, youre returned to the previous screen.  
1 0 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Sa vin g So n g s  
A recorded performance is discarded when you switch off the power or choose  
another song. Storing recorded performances and other data to floppy disks or the  
Favorites (KR-7) is called “saving.” Be sure to save important songs to floppy disks  
or Favorites (KR-7).  
When using a new floppy disk,  
first initialize (format) the disk  
on the KR-7/ 5. Take a look at  
W h a t a re Fa vo rite s? ”  
You can register songs you are currently practicing or particularly like to  
On the KR-7, when you register a song on a floppy disk to Favorites, you can then  
play back the song without inserting the floppy disk in the disk drive.  
If a recorded performance is saved to Favorites, the performance wont be erased  
when the power is turned off.  
N O TE  
Some commercially available  
music files cannot be saved  
because they are copy  
protected.  
Pre p a ra tio n s fo r Sa vin g Da ta  
When saving to floppy disks, first check to make sure that the floppy disks protect  
1 .  
2 .  
3 .  
Press the [Disk] button.  
Touch <File>.  
If not handled with care, a  
floppy disk can be damaged,  
or the data on it become  
corrupted, making playback  
impossible. We recommend  
saving your songs on two  
different floppy disks.  
Touch <Save>.  
The following “Save Song screen” appears.  
fig.d-songsave.eps_60  
When you want to clear all of  
the content saved to the  
“Favorites” and restore the  
settings to the original factory  
condition on the KR-7, refer to  
Display of the KR-7  
1 0 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
De te rm in in g th e n a m e o f th e so n g to b e sa ve d  
4 .  
Touch <Rename>.  
The following “Rename screen” appears.  
fig.d-songname.eps_60  
When you touch  
, the cursor moves.  
When you touch the icon for the letter or character to be input, the character appears  
at the cursor location. For example touching <ABC> in succession cycles you  
through the available choices in that character group (“A”B”C”...).  
Each touch of <A-a-0-!> cycles the type of characters through “English (upper case),”  
“English (lower case),” “numerals,” “symbols,” then back to “English (upper case).”  
When you touch <Del>, the character at the cursor position is deleted.  
When you touch <Ins>, a space is inserted at the cursor position.  
5 .  
When you have finished with the name, touch <Exit>.  
De te rm in in g th e Sa ve De stin a tio n  
6 .  
7 .  
Touch <Disk> or <Favorites>. (KR-7)  
Touch <Disk> if you are saving to a floppy disk; touch <Favorites> if you are saving  
to Favorites.  
Touch  
to select the save-destination song number.  
If a song name is displayed with a number a song is already saved to that number.  
If you select a number with a previously saved song and then proceed to save a new  
song, the previously saved song will be erased. If you do not want to lose a saved  
song, select a number with no song name indicated in the save-destination column.  
1 0 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Se le ctin g th e to n e co m p a tib ility fo rm a t (w h e n sa vin g to d isk s)  
8 .  
Touch <KR> or <MT>.  
Some Tones are unique to the KR-7/ 5. Data that is recorded using these tones may  
not play back correctly on other Roland Digital Pianos or Music Players. When you  
want to save data so that it can be played back on another devices, save the data with  
“MT” set as the Tone compatibility format.  
Display  
KR  
Explanation  
The song is saved as data capable of reproducing performances with  
richness of expression using the KR-7/ 5s special Tones.  
Data is saved in a form that can also be played on the Roland Digital  
Pianos or Music Players other than the KR-7/ 5.  
You can listen to songs saved in this format on the Roland HP-G/ R se-  
ries and KR series keyboards as well as on Roland MT series devices.  
MT  
<N o te >  
When data saved with “MT” as the Tone compatibility format is played back on this  
instrument, some of the nuances that were part of the performance at the time the  
data was recorded may be altered.  
Even with data saved with “MT” as the Tone compatibility format, an exact  
reproduction of the original performance may be unobtainable when using GS  
devices other than Roland Pianos and Music Players.  
Sa ve  
N O TE  
9 .  
Touch <Save> or <As SMF> to start saving.  
You can only save songs in one  
format on a single floppy disk.  
The resulting file format will be different depending on whether <Save> or <As  
SMF> is chosen, as described below.  
N O TE  
Never turn off the power  
Display  
Explanation  
while the saving operation is  
in progress. Doing so will  
damage the KR-7/5’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
Saves the song in KR-7/ 5 format. You can listen to songs saved in  
this format on the Roland HP-G/ R series and KR series key-  
boards as well as on Roland MT series devices. This format is  
called “i-format”.  
Save  
Saves the song as an SMF (Standard MIDI Files). Songs saved in  
this SMF format can be listened to on many instruments that can  
A song recorded using commercial music files cant be saved in  
“Save As SMF” format for reasons of copyright protection.  
Save As SMF  
It’s a good idea to get into the  
habit of moving the write-  
protect tab on the floppy disk  
to the “Protect” position when  
youve finished saving your  
data. Keeping the tab at  
The time required for saving ranges from several seconds to half a minute or more.  
Dont take the floppy disk out of the disk drive until the saving process is finished.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Song File screen.  
“Protect” prevents operations  
that could erase your songs by  
mistake.  
N O TE  
Depending on the playback  
instrument, some notes may  
drop out or sound different.  
1 0 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
De le tin g Sa ve d So n g s  
This deletes songs that have been saved on floppy disks, or to Favorites (KR-7).  
To delete a song on a floppy disk, first insert the floppy disk in the disk drive.  
1 .  
2 .  
Press the [Disk] button.  
Touch <File>.  
The “Song File screen” appears.  
3 .  
Touch <Delete>.  
A “Delete Song screen” appears.  
fig.d-songdel.eps_60  
Display of the KR-7  
4 .  
Touch <Disk> or <Favorites> (KR-7).  
Touch <Disk> if you are deleting a song from a floppy disk; touch <Favorites> if you  
are deleting a song from Favorites.  
5 .  
6 .  
Touch  
to select the song to be deleted.  
Touch <Delete>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.m-filedel.eps_60  
N O TE  
7 .  
Touch <OK>.  
Never turn off the power  
while the operation is in  
progress. Doing so will  
The selected song is deleted.  
Do not eject the floppy disk from the disk drive until the operation is finished.  
Touching <Cancel> cancels the operation.  
damage the KR-7/5’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Song File screen.  
1 0 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Co p y in g So n g s o n Disk s to Fa vo rite s  
(KR-7 )  
You can take songs saved on floppy disks and copy them to Favorites.  
You can also copy songs in Favorites to floppy disks.  
1 .  
2 .  
3 .  
4 .  
Insert the disk with the song to be copied in the disk drive.  
Press the [Disk] button.  
Touch <File>.  
Touch <Copy>.  
The following “Copy Song screen” appears.  
fig.d-songcopy.eps_60  
Sp e cify in g th e Co p y So u rce  
5 .  
Touch the <Disk>  
to select the song you want to copy.  
When “Copy All” is selected, all of the songs on the disk are copied to Favorites.  
Sp e cify in g th e Co p y De stin a tio n  
6 .  
Touch <Favorites>  
to select the copy destination for the song.  
If a song name is displayed with a number, a song is already saved to that number.  
If you select a number with previously saved song data and proceed to copy to that  
location, the previously saved song will be erased. If you dont want to erase a  
previously saved song, choose a number with no song name appears in the  
destination column.  
N O TE  
Never turn off the power  
while the operation is in  
progress. Doing so will  
7 .  
Touch <Execute>.  
Do not eject the floppy disk from the disk drive until the copy is finished.  
The song from the disk is copied to Favorites.  
damage the KR-7’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
1 1 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 4 Re co rd in g a n d Sa vin g th e Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Co p y in g So n g s Sa ve d in Fa vo rite s to Disk s  
(KR-7 )  
Songs thatve been saved to Favorites can be copied onto floppy disks.  
In this case, in the “Copy Song screen” in Step 4 above, touch the large arrow icon in  
the center to point the arrow upwards. This sets the KR-7 to copy the song in  
Favorites to the floppy disk.  
fig.d-songcopy2.eps_60  
The rest of the procedure is identical to that used for copying songs from floppy  
disks to Favorites.  
Some song data cannot copy  
because they are copy  
protected.  
1 1 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ch a p te r 5 Use r Pro g ra m Re g istra tio n  
De te rm in in g th e n a m e o f th e Use r Pro g ra m s  
Sa vin g Pe rfo rm a n ce Se ttin g s  
(Use r Pro g ra m )  
4 . Touch <Rename>.  
A “Rename screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-upgname.eps_50  
Any collection of settings, including those describing the  
current status of your data selections or settings Automatic  
Accompaniment, can be saved to the [User Program] button.  
You can then call up the stored settings by pressing the [User  
Program] button. Saving your preferred combinations of  
Music Styles and Tones, as well as other frequently used  
settings, makes it more convenient.  
You can register up to 36 User Programs to the KR-7/ 5.  
fig.panel_UPG  
When you touch  
, the cursor moves.  
When you touch the icon for the character to be input,  
the character appears of the cursor potion.  
For example, touching the <ABC> icon in succession  
cycles you through the available choices in that character  
group (ABCA...).  
KR-7  
For more on what can be registered to a User Program, refer to  
Each touch of <A-a-0-!> cycles the type of characters  
through “English (upper case),” “English (lower case),”  
“numerals,” “symbols,” then back to “English (upper  
case).”  
1 . Set the Music Style, Tone, and other data until the  
settings are the way you want them.  
2 . Press the [User Program] button.  
When you touch <Del>, the character at the cursor  
position is deleted.  
A “User Program screen” like the one shown below  
appears.  
fig.d-upg.eps_50  
When you touch <Ins>, a space is inserted at the cursor  
position.  
5 . When you have finished with the name, touch <Exit>.  
Youre returned to the Write User Program screen.  
De te rm in in g th e w rite d e stin a tio n  
6 . Touch  
number.  
to select the write-destination  
7 . Touch <Write>.  
3 . Touch <Write>.  
The confirmation message appears.  
A “Write User Program screen” like the following  
8 . Touch <OK>.  
appears.  
fig.d-upgwrite.eps_50  
The current performance settings are saved to the [User  
Program] button.  
* Never turn off the power while the display indicates  
<Executing...>. Doing so will damage the KR-7/5’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
You can restore the content registered to the [User Program]  
1 1 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Ch a p te r 5 Use r Pro g ra m Re g istra tio n  
Ca llin g Up Sa ve d Use r  
Pro g ra m s  
Sa ving the User Prog ra m Sets  
You can take the 36 User Programs saved to the [User  
Program] button and save them as a set to a floppy disk, or to  
user memory (KR-7).  
You can easily call up settings saved to the [User Program]  
button.  
When saving to a floppy disk, first insert a floppy disk in the  
disk drive.  
1 . Press the [User Program] button.  
The “User Program screen” appears.  
2 . Touch the name of the User Program you want to call  
up.  
1 . Press the [User Program] button.  
2 . Touch <File>.  
When you touch the name of the User Program, the  
buttons or other performance settings instantly change  
to the previously saved settings.  
3 . Touch <Save>.  
A “Save User Program screen” like the following  
Ch a n g in g th e W a y Use r  
appears.  
fig.d-upgsave.eps_50  
Pro g ra m s Are Ca lle d Up  
When calling up User Programs, you can prevent the settings  
for Automatic Accompaniment from switching by not  
touching the touch screen for a few moments.  
1 . Press the [User Program] button.  
2 . Touch <Option> in the lower part of the screen.  
A settings screen like the following appears.  
fig.d-upgopt.eps_50  
Display of  
the KR-7  
Givin g a n a m e to a se t o f Use r Pro g ra m s  
4 . Touch <Rename>.  
The Rename screen appears.  
When you touch  
, the cursor moves.  
When you touch the icon for the character to be input,  
the character appears at the cursor position. For example  
touching the <ABC> icon in succession cycles you  
through the available choices in that character group  
(ABCA...).  
3 . Touch <Instant> or <Delayed> to select the setting.  
Display  
Instant  
Explanation  
Each touch of <A-a-0-!> cycles the type of characters  
through “English (upper case),” “English (lower case),”  
“numerals,” “symbols,” then back to “English (upper  
case).”  
Immediately after a User Program name is  
touched, the Automatic Accompaniment  
settings also switch.  
The Automatic Accompaniment settings  
switch after you touch and road the User  
Program name for a few moments.  
When you touch <Del>, the character at the cursor  
position is deleted.  
Delayed  
When you touch <Ins>, a space is inserted at the cursor  
position.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the User Program screen.  
5 . When you have finished with the name, touch <Exit>.  
1 1 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 5 Use r Pro g ra m Re g istra tio n  
De te rm in in g th e sa ve d e stin a tio n  
Lo a d in g Sa ve d Use r Pro g ra m  
6 . Touch <Disk> or <User>. (KR-7)  
Se ts  
User Programs that have been saved on floppy disks or in  
user memory (KR-7) can be called up, on an individual set  
basis, to the [User Program] button.  
Touch <Disk> if you are saving to a floppy disk; touch  
<User> if you are saving to user memory.  
7 . Touch  
Program number.  
to select the save-destination User  
* Note that calling up these User Programs results in the  
deletion of all User Programs currently recorded to the [User  
Program] button.  
If a User Program set name is displayed, a User Program  
set saved to that saved to that number is already.  
When loading a set of User Programs from a floppy disk,  
first insert the floppy disk in the disk drive.  
If you select a number with previously saved User  
Program set data, then save a new set of data to that  
same number, the older User Program set will be  
deleted. If you dont want to lose any previously saved  
User Programs, select a number in the save-destination  
column that does not yet have a name.  
1 . Press the [User Program] button.  
2 . Touch <File>.  
3 . Touch <Load>.  
Sa ve  
A “Load User Program screen” like the following  
8 . Touch <Save> to begin the save.  
appears.  
fig.d-upgload.eps_50  
Touch <Exit> to return to the User Program File screen.  
* Never turn off the power or eject the floppy disk from the disk  
drive while the operation is in progress. Doing so will damage  
the KR-7/5’s internal memory, making it unusable.  
When clearing the set of saved User Programs, refer to  
Display of  
the KR-7  
Sp e cify in g th e se t o f Use r Pro g ra m s to b e  
lo a d e d  
4 . Touch <  
(Disk)> or <  
(User)>. (KR-7)  
Touch <  
> if you are loading User Programs from a  
floppy disk; touch <  
> if you are loading User  
Programs from the user memory.  
5 . Touch the name of User Program to load.  
6 . Touch <Load>.  
The confirmation message appears.  
7 . Touch <OK>.  
The selected User Programs are loaded to the [User  
Program] button.  
* Never turn off the power or eject the floppy disk from the disk  
drive while the operation is in progress. Doing so will damage  
the KR-7/5’s internal memory, making it unusable.  
1 1 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 5 Use r Pro g ra m Re g istra tio n  
Cop ying Sets of User Prog ra m s on  
Disk s to the User Mem ory (KR-7 )  
De le tin g Sa ve d Use r  
Pro g ra m Se ts  
You can copy sets of User Programs saved on floppy disks  
and to user memory.  
You can delete individual User Program sets saved to floppy  
disks or in user memory.  
You can also copy sets of User Programs saved in user  
memory and to floppy disks.  
When deleting a set of User Programs on a floppy disk, first  
insert the floppy disk in the disk drive.  
1 . Insert the disk with the settings to be copied in the disk  
drive.  
2 . Touch the [User Program] button.  
1 . Press the [User Program] button.  
2 . Touch <File>.  
3 . Touch <File>.  
4 . Touch <Copy>.  
3 . Touch <Delete>.  
A “Copy User Programs screen” like the following  
A “Delete User Program screen” like the following  
appears.  
fig.d-upgcopy.eps_50  
appears.  
fig.d-upgdel.eps_50  
Display of  
the KR-7  
Sp e cify in g th e co p y so u rce  
4 . Touch <Disk> or <User>. (KR-7)  
5 . Touch <Disk>  
to select the set of User  
Touch <Disk> if you are deleting User Programs from a  
floppy disk; touch <User> if you are deleting User  
Programs from the user memory.  
Programs you want to copy.  
When “All” is selected, all of the sets of User Programs  
on the disk are copied to user memory.  
5 . Touch  
be deleted.  
to select the set of User Programs to  
Sp e cify in g th e co p y d e stin a tio n  
6 . Touch <User>  
to select the copy destination  
6 . Touch <Delete>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
for the set of User Programs.  
fig.msg_filedel  
If a User Program name is displayed, already a User  
Program saved to that number is already.  
If you select a number with User Programs data, and  
then copy data to that number, the previously saved  
User Programs are deleted. If you do not want to delete  
the saved User Programs, select a number in the save-  
destination column for which no name is displayed.  
7 . Touch <OK>.  
7 . Touch <Execute>.  
The set of User Programs on the disk is saved to user  
memory.  
The selected User Programs are deleted.  
Touching <Cancel> cancels deleting the file.  
* Never turn off the power or eject the floppy disk from the disk  
drive while the operation is in progress. Doing so will damage  
the KR-7’s internal memory, making it unusable.  
* Never turn off the power or eject the floppy disk from the disk  
drive while the operation is in progress. Doing so will damage  
the KR-7/5’s internal memory, making it unusable.  
1 1 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Ch a p te r 5 Use r Pro g ra m Re g istra tio n  
Co p in g Se ts o f Use r Pro g ra m s  
Sto re d in th e Use r Me m o ry to  
Disk s (KR-7 )  
Sim u lta n e o u sly Sw itch in g  
Use r Pro g ra m a n d  
Tra n sm ittin g PC N u m b e rs  
You can take User Program sets saved in user memory and  
You can have PC (Program Change) numbers be transmitted  
to an external MIDI device when you switch the User  
Program on the KR.  
copy them to floppy disks.  
In this case, in the Copy User Programs screen in Step 4  
above, touch the large arrow icon in the center to get the  
arrow to point up. This sets the KR-7 to copy the User  
Program set in the user memory to the floppy disk.  
You can register PC number settings to each of the User  
Programs, just as you can with button settings and other  
settings preferences.  
The rest of the procedure is identical to that used for copying  
sets of User Program set from disks to user memory.  
Ca llin g Up th e Pe rfo rm a n ce Se ttin g s to Be Se t  
1 . Press the [User Program] button, then touch the name  
of the performance setting you want to set.  
Usin g th e Pe d a l to Sw itch  
Use r Pro g ra m s  
Se ttin g th e Tra n sm issio n o f th e PC  
2 . Touch <PC Set> in the User Program screen.  
You can use the Pedal as a dedicated switch for selecting  
User Programs in order.  
The following type of screen appears.  
fig-upgPCset.eps_50  
1 . Press the [User Program] button.  
2 . Touch <Option> in the lower part of the screen.  
3 . Touch  
following.  
to display screen like the  
fig.d-upgopt.eps_50  
3 . Touch  
settings.  
for the parameter and make the  
Display  
Description  
This prevents the PC number from being  
transmitted (Off), or sets the transmission  
channel (Channel 1–16).  
Tx PC  
Channel  
4 . Touch  
to select the setting.  
Explanation  
Display  
Bank  
Select LSB  
Sets the Bank Select LSB.  
Sets the Bank Select MSB.  
You can use a function assigned to the  
pedal.  
Off  
Bank  
Select MSB  
The left pedal is dedicated to switching  
User Programs.The function assigned to  
the left pedal cannot be used.  
Left Pedal  
Program  
Change  
Sets the Program Change messages (Pro-  
gram Numbers).  
The center pedal is dedicated to switch-  
Center Pedal ing User Programs.The function assigned  
4 . Touch <Exit>.  
to the center pedal cannot be used.  
The User Program screen returns to the display.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the User Program screen.  
Touch <Write> to save the setting to the User Program.  
1 1 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Co m m e rcia lly Ava ila b le Mu sic File s  
Commercially available song file recorded in Rolands SMF  
Mu ltitra ck Re co rd in g w ith 1 6  
Pa rts (1 6 -Tra ck Se q u e n ce r)  
format is also composed of sixteen parts.  
By loading the song file from the floppy disk and using the  
Multitrack recording always you to listen to previously  
16-Track Sequencer, you can then also edit the song file.  
recorded material while continuing to add performances of  
Although with commercially available Roland SMF music  
data, Part 11 is included in the [2/Bass Accomp] track button,  
other tracks match to the corresponding Track buttons.  
other parts.  
The KR-7/ 5 is capable of multitrack recording of up to  
sixteen parts. Since each parts performance is recorded  
using one tone, you can layer performances, using up to  
sixteen tones for the data in one song. The function used to  
layer these sixteen parts, one at a time, is called the “16-Track  
* With some commercially available music files, you cannot edit  
the data.  
Sequencer.”  
fig.16track.e  
Th e 1 6 -Tra ck Se q u e n ce r Scre e n  
When recording with 16-track Sequencer, display the 16-  
1 6 -Tra ck Se q u e n ce r  
You can record performances for up to 16 parts,  
overlaying them part by part, to create a single song.  
track Sequencer screen.  
1 . Press the [Menu] button.  
Part 1  
Flute Part  
Part 2  
Part 3  
Part 4  
The Menu screen appears.  
Bass Part  
2 . Touch <16trk Sequencer>.  
Piano Part (left hand)  
Piano Part (right hand)  
A “16-track Sequencer screen” like the one shown below  
appears.  
Part 16  
fig.d-16tr.eps_50  
1 6 -Tra ck Se q u e n ce r a n d Tra ck Bu tto n s  
In addition to the “16-Track Sequencer” function, the “Track  
functions.  
These five “Track buttons” are used for organizing the 16-  
Track Sequencers sixteen parts. This allows you to use the  
16-Track Sequencer to add more sounds to performances  
recorded with the Track buttons, and make even more  
detailed edits of the songs.  
You can easily play back the original song data with the 16-  
Track Sequencer, mute parts by pressing the Track buttons,  
and more.  
Icon  
Description  
Touch to select the part to be recorded, or the  
part whose settings are to be changed. The  
Part you choose appears is highlighted.  
<1>-  
<16>  
The Track buttons correspond to 16-track sequencer parts as  
shown below.  
This Part to be played back  
Track button  
[R/Rhythm]  
[1/Whole]  
Part  
D (10), S (11)  
The Part not to be played back (Muted Part)  
1
[2/Bass Accomp]  
[3/Lower]  
2, 5–9, 12–16  
Parts that do not have performance data re-  
corded to them.  
3
4
[4/Upper]  
Solo  
Mute  
Only the selected Part is played back.  
Since the 16-Track Sequencer records one tone to one part,  
simultaneously. Also, you cant record the performance with  
Automatic Accompaniment.  
This allows you to prevent the sound for the  
selected part from playing.  
The performance data for the selected part is  
deleted.  
Clear  
When you want to record with Automatic Accompaniment,  
then you should use the Track buttons for recording. (Refer  
This displays the Part Settings screen, in  
which you can make detailed settings for each  
Options  
1 1 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Icon  
Description  
4 . Touch  
the setting.  
for the corresponding item to change  
The Tone Set screen appears. For details refer  
Tone Set  
You can also change the values by touching each  
parameter slider and then using the [-] [+] buttons and  
the dial.  
Mo d ify in g th e Se ttin g s o f Ea ch Pa rt  
You can change the Tones and volume, as well as mute the  
playback, for each individual part in songs recorded with the  
16-track Sequencer and the internal songs.  
Display  
Description  
Because commercially available Roland SMF music files are  
also made up of 16 Parts, you can change the settings for the  
individual Parts and play them back in the same way.  
Volume  
Reverb  
Chorus  
Changes the volume level.  
Changes the amount of reverb effect  
applied to the sound.  
First, select the song for which the settings are to be made  
Changes the amount of chorus applied.  
Shifts the direction from which the sound is  
heard between left and right.  
2 . Touch the screen to choose the Part for which you want  
Panpot  
Touch  
to shift the sound to the right,  
to shift it to the left.  
to make settings.  
or touch  
Change the settings for the selected Part.  
Display  
Solo  
Function  
W h a t’s Pa n p o t?  
Panpot is the control that determines the placement of  
the sound in the stereo sound field between left and  
right speakers. By altering the Panpot setting, you can  
change the perceived location of the sound between the  
left and right speakers.  
Only the selected Part is played back.  
Toggles playback of the selected Part to on  
or off.  
Mute  
Clear  
The performance data for the selected part is  
deleted.  
* When you touch <Clear>, a message asking you to confirm the  
deletion appears. To erase the recorded sound, touch <OK>. If  
you don’t want to erase the recorded sound, touch <Cancel>.  
Once a performance has been erased, it can’t be restored.  
When you press the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button, you  
hear what the song sounds like as you change the  
settings. When you press the [  
(Play/ Stop)]  
button, playback of the song stops.  
3 . Touch <Options> to make more detailed settings for  
5 . Touch  
to make settings for other parts.  
the selected part.  
The Part name appears at the upper part of the screen.  
Change the settings for other parts as needed.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-16trpart.eps_50  
6 . Hold down the [  
(Rec)] button and press the [  
(Reset)] button.  
This operation set the changes in the settings.  
The song can then be saved to a floppy disk or to user  
memory (KR-7).  
If you do not want to delete a song after changing the  
settings for the individual parts, save the song to a  
You can change the Tone for the selected Part by  
pressing a Tone button while this screen is displayed.  
When selecting Part 10 or 11, you can touch <Drum Set>  
to select the drum set or effect sound.  
* You cannot save the settings that determine whether sounds  
for each individual part are played or not (solo and mute).  
The Part name and tone name are displayed at the top of  
the screen.  
1 1 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
If th e fo llo w in g m e ssa g e a p p e a rs  
Re co rd in g a Pe rfo rm a n ce  
Ste p 1 Pre p a re fo r Re co rd in g  
Se le ctin g th e so n g to re co rd  
If you try to display another screen after youve changed the  
songs settings for each Part, a message like the one below  
may appear.  
fig.m-songmod.eps  
1 . Press the [Select/Listen to a Song] button.  
2 . Touch the genre of the song youre recording.  
When recording a new song, try recording to  
“Favorites.”  
3 . Select the song number to which you want to record.  
If recording a new song, touch <0: (Song Name)> to  
Touch <OK> to change the songs settings.  
select <0: New Song>.  
fig.d-songnew.eps_50  
Touch <Cancel> to discard the changes youre made.  
Ge ttin g th e Mo st Su ita b le Pa rt  
To n e s fo r th e Mu sica l Ge n re  
(To n e Se t)  
“Tone Set” is a function that automatically assigns the most  
suitable tones for the selected musical style.  
When youre creating a song, you can assign Tone sets, then  
change the Tones to suit the ideas you have for your song.  
If a song has already been recorded, or if the song’s settings  
have been changed, the “OK to delete Song?” confirmation  
prompt appears when you touch <0: (Song Name)>. For more  
2 . Touch <Tone Set> in the lower part of the screen.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-16trtone.eps_50  
De te rm in in g th e so n g ’s b e a t a n d te m p o  
You cant change a song’s beat once it’s been recorded. If you  
want to compose a song whose beat changes partway through  
5 . Press the Tempo [-] and [+] buttons to set the basic  
3 . Touch the screen to select a musical genre.  
tempo of the song.  
4 . Touch <Exit>.  
If you do not need the metronome sound, press the  
[Metronome] button once more.  
The 16-track Sequencer screen appears.  
Tones for each part are assigned automatically.  
When using song data that has already been recorded, the  
recording is made using the source song’s basic tempo. To  
* In some genres, some parts may have no tone assigned.  
1 1 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Ste p 2 Sta rt Re co rd in g  
Ch a n g in g th e Re co rd in g  
Me th o d (Re c Mo d e )  
If necessary, choose a recording method.  
If you record for the first time, theres no need to select the  
recording method.  
You can use any of the four methods below to record with  
the KR-7/ 5.  
Although you will normally be using “Replace Recording,”  
where previously recorded material is erased when new  
sounds are recorded, youll find that you can record songs  
easily by using this method in combination with other  
recording methods.  
Se le ctin g th e Pa rt to Re co rd  
2 . Touch the number for the Part you want to record.  
The Part you touch appears in reverse video.  
You can only record drum sounds or effect sounds on  
Part D (10) or Part S (11). You can select drum sets or  
effect sounds by selecting Part D (10) or Part S (11) and  
touching <Drum Set>.  
This is the normal method for recording. New material is  
recorded as previously recorded material is erased.  
Se le ctin g th e so u n d to p la y  
New notes are recorded on top of notes previously recorded.  
3 . Use the Tone buttons to choose a Tone to play.  
This convenient feature makes it easy for you to record  
melodies over prerecorded accompaniment.  
After selecting a Tone, touch <Exit> to call up the “16-  
Track Sequencer screen.”  
Re co rd in g th e p e rfo rm a n ce  
Specified measures are recorded repeatedly, while new notes  
are combined with existing music. A convenient feature for  
creating rhythm parts. Loop Recording allows you to record  
over and over within a selected segment, adding a different  
percussion sound with each pass.  
4 . Press the [  
(Reset)] button.  
Recording will start at the beginning of the song.  
If you want to record from a point other than the  
beginning, use the [  
(Bwd)] and [  
(Fwd)]  
buttons to select another measure to begin.  
5 . Press the [  
(Rec)] button and watch the indicator is  
You can re-record only a specified passage as you listen to a  
recorded performance.  
light up.  
Immediately after the power is turned on, Replace Recording is  
The KR-7/ 5 is put in recording standby.  
6 . Press the [ (Play/Stop)] button.  
selected.  
A two-bar count-in sounds, then recording starts.  
* You cannot use the performance pads when recording with the  
16-track sequencer.  
7 . Press the [  
Recording stops.  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
When one part is recorded, continue by selecting and  
recording another part. Continue layering parts to finish  
recording the song.  
You only need to follow the procedure described in “Step 1 –  
Prepare for Recording” when you’re recording the first Part.  
For the second Part and after, you can skip step 1 and proceed  
from Step 2 Start Recording.”  
* Any performance that has been recorded is deleted when the  
power to the KR-7/5 is turned off. It is a good idea to save song  
data to a floppy disk or user memory. For more information,  
1 2 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Ch a n g in g th e Re co rd in g Me th o d  
Re co rd in g W h ile Era sin g th e  
Pre vio u s Re co rd in g (Re p la ce  
Re co rd in g )  
The recording process where previous material is erased as  
new material is recorded is called “replace recording.” This  
setting is in effect when you turn on the power.  
1 . Press the [Menu] button.  
The Menu screen appears.  
fig.d-menu1.eps_50  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Menu screen.  
The KR-7/ 5 is set to the replace recording mode.  
Record the performance using the procedures described  
Display of  
the KR-7  
2 . Touch <Rec Mode>.  
A “Rec Mode screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-recmode.eps_50  
La y e rin g a Re co rd in g O ve r  
Pre vio u sly Re co rd e d So u n d s  
(Mix Re co rd in g )  
You can record a performance layered over a previously  
recorded performance. This method is called “Mix  
Recording.”  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Menu screen.  
Record the performance using the procedures described  
methods.  
3 . Touch <Rec Mode>  
to select the recording  
mode.  
* After you have finished with mix recording, return to the  
usual replace recording mode.  
Display  
Replace  
Mix  
Recording Method  
Replace Recording  
Mix Recording  
Loop  
Loop Recording  
Auto Punch-  
In/Out  
Punch-in recording of the interval  
between set markers  
Punch-in recording starting from the  
point at which the pedal, the  
Manual  
Punch-In/Out  
Performance Pad or the [  
ton is pressed  
(Rec)] but-  
For more about Punch In Recording,  
You can add tempo changes to a  
Tempo  
4 . Touch <Exit>.  
Returns to the Menu screen.  
1 2 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
5 . Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button to begin  
Rep ea ted Record ing a t the  
recording.  
Sa m e Loca tion (Loop Record ing )  
You can record a specified passage over and over, layering  
sounds with each pass. This method is called “Loop  
Recording.” This is handy when recording a Rhythm Part.  
Recording starts from Marker A.  
When the song reaches Marker B, it then returns to  
Marker A, where recording continues.  
For example, use this method to make a Loop Recording of a  
four-measure segment. First record the bass drum, the snare  
drum next, then the hi-hat and so on, layering a different  
instrument onto the same four measures. After you have  
finished recording the four-measure rhythm pattern, you can  
need to complete your Rhythm part.  
Each time the recording is looped, the newest sounds are  
layered over previously recorded sounds.  
6 . When you press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button,  
recording stops.  
* After you have finished with loop recording, return to the  
1 . Place A and B markers at the beginning and end of the  
Lo o p Re co rd in g Sh o rtcu t  
passage you want to record.  
You can also use the method described below to set Loop  
Recording.  
1 . Place A and B markers at the beginning and end of  
If you havent recorded anything yet, then use “Blank  
Recording” to create the necessary number of measures  
before placing the markers.  
the passage you want to record.  
If you havent recorded anything yet, then perform  
Blank Recording” for the necessary number of  
measures before placing the markers.  
W h a t is Bla n k Re co rd in g ?  
Blank Recording is recording a number of silent  
measures with no content.  
2 . Touch the <Repeat> icon in the Marker screen  
1 . Set the basic tempo and beat of the song.  
2 . Hold down the [  
(Rec)] button and press the  
This sets the loop recording mode.  
Start a recording.  
[
(Play/Stop)] button.  
The indicators for the [  
(Rec)] and [  
(Play/  
* After you have finished with loop recording, touch the  
<Repeat> icon in the “Marker screen” once more to  
return to the usual replace recording mode.  
Stop)] buttons both light up, and recording starts.  
3 . Without performing anything, record only the  
required number of measures, then press the  
[
(Play/Stop)] button.  
The indicators for the [ (Rec)] and [  
(Play/  
Stop)] buttons both go out, and recording stops.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the menu screen.  
The recording method changes to loop recording.  
3 . Press the [  
(Rec)] button.  
4 . Press the Track button for the track to be recorded.  
The KR-7/ 5 is put in recording standby.  
1 2 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
3 . Begin recording.  
Re -Re co rd in g Pa rt o f Yo u r  
Pe rfo rm a n ce (Pu n ch -in Re co rd in g )  
Begin recording using the procedures described in  
You can re-record part of a passage as you listen to a  
recorded performance. This recording method is called  
“Punch-in Recording.” This convenient function lets you  
record over a specified points in a part as you listen to a  
prerecorded performance in another section.  
Up until the specified passage, the previously recorded  
performance plays back.  
User Punch-In Recording by the following two methods:  
When you reach the specified passage, sounds are erased  
as recording starts; begin playing now.  
Recording the Region Defined by Markers A and B  
(Auto Punch-In/Out)  
When you reach the end of the specified passage,  
recording stops, and the KR-7/ 5 returns to playback of  
the previously recorded performance.  
Before you start recording, place markers A and B to  
define the passage you want to re-record. Make the  
setting for punch-in recording, and re-record just the  
passage between markers A and B.  
4 . When you press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button, the  
song stops.  
Recording From the Point at Which the Pedal or Buttons  
Are Pressed (Manual Punch-In/Out)  
Sta rtin g Re co rd in g fro m th e Me a su re  
You can play back a performance and depress the pedal  
at the desired place to start re-recording. Depressing the  
pedal a second time cancels recording and returns you to  
playback.  
Sp e cifie d b y Bu tto n s a n d Pe d a ls  
If using the Performance Pads or pedals, you must first  
change the function of the pedals and Pads. Follow the  
When you use the Performance Pads or [  
(Rec)]  
and assign <Auto Punch-In/ Out> to the buttons or pedal.  
button, recording begins when you press the Pad or  
button upon reaching a specified point in the song.  
When you press the Pad or [  
(Rec)] button once more,  
the KR-7/ 5 exits recording mode and returns to normal  
playback.  
In/Out>.  
This changes the recording mode to “Punch-In  
Recording.”  
Re co rd in g a Pa ssa g e Sp e cifie d b y Ma rk e rs  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Menu screen.  
1 . Before you start re-recording, place markers A and B to  
define the passage.  
2 . Begin recording.  
and B to specify the passage.  
Begin recording using the procedures described in  
Out>.  
The previously recorded performance will be played  
back.  
fig.d-rec-punch.eps_50  
Recording begins when you press the pedal, the  
Performance Pad, or the [  
recording at this time.  
(Rec)] button; start re-  
Recording stops when you press the pedal, the  
Performance Pad, or the [  
(Rec)] button again, and  
the previously recorded performance is played back.  
3 . When you press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button, the  
performance stops.  
This changes the recording mode to “Punch-In  
Recording.”  
* When you’re finished with Punch-In Recording, return to the  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Menu screen.  
1 2 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
4 . Touch <Exit>.  
Co m p o sin g a n  
Acco m p a n im e n t By En te rin g  
Ch o rd s (Ch o rd Se q u e n ce r)  
You are returned to the Chord Sequencer screen.  
5 . Enter the chord progression and the accompaniment  
pattern.  
You can enter a chord progression and choose the places  
where the accompaniment pattern will change to create an  
accompaniment for a song. This feature is called “Chord  
Sequencer.”  
Refer to “Inputting Chords with the Chord Sequencer.”  
6 . When you have finished inputting all the data, touch  
<Execute>.  
The accompaniment youve composed is registered at “0:  
Thanks to the chord sequencer, you can create an  
accompaniment ahead of time and play along with your  
right hand.  
New Song.”  
When storage of the data is complete, return to the Menu  
screen.  
1 . Press the [Menu] button and watch the indicator light  
Now, press the [  
(Play/ Stop)] button, and try  
up.  
playing the melody along with the accompaniment you  
created.  
The Menu screen appears.  
2 . Touch <Chord Sequencer>.  
* Songs you’ve created are discarded as soon as you turn off the  
power. If you do not want to delete the song, save it to a floppy  
The screen like the one shown below is called “Chord  
Sequencer screen.”  
fig.d-chordseq.eps_50  
In p u ttin g Ch o rd s w ith th e Ch o rd Se q u e n ce r  
This is the “cursor.The cursor  
shows where the chord change  
or other information is input.  
This is the end of the song. When  
continuing to add input, insert  
measures by touching <Ins>.  
Move the cursor  
Change the accompaniment arrangements  
Panel of  
the KR-7  
Select the accompaniment pattern (Division)  
1 . Use the [+] [-] buttons or the dial to move the cursor to  
This indicates the position where the  
accompaniment pattern (Division) or  
the Style Orchestrator changes.  
the input position.  
Use the [  
(Bwd)] and [  
(Fwd)] buttons to move  
the cursor one measure at a time.  
Display  
Ins  
Description  
2 . Enter the chord progression and the changes in the  
accompaniment pattern and arrangement.  
One measure is inserted before the measure  
where the cursor is positioned.  
Just as when performing with Automatic  
The measure in which the cursor is posi-  
tioned is deleted.  
Accompaniment, press the keys to specify a chord, and  
Del  
Allows input of chords without playing the  
Chords  
3 . Touch <Ins> once to insert one measure before the  
All Clear  
Clear  
Deletes all of the data thats been input.  
Deletes the data at the cursor position.  
measure where the cursor is currently positioned.  
If you touch <Del>, the measure where the cursor is  
currently positioned is deleted, while the measures that  
follow are moved forward.  
Records the input chord progression.  
Touch this icon when you have finished in-  
putting all of the chords.  
Execute  
To remove what you have input, move the cursor to the  
position with input you want to delete, then touch  
<Clear>. This deletes the entered setting.  
3 . Press a Music Style button or the touch screen to select  
1 2 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
You can only insert an intro at the beginning of a song. When  
you add an intro, the number of bars corresponding to the  
length of the intro is inserted automatically.  
Ed itin g So n g s  
There are many ways you can edit performances recorded  
using the KR-7/ 5 Track button or 16-track sequencer.  
Fu n ctio n s Th a t Ca n Be Assig n e d to th e Pe d a ls  
a n d th e Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa d s  
Ba sic O p e ra tio n o f th e Ed itin g  
Fu n ctio n s  
* While songs are being loaded, the measure number in the  
upper right of the screen is highlighted (text and background  
are inverted). Start editing the song only after the measure  
number is no longer highlighted.  
Inputting a short Intro and Ending  
Assign “Intro 2/ Ending 2" to a pedal or pad.  
Inputting a “Variation” or “Original” without a Fill-In  
Assign “Original/ Variation” to a pedal or pad.  
Se le ctin g th e e d itin g fu n ctio n  
1 . Press the [Menu] button and watch the indicator light up.  
Using the keyboard to input slash chords (such as Fm/ C)  
Assign “Leading Bass” to a pedal or pad.  
The Menu screen appears.  
2 . Touch <Song Edit>.  
Inputting a break somewhere within the song  
Assign “Break” to a pedal or pad.  
A “Song Edit screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-edit1.eps_50  
Ch e ck th e a cco m p a n im e n t y o u in se rte d  
Heres how to play back as much of the accompaniment as  
you have input.  
1 . Press the [  
(Reset)] button to return to the  
beginning of the song.  
2 . When you press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button, the  
performance is played back.  
3 . Playback stops when you press the [  
(Play/Stop)]  
3 . Touch an editing function to select that function.  
button once more.  
For more detailed information, refer to the  
corresponding page for each function.  
In p u ttin g Ch o rd s w ith o u t  
Pla y in g th e Ke y b o a rd  
You can use <Chords> at the bottom right of the Chord  
Function  
Undo  
Description  
Page  
Sequencer screen to specify chords on the screen.  
Undoes editing operations that  
have been performed.  
1 . At the Chord Sequencer screen, touch <Chords>.  
Copies measures and internal  
rhythm patterns.  
Copy  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-chordinput.eps_50  
Evens out sounds in recorded  
performances.  
Quantize  
Delete  
Insert  
Deletes measures.  
Inserts a blank measure.  
Trans-  
pose  
Transposes parts individually.  
Erases data in measures, creating  
blank measures.  
Erase  
Part  
Exchange  
Exchanges the sounds in parts.  
Allows corrections to be made  
note by note.  
2 . Touch  
in each to specify the chords.  
Note Edit  
PC Edit  
3 . Touch <Execute> to enter the chord.  
Allows editing of the Tones  
changes that occur during a song.  
You are returned to the Chord Sequencer screen.  
1 2 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
”PC” stands for “Program Change,” which is a command that  
tells an instrument to change the sound it’s using. With songs  
that rely on the use of a variety of sounds, a “PC” needs to be  
located at every point within the song where the Tone is to be  
changed  
Co p y in g Me a su re s (Co p y )  
You can copy a portion of a performance to a different bar in  
the same Part or to a measure in another Part. This is handy  
when youre composing a song that repeats a similar phrase.  
fig.e-copy.e  
Ex. To copy measures 5-7 to measure 8.  
* Some edits can’t be undone, not even by choosing “Undo.” We  
recommend saving songs to floppy disks or to user memory before  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Ed itin g  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
4 . Touch the item to be edited.  
The value for the item being edited is highlighted.  
5 . Set the value with the [-] [+] buttons or the dial.  
<Copy>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-e-copy.eps_50  
To cancel the operation once it is underway, touch  
<Exit>.  
6 . When youre done making all the settings, touch  
<Execute>.  
When you are finished editing the setting, return to the  
“Song Edit screen.”  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Menu screen.  
Un d o in g Ed its (Un d o )  
You can cancel an editing operation that youve just carried  
out. This is handy when you want to undo an edit and  
restore data to the way it was before.  
Item  
From  
For  
Content  
Measure number of the first measure of the  
segment to be copied  
* There are some edits that can’t be restored.  
<Undo>.  
Number of measures to be copied  
Copy-source Track button or part number  
Editing functions that can be undone appear on screen.  
fig.d-e-undo.eps_50  
Choosing “All” copies all Parts. “—” appears in  
the <Dst> column.  
Choosing “R.Pattern” copies the KR-7/ 5s  
built-in Rhythm Patterns. For more informa-  
Src  
If you choose a Track button, you can only copy  
to the selected Track button. You cannot copy  
to the other Track buttons.  
Copy-destination measure number  
To  
When “End” is selected, the data is copied to  
the end of the song.  
If you touch <Cancel>, the undo is cancelled, and youre  
returned to the Song Edit screen.  
Times  
Dst  
Number of times the data is to be copied  
Copy-destination part number  
If you touch <OK>, the confirmation message appears on  
screen. Touch <OK> to undone the most recent edit.  
1 2 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Co rre ctin g Tim in g  
Item  
Content  
Discre p a n cie s (Q u a n tize )  
Data can be copied in the following three ways:  
You can correct for timing discrepancies in a recorded  
performance by automatically aligning the music with the  
timing you specify. This is called “Quantizing.”  
Replace  
If there is a performance recorded at the copy  
destination, this previous recording is erased,  
and the copied data is written in its place.  
As an example, lets say that the timing of some quarter-  
notes in a performance is a little off. In this case, you can  
quantize the performance with quarter-note timing, thus  
Mix  
If there is a performance recorded at the copy  
destination, the copied data is layered over the  
previous recording. If the Tones used for the  
copy source and copy destination are different,  
the copy-destination Tone is used.  
making the timing accurate.  
fig.e-quantize.e  
Mode  
Example: Quarter-note resolution  
Actual note data  
Insert  
1
2
2
3
4
If there is a performance recorded at the copy  
destination, the copied portion is inserted with-  
out erasing the previous recording. The song is  
lengthened by the number of inserted mea-  
sures.  
Note data after quantization  
Example: Sixteenth-note resolution  
Actual note data  
1
3
4
Co p y in g Rh y th m Pa tte rn s to  
Note data after quantization  
Cre a te Rh y th m Pa rts  
The KR-7/ 5 features numerous internal rhythm patterns.  
<Quantize>.  
You can copy these rhythm patterns to create a rhythm part.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
For more information about the name of Rhythm Patterns,  
fig.d-e-quant.eps_50  
<Copy>.  
Select “Rhythm Pattern” as the <Src>.  
This makes the setting for copying a built-in Rhythm Pattern.  
fig.d-e-copy2.eps_50  
Item  
From  
For  
Content  
Measure number of the first measure of the  
segment to be quantized  
Number of measures to be quantized  
Track button or part number to be  
quantized  
Tr/Pt  
Choosing “All” quantizes the same passage  
in all Parts.  
The rhythm patterns name and measure count are  
indicated in the <From> column.  
Quantization timing  
The <Dst> is fixed at “Part 10.”  
Select one of the following values  
1/ 2 (half note), 1/ 4 (quarter note),  
1/ 6 (quarter-note triplet), 1/ 8 (eighth note),  
1/ 12 (eighth-note triplet), 1/ 16 (sixteenth  
note), 1/ 24 (sixteenth-note triplet),  
1/ 32 (thirty-second note)  
When the <Src> is switched to something other than  
“Rhythm Pattern,” the KR-7/ 5 is set to carry out normal  
copying.  
Resolu-  
tion  
Press the [  
confirm the rhythm pattern. The rhythm pattern stops when  
you press the [ (Play/ Stop)] button once more.  
(Play/ Stop)] button to play back and  
When finished with the Quantize settings, return to the Song  
Edit screen.  
1 2 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
De le tin g Me a su re s (De le te )  
You can delete a part of a performance measure by measure.  
When a portion of a performance is deleted, the rest of the  
performance is shifted up to fill the gap. Erasing measures in  
In se rtin g Bla n k Me a su re s  
(In se rt)  
You can add a blank measure at a location you specify. This  
addition of a blank measure is called “insertion.”  
fig.e_insert.e  
a specified passage is called “deleting.”  
fig.e_delete.e  
Ex. To insert measures (bars) 5-7  
Ex. To delete measures (bars) 5-8  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
8
9
10  
<Delete>.  
<Insert>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-e-del.eps_50  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-e-ins.eps_50  
Item  
From  
For  
Content  
Item  
From  
For  
Content  
Measure number of the first measure of the  
segment to be deleted  
Measure number of the first measure of the  
segment to be inserted  
Number of measures to be deleted  
Number of measures to be inserted  
Track button or part number to be deleted  
Track button or part number where data will be  
inserted  
Tr/Pt  
When “All” is selected, the same portion of all  
parts is deleted.  
Tr/Pt  
When “All” is selected, blank measures are in-  
serted at the same place in all parts.  
1 2 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-e-erase.eps_50  
Tra n sp o sin g In d ivid u a l Pa rts  
(Tra n sp o se )  
You can transpose specified parts and tracks individually.  
<Transpose>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-e-trans.eps_50  
Item  
From  
For  
Content  
Measure number of the first measure of the  
segment to be erased  
Number of measures to be erased  
Track button or part number to be erased  
Tr/Pt  
When “All” is selected, the same portion of all  
parts is erased.  
Item  
From  
For  
Content  
Measure number of the first measure of the  
segment to be transposed  
Select from the following types of performance  
data to erase:  
Number of measures to be transposed  
All  
All performance data, including notes, tempos,  
Tones switches, volume changes, etc., are erased.  
Track button or part number to be transposed  
Tr/Pt  
Bias  
When “All” is selected, the same portion of all  
parts is transposed.  
Tempo  
Tempo data is erased. Erasing the tempo data for  
all measures results in a single, constant tempo.  
The range of transposition  
You can select the range to transpose the data,  
from -24 (two octaves down) to +24 (two oc-  
taves up), adjustable in semitones.  
Event  
Prog.Change  
Note  
Erases only notes.  
* You cannot transpose performances of the drum sets and  
sound effect sets (such as the Rhythm Track).  
Except Notes  
Erases all of the performance data except for the  
notes.  
Ma k in g Me a su re s Bla n k  
(Era se )  
Expression  
You can delete the performance data in a specified block of  
measures, turning them into blank measures without  
reducing the length of the song. This process is called  
Erases Expression (volume change) information.  
“erasing.”  
fig.e_erase.e  
Ex. To erase measures (bars) 5-8  
1
1
2
2
3
3
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
8
8
9
9
10  
10  
Blank measures  
choose <Erase>.  
1 2 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Ex ch a n g in g Pa rts  
Co rre ctin g N o te s O n e b y O n e  
(Pa rt Ex ch a n g e )  
(N o te Ed it)  
You can exchange the notes recorded for a particular part  
with the notes recorded for another part. This process of  
exchanging parts is called “part exchange.”  
You can make corrections in a recorded performance one  
note at a time. This process of making changes in individual  
notes is called “note editing.”  
You can make these corrections by using note editing:  
<Part Exchange>.  
Deleting misplayed notes  
Changing the scale of a single note  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-e-partex.eps_50  
Changing the force used in playing a single key (velocity)  
<Note Edit>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.e-note.e  
Touch each  
exchange.  
to choose Parts you want to  
Location  
Pitch  
Velocity  
The note-location display uses “Measure: Beat: Tick” as the  
format. A tick is a unit of time thats shorter than a beat.  
Touch  
to select the part with the note to be  
corrected. The Part number appears at the top of the screen.  
Use the [  
(Bwd)] button and the [  
(Fwd)] button or  
use < > < > in the upper part of the screen to find the  
note to be corrected.  
When youve found the note you want to correct, touch  
“Pitch” or “Velocity” for the note.  
Use the [-] [+] buttons and the dial to correct the pitch or  
velocity. If you want to delete the note, touch <Delete>.  
When youre done making all the settings, touch <Exit>.  
Return to the Song Edit screen.  
1 3 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Mo d ify in g th e To n e Ch a n g e s in  
Ch a n g in g th e Be a t in th e Mid d le  
o f a So n g (Be a t Ma p )  
a So n g (PC Ed it)  
In some songs, the instrument sound changes during the  
course of the song (that is, the Tone changes in the middle of  
a Part). In such songs, an instruction to switch the Tone is  
inserted at the place where you want the sound to change.  
This instruction is called a “Program Change” (PC), and  
actions such as deleting program changes, or changing the  
selected Tone by them are called “PC editing.”  
You can create songs that have beat changes during the  
course of the song.  
* You cant change a song’s beat once it’s been recorded. Before  
recording the performance, determine the beat to be used.  
1 . Press the [Menu] button.  
The Menu screen appears.  
* It is not possible to insert a program change into a measure or  
beat that does not contain a program change.  
2 . Touch <Beat Map>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-beatmap.eps_50  
<PC Edit>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-e-pc.eps_50  
3 . Use <  
><  
> in the screen or the [  
(Bwd)]  
and [  
(Fwd)] buttons to move to the measure  
whose beat you want to change.  
The measure number appears in the top-right area of the  
screen.  
Location  
Tone name  
The PC-location display uses “Measure: Beat: Tick” as the  
format. A tick is a unit of time thats shorter than a beat.  
Touch <  
Touch <  
> to move to the beginning of the song.  
> to move to the end of the song.  
Touch  
to select the part with the program  
4 . Touch  
in each to set the beat.  
change to be edited.  
5 . Touch <Execute>.  
The Part number appears at the top of the screen.  
Use the [ (Bwd)] button and the [ (Fwd)] button or  
The beat change starts with the measure you selected.  
Repeat Steps 3–5 to make beat settings in other measures  
as needed.  
use < > < > in the upper part of the screen to find the  
program change to be edited.  
Re co rd in g th e p e rfo rm a n ce  
When youve found the Program Change you want to  
modify, touch “Tone Name” on the screen.  
6 . Touch <Exit> twice.  
The screen displayed before you pressed the [Menu]  
button appears.  
Press a Tone button to select a Tone group, then select a Tone  
with the [-] [+] buttons and the dial. When selecting Part 10  
or 11, select the drum set or effect sound.  
7 . Press the [  
(Reset)] button to return the measure  
number to “1.”  
If you want to delete the Program Change, touch <Delete>.  
When youre done making all the settings, touch <Exit>.  
8 . Start a recording.  
Record the performance using the procedures described  
1 3 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Ch a n g in g th e Te m p o o f  
Re co rd e d So n g s  
3 . Touch the <Rec Mode>  
to select <Tempo>.  
This makes the setting for tempo recording.  
You can change the basic tempo of a composition. The basic  
tempo was initially set when the song was recorded.  
Touch <Exit> a number of times to switch to the screen  
where the measure number is indicated in the upper  
right of the screen.  
1 . Press the Tempo [-] and [+] buttons to choose a tempo.  
When the KR-7/ 5 goes into Tempo Recording, the tempo  
indication is highlighted in white.  
2 . Hold down the [  
(Rec)] button and press the  
[
(Reset)] button.  
Re co rd in g th e Te m p o  
The songs basic tempo changes.  
4 . Use the [  
(Bwd)] and [  
(Fwd)] buttons to  
The change in basic tempo is discarded when you turn  
off the power or choose a different song. Save important  
move slightly before the measure where you want to  
change the tempo.  
5 . Press the [  
flashing.  
The KR-7/ 5 is put in recording standby.  
(Rec)] button and watch the indicator is  
* If the song you’re working on has tempo changes, press the  
[
(Reset)] button to go back to the beginning of the song  
before you carry out this operation.  
6 . When you press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button,  
recording begins.  
Ch a n g in g th e Te m p o W ith in  
th e So n g  
7 . When you get to the place where you want to change  
the tempo, use the Tempo [-] and [+] buttons or the dial  
to vary the tempo as desired.  
You can add tempo changes to a recorded composition.  
The KR-7/ 5 stores song tempo information and performance  
data separately. Therefore, when making changes to the  
tempo in a song, you must record the changes in the tempo  
information independently of the performance data.  
8 . When you press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button,  
recording stops.  
The songs tempo changes.  
This recording of the tempo is called “Tempo Recording.”  
* You cannot record performances while in Tempo Recording  
mode. When you’re finished tempo recording, go back to the  
Ad ju stin g th e Te m p o W h ile  
Liste n in g to a So n g  
You can add ritardando and other such gradual tempo  
changes.  
Se ttin g th e Re c Mo d e to “ Te m p o ”  
1 . Press the [Menu] button.  
The Menu screen appears.  
2 . Touch <Rec Mode>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-rec-tempo.eps_50  
1 3 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 6 Cre a tin g a n d Ed itin g So n g s  
Ad ju stin g th e Te m p o a t a  
Pa rticu la r Me a su re  
You can create a tempo change at the beginning of a selected  
measure. This is handy when you want to make a sudden  
change in tempo.  
1 . Use the [  
(Bwd)] and [  
(Fwd)] buttons to  
move to the measure where you want to change the  
tempo.  
The measure number appears in the top-right area of the  
Basic screen.  
2 . Press the [  
flashing.  
(Rec)] button and watch the indicator is  
The KR-7/ 5 is put in recording standby.  
3 . Use the [-] [+] buttons or the dial to change the tempo.  
4 . Press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button.  
The songs tempo changes starts with the measure you  
selected.  
While tempo recording is being used to write tempo, the tempo  
display in the screen will be highlighted.  
5 . When you press the [  
(Play/Stop)] button, the  
change in tempo stops.  
* You cannot record performances while in Tempo Recording  
mode. When you’re finished tempo recording, go back to the  
If you want to restore the previous tempo, delete the tempo  
data at the place where the tempo was recorded. For an  
explanation of how to delete the information of tempo settings,  
Tempo Recording Shortcut  
Hold down the [  
(Rec)] button and press one of the  
Tempo [-] [+] buttons to switch to the Tempo Recording  
settings. Record tempo information. In this case, tempo  
recording is canceled when recording ends.  
1 3 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ch a p te r 7 Cre a tin g Mu sic Sty le s  
Cre a tin g N e w Sty le s b y  
Cre a tin g O rig in a l Sty le s  
(Use r Sty le s)  
Co m b in in g In te rn a l Mu sic  
Sty le s (Sty le Co m p o se r) (KR-7 )  
You can create a new style by selecting from among the  
Rhythm, Bass, Accompaniment 1, Accompaniment 2, and  
Accompaniment 3 parts in different Styles. This function is  
called the “Style Composer.”  
Although the KR-7/ 5 features a variety of internal Music  
Styles, you can also create your own. These original Styles  
are called “User Styles.”  
You can use either of the two methods described below to  
create a User Style.  
* You can only combine the KR-7’s built-in Styles.  
Disp la y in g th e Sty le Co m p o se r Scre e n  
1 . Press the [Menu] button.  
Sty le Co m p o se r (KR-7 )  
With this method, you combine internal Music Styles to  
create new Styles. You can create a new Style by selecting  
from among the Rhythm, Bass, Accompaniment 1,  
Accompaniment 2, and Accompaniment 3 parts in different  
styles.  
The Menu screen appears.  
fig.d-menu1.eps_50  
Create a new Style by extracting the portions you need from  
songs composed with the 16-track sequencer.  
When youre composing a song, theres no need to specify all  
the chords. You can specify just some of the chords, and the  
KR-7/ 5 automatically chooses the other chords and arranges  
the Style.  
Display of  
the KR-7  
Style Converter features an “Auto mode” that allows you to  
easily create Styles from songs with a single chord, and a  
“Manual mode,” in which you create Styles from songs with  
three kinds of chords–major, minor, and seventh chords.  
2 . Touch <Style Composer>.  
* If a User Style has already been recorded, a message like the  
one shown below appears.  
fig.m-styledel.eps  
Touch <Cancel> to return to the Menu screen. Save User  
When you touch <OK>, the previously recorded User Style is  
deleted, and a new User Style is created.  
1 3 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 7 Cre a tin g Mu sic Sty le s  
A “Style Composer screen” like the one shown below  
De cid in g o n a Sty le  
appears.  
fig.d-stylecomp.eps_50  
6 . Touch <Execute>.  
You have created a new Style.  
The User Style is recorded to the Music Style [User]  
button. Try playing with the new Style.  
* If you turn off the power or record a new User Style, any User  
Style you’ve previously recorded is lost. If you do not want to  
delete the Style, save it to a floppy disk or to user memory.  
Mu tin g Pa rts fo r a p a rticu la r d ivisio n  
You can mute the sound of particular Parts in specific  
Divisions.  
Display  
Part  
For example, have all of the parts play in the “Variation”  
accompaniment pattern, while muting “Accompaniment 2”  
and “Accompaniment 3” in the “Original” accompaniment  
pattern. With this arrangement, when the accompaniment  
pattern changes from the original to the variation, it creates a  
more elaborate effect in the accompaniment.  
R
Rhythm  
B
Bass  
A1  
A2  
A3  
Accompaniment 1  
Accompaniment 2  
Accompaniment 3  
1 . Touch the screen to choose the Part you want to mute  
Icon  
Function  
out.  
All Clear  
Deletes all of the settings.  
2 . Press the Fill In [To Variation] or [To Original] button  
You can mute the sound of particular  
Parts in specific Divisions. For more in-  
to switch to the division that you want to mute.  
Mute  
Clear  
3 . Touch <Mute> on the screen.  
The Part you chose is only muted out in the Division you  
selected.  
Deletes the Styles in selected parts.  
The Part Settings screen is displayed, al-  
lowing you to make detailed settings to  
each part. For more information, take a  
If you want to hear the muted-out Part, touch <Mute>  
again.  
Options  
Execute  
* To mute out a Division that changes after a few seconds (intro,  
ending, or fill-in), touch <Mute> immediately after switching  
to the Division.  
Records the created Style to the Music  
Style [User] button. Touch this when  
you have finished creating the Style.  
Se le ctin g th e Sty le s a ssig n e d to e a ch p a rt  
3 . Touch the part to be set.  
The Part you touched appears in reverse video.  
4 . Press an Music Style button, then select a Style with  
the touch screen or the [-]/[+] buttons and the dial.  
When you have decided on a Style, touch <Exit> to  
display the Style Composer screen.  
5 . Repeat steps 3 and 4 to determine the Styles for each  
Part.  
1 3 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 7 Cre a tin g Mu sic Sty le s  
Ed itin g th e vo lu m e a n d e ffe ct se ttin g s fo r  
Cre a tin g a Sty le fro m a So n g  
Yo u Co m p o se d Yo u rse lf  
(Sty le Co n ve rte r)  
e a ch Pa rt  
Disp la y in g th e Pa rt se ttin g s scre e n  
You can take a song youve composed yourself and extract  
the portions you need to create your own original Style.  
When youre composing a song, theres no need to specify all  
the chords. You can specify some of the chords, and the KR-  
7/ 5 automatically chooses the other chords and arranges the  
style. This function is called the “Style Converter.”  
1 . At the Style Composer screen, touch <Options>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-scomp-part.eps_50  
Style Converter features an “Auto mode” that allows you to  
easily create Styles from songs with a single chord, and a  
“Manual mode,” in which you create Styles from songs with  
three kinds of chords–major, minor, and seventh chords.  
When creating a song in order to create an music style, its  
good practice to consider the arrangement of the music style.  
Sty le Arra n g e m e n ts  
Mo d ify in g th e se ttin g s o f e a ch p a rt  
A Music Style is made up of five performance parts:  
“Rhythm,” “Bass,” “Accompaniment 1,” “Accompaniment  
2” and “Accompaniment 3.”  
2 . Touch the  
settings to be changed.  
to select the part with the  
The part name and Tone name are indicated in the upper  
part of the screen.  
A song progresses in predictable a sequence, such as intro,  
melody A, melody B, bridge and ending.  
With the KR-7/ 5, such changes in songs are allocated to the  
following six performance states. We call these six parts of a  
song “Divisions.”  
3 . Touch  
for each parameter to change the value.  
You can also change the values by touching each  
parameter name and then using the [-] [+] buttons and  
the dial. Pressing the [-] [+] buttons simultaneously  
returns the parameter to its original value.  
Division  
Intro  
Performance division  
The intro is played at the start of a song.  
This is played at the end of a song.  
This is a basic accompaniment pattern.  
Display  
Explanation  
Ending  
Original  
Volume  
Reverb  
Adjusts the volume.  
Adjusts the amount of reverb effect applied  
to the sound.  
This is a developmental accompaniment  
pattern. It is a variation on an Original.  
Variation  
Adjusts the amount of chorus effect applied  
to the sound.  
Chorus  
This is a one-measure phrase inserted at a  
juncture where the mood changes. It is used  
to make a song more lively.  
Fill-In To  
Variation  
Changes the left-right direction from which  
the sound appears to come.  
This is a one-measure phrase inserted at a  
juncture where the mood changes. It is used  
to make a song more sedate.  
Fill-In To  
Original  
Panpot  
When you touch  
, the sound moves to  
to move the sound to  
the right; touch  
the left.  
You can make a song more lively or more restrained by  
increasing or reducing played parts by Divisions. You can  
also modify a song by changing the Tone of the parts in the  
Divisions.  
You can change the Tone for the selected Part by  
pressing a Tone button to change the Tone while this  
screen is displayed. When selecting Rhythm Part, you  
can touch <Drum Set> to select the drum set or effect  
sound.  
Fin ish in g th e se ttin g s  
4 . Touch <Exit>.  
The Style Composer screen appears.  
1 3 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 7 Cre a tin g Mu sic Sty le s  
fig.d-styleconv.eps_50  
Cre a tin g Sty le s in Au to Mo d e  
Po in ts to n o te w h e n cre a tin g so n g s  
Use one of the major, minor, or diminished seventh  
chords to create the song. We recommend using  
diminished seventh chords to compose the song.  
It is convenient to record the sounds shown below for  
the Parts of the 16-track sequencer.  
Rhythm  
Bass  
Accomp Accomp Accomp  
1
2
3
D (10)  
2
7
8
9
Parameter  
Name  
Settings Content  
When using parts other than Part 2, 7, 8, 9, and D, refer to  
Conv.Mode  
Chord Root  
Switches the mode (Auto/ Manual)  
Cre a tin g so n g s  
Chord root for the segment to be  
extracted  
1 . Use the 16-track sequencer to record the song.  
Chord type for the segment to be  
extracted (major/ minor/ seventh)  
Chord Type  
Division  
From  
related sections.  
Division  
Measure number of the first measure of  
the segment to be extracted  
Disp la y in g th e Sty le Co n ve rte r scre e n  
2 . Press the [Menu] button.  
For  
Number of measures extracted  
The Menu screen appears.  
Ma k in g th e se ttin g s  
3 . Touch <Style Converter>.  
4 . Touch <Conv.Mode>, then use the [-] [+] buttons or the  
* If no song for use in creating a new Style is selected, the  
message "Please select a song" appears. Use the [Select/Listen  
procedure again.  
dial to switch the mode to “Auto.”  
This makes the setting for the Auto mode.  
5 . Touch <Chord Root> and <Chord Type>, then use the  
[-] [+] buttons or the dial to input the chord root and  
type for the segment to be extracted.  
* If a User Style has already been recorded, a message like the  
one shown below appears.  
fig.m-styledel.eps  
6 . Touch <Division>, then use the [-] [+] buttons or the  
dial to select the Division.  
Display  
Intro  
Performance division  
Intro  
Original  
Original accompaniment pattern  
Touch <Cancel> to return to the Menu screen. Please save the  
User Style on a floppy disk or in the internal memory (KR-7)  
Fill To  
Vari  
From the fill-in to the variation  
Variation  
Fill To Ori  
Ending  
Variation accompaniment pattern  
From the fill-in to the original  
Ending  
When you touch <OK>, the previously recorded User Style is  
deleted, and a new User Style is created.  
A “Style Converter screen” like the one shown appears.  
* Only one measure can be extracted when “Fill To Vari” or  
“Fill To Ori” is selected for the Division. The number of  
measures may also be limited in other Divisions.  
1 3 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 7 Cre a tin g Mu sic Sty le s  
Disp la y in g th e Sty le Co n ve rte r scre e n  
7 . Touch <From> and <For>, then use the [-] [+] buttons or  
the dial to select the measures to be extracted.  
2 . Press the [Menu] button.  
Touching <Play> at the bottom of the screen, you can  
listen to performance of the portion which you chose.  
3 . Touch <Style Converter>.  
The “Style Converter screen” appears.  
8 . Repeat Steps 5–7 to create Styles for all of the  
4 . Touch <Conv.Mode>, then use the [-] [+] buttons or the  
Divisions.  
dial to switch the mode to “Manual.”  
*
If no setting is made for a Division, it uses a simple drum pattern.  
This makes the setting for the Manual mode.  
De cid in g o n a Sty le  
9 . When youre done making all the Division settings,  
When you touch <Play> in the lower part of the screen,  
you can listen to the performance of the part selected  
with <Options>.  
touch <Execute>.  
The User Style is recorded to the [User] button.  
* If you turn off the power or record a new User Style, any User  
Style you’ve previously recorded is lost. If you do not want to  
delete the Style, save it to a floppy disk or to user memory  
Ch a n g in g a n Ex tra cte d Pa rt  
You can extract and change part of a song created with 16-  
track sequencer.  
* The following data is saved to the User Style. If a song  
includes data other than this, the results you get might not be  
what was intended.  
1 . At the Style Converter screen, touch <Options>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-styleconv.eps_50  
Keyboard performance data  
Amount of Reverb effect applied  
Amount of Chorus effect applied  
Cre a tin g a Sty le in Ma n u a l Mo d e  
When you create a Music Style in the Manual mode, you can  
clearly point up the differences in accompaniment for each  
individual chord.  
Po in ts to n o te w h e n cre a tin g so n g s  
Record your performance with the three chord types of  
diminished seventh, major, and minor.  
2 . Touch the performance Part with settings you want to  
It is convenient to record the sounds shown below for  
the Parts of the 16-track sequencer.  
change.  
3 . Use the [-] [+] buttons and the dial to specify which 16-  
Chords Rhythm Bass Accomp Accomp Accomp  
track Sequencer performance part you want to extract.  
1
2
3
In the Manual mode, the type of chords appear at the bottom of  
Major  
Seventh  
Minor  
D (10)  
3
2
4
5
6
the screen. Set the Parts for all chords.  
-
-
7
8
9
4 . Touch <Exit> to return to the Style Converter screen.  
12  
13  
14  
15  
The chords all share the same Rhythm Part.  
If you want to use the performance of other part, check out  
Cre a tin g so n g s  
1 . Use the 16-track sequencer to record the song.  
related sections.  
1 3 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ch a p te r 7 Cre a tin g Mu sic Sty le s  
fig.d-stylesave.eps_50  
Sa vin g a Use r Sty le  
You can save the User Styles you create to floppy disks.  
With the KR-7, you can save Styles to the user memory.  
When saved to the user memory, User Styles are not deleted  
when the power is turned off. You can also select Styles  
saved to the user memory by pressing the Music Style [User]  
button.  
Display of  
the KR-7  
You can save up to 99 User Styles in user memory.  
W h a t is th e Use r Me m o ry ? (KR-7 )  
De te rm in in g th e n a m e o f th e Sty le to b e sa ve d  
The user memory is the area within the instrument  
where User Styles created with the KR-7, sets of User  
Programs, and other such data are stored.  
4 . Touch <Rename>.  
A “Rename screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-stylename.eps_50  
You can also copy User Styles and sets of User Programs  
saved on floppy disks.  
Data saved to the user memory is not deleted, even  
when the KRs power is turned off.  
When you want to clear all of the content saved to the user  
memory and restore the settings to the factory settings on the  
Pre p a ra tio n s fo r sa vin g d a ta  
When saving to a floppy disk, first insert a floppy disk in the  
disk drive.  
When you touch  
, the cursor moves.  
When you touch the icon for the character to be input,  
the character appears at the cursor position.  
For example, touching the <ABC> icon in succession  
cycles you through the available choices in that character  
group (ABCA...).  
1 . Press the Music Style [User] button.  
A “User Style screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-usrdisk.eps_50  
Each touch of <A-a-0-!> cycles the type of characters  
through “English (upper case),” “English (lower case),”  
“numerals,” “symbols,” then back to “English (upper  
case).”  
When you touch <Del>, the character at the cursor  
position is deleted.  
Display of  
the KR-7  
When you touch <Ins>, a space is inserted at the cursor  
position.  
If the User Style screen is not displayed, touch <User/  
Disk> in the lower part of the screen.  
5 . When you have finished with the name, touch <Exit>.  
De te rm in in g th e sa ve d e stin a tio n  
2 . Touch <File>.  
6 . Touch <Disk> or <User>. (KR-7)  
3 . Touch <Save>.  
Touch <Disk> if you are saving to a floppy disk; touch  
<User> if you are saving to user memory.  
A “Save Style screen” like the following appears.  
1 3 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 7 Cre a tin g Mu sic Sty le s  
De le tin g Sa ve d Use r Sty le s  
7 . Touch  
number.  
to select the save-destination  
This deletes User Styles that have been saved to floppy disks  
or in user memory (KR-7).  
If a Style name is displayed, a style is already saved to  
that number.  
When deleting a User Style on a floppy disk, first insert the  
floppy disk in the disk drive.  
If you select a number with a previously saved User  
Style and then save to that number, the previously saved  
User Style is deleted. If you do not want to delete the  
User Style being saved, select a number in the save-  
destination column that does not yet have a name.  
1 . Press the Music Style [User] button.  
A “User Style screen” appears.  
If the User Style screen is not displayed, touch <User/  
Disk> in the lower part of the screen.  
8 . Touch <Save>.  
2 . Touch <File>.  
The saving process starts.  
3 . Touch <Delete>.  
A “Delete Style screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-styledel.eps_50  
* Never turn off the power while the operation is in progress.  
Doing so will damage the KR-7/5’s internal memory, making  
it unusable.  
Display of  
the KR-7  
4 . Touch <Disk> or <User> (KR-7).  
Touch <User> if you are deleting a file from user  
memory; touch <Disk> if you are deleting a file from a  
floppy disk.  
5 . Touch  
6 . Touch <Delete>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
or  
to select the Style to be deleted.  
fig.m-filedel.eps  
7 . Touch <OK>.  
The selected Style is deleted.  
If you touch <Cancel>, the Style wont be deleted.  
* Never turn off the power while the operation is in progress.  
Doing so will damage the KR-7/5’s internal memory, making  
it unusable.  
1 4 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 7 Cre a tin g Mu sic Sty le s  
Sp e cify in g th e Co p y De stin a tio n  
Co p y in g Sty le s o n Disk s to  
th e Use r Me m o ry (KR-7 )  
6 . Touch <User>  
to select the copy destination  
for the Style.  
You can take User Styles saved on floppy disks and copy  
them to user memory.  
If a Style name is displayed, a style is already saved to  
that number.  
You can also take User Styles saved in user memory and  
copy them to floppy disks.  
If you select a number with a previously saved Style and  
then copy to that number, the previously saved Style is  
deleted. If you do not want to lose the Style being saved,  
select a number in the save-destination column that does  
not yet have a name.  
1 . Insert the disk with the Style to be copied in the disk  
drive.  
2 . Press the [User] button.  
7 . Touch <Execute>.  
A “User Style screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-usrdisk.eps_50  
Do not eject the floppy disk from the disk drive before  
the copy is finished.  
The Style on the disk is copied to user memory.  
* Never turn off the power while the operation is in progress.  
Doing so will damage the KR-7’s internal memory, making it  
unusable.  
Co p y in g Sty le s Sa ve d in th e  
Use r Me m o ry to Disk s (KR-7 )  
You can take Styles saved in user memory and copy them to  
If the User Style screen is not displayed, touch <User/  
Disk> in the lower part of the screen.  
floppy disks.  
3 . Touch <File>.  
In this case, touch the large arrow icon in the center of the  
“Copy Style screen” in Step 4 above so that the arrow points  
upwards. Turn the KR will copy user memory Styles to the  
floppy disk.  
4 . Touch <Copy>.  
A “Copy Style screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-copystyle.eps_50  
The rest of the procedure is identical to that used for copying  
Styles from disks to user memory.  
Sp e cify in g th e co p y so u rce  
5 . Touch <Disk>  
to select the Style you want  
to copy.  
When “All” is selected, all of the Styles on the disk are  
copied to user memory.  
1 4 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Ad ju stin g Re so n a n ce  
(Re so n a n ce )  
You can adjust this resonance (Sympathetic Resonance)  
Ch a n g in g th e Se ttin g s fo r  
O n e -To u ch Pia n o  
You can make detailed settings, such as those for the  
keyboard touch and tunings, allowing you to set up the KR  
just the way you want for your piano performances.  
when the damper pedal is depressed.  
fig.d-p-reso.eps_50  
Pro ce d u re  
1 . Press the One Touch Program [Piano] button.  
The Piano screen appears.  
fig.d-piano.eps_50  
Display of  
the KR-7  
Display  
Explanation  
Standard  
This replicates the resonance inside a piano.  
The KR-7 physically reproduces the vibra-  
tion of other free strings when keys are  
played, allowing you to experience the feel-  
ing of acoustic piano reverberation and res-  
onance (Physical Damper Simulation).  
Advanced  
(KR-7)  
2 . Touch <Functions>.  
Touch <Exit> to go back the Piano screen.  
fig.d-pianoopt1.eps_50  
In addition to the effects of Advanced, this  
also replicates the noise produced when  
you depress the pedal.  
Demo  
(KR-7)  
On the KR-7, touch the <Standard>, <Advanced>, or  
<Demo> icon to choose the type of resonant sound.  
Touch <Level>  
applied.  
to adjust the amount of effect  
Display of the KR-7  
Touch  
to deepen the effect. When you touch  
, the  
Display  
Page  
Display  
Page  
effect is lessened.  
Hammer Response  
(KR-7)  
Resonance p. 142  
On the KR-5, touch the Level bar to make the adjustment.  
On the KR-7, the Resonance settings may change when you  
effects.  
String Resonance  
(KR-7)  
Tuning  
Key Touch  
On the KR-7, when you’ve chosen <Demo>, touching <Exit>  
You can set the master tuning and make a variety of other  
settings to the instrument starting from the third page (second  
page for the KR-5) of <Functions>. For more detailed  
changes the setting for resonant notes to <Advanced>.  
3 . Touch the icon for the setting.  
Refer to the corresponding page for each function.  
4 . Touch <Exit> to return to the Piano screen.  
1 4 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Ch a n g in g th e Tu n in g (Tu n in g )  
Tuning  
system  
Characteristics  
Ch o o sin g th e Tu n in g  
This temperament is a partial compro-  
mise of just intonation in order to allow  
modulation.  
You can play classical styles such as Baroque using historic  
temperaments (tuning methods).  
Meantone  
Most modern songs are composed for and played in equal  
temperament, the most common tuning in use today. But at  
one time, there were a wide variety of other tuning systems  
in existence. By playing in the temperament that was in use  
when a composition was created, you can experience the  
sonorities of chords originally intended for that song.  
This temperament is a combination of  
meantone and Pythagorean tempera-  
ments. It allows you to play in all keys.  
(First method, number three.)  
Werkmeister  
Touch any one of the icons to choose the tuning system.  
When playing in a temperament other than equal  
temperament, you must specify the tonic (the note  
corresponding to C for a major key, or to A for a minor key)  
of the key in which you will play.  
fig.d-p-temp.eps_50  
Touch <Key>  
to select the tonic.  
If you have selected equal temperament, it is not necessary to  
select the tonic.  
Se ttin g th e Tu n in g Cu rve (Stre tch Tu n in g )  
Pianos are generally tuned so that the low range is flatter and  
the high range is sharper than equal tempered pitches. This  
method of tuning is unique to the piano, and is known as  
“stretched tuning.”  
You can choose from among the eight tunings described  
below.  
A graph that shows the changes in pitch of actual tuning  
compared with the changes in equal temperament pitch is  
called a tuning curve. Changing the tuning curve produces  
subtle variations in the reverberations of the chords you play.  
Tuning  
Characteristics  
system  
This temperament divides the octave  
into 12 equal parts. All intervals will be  
slightly out of tune by the same amount.  
This setting is in effect when you turn on  
the power.  
Touch the Stretch Tuning <ON> or <OFF> icon to select the  
tuning curve.  
Equal  
When set to “ON,” the tuning curve features extended low  
and high ranges (Stretch Tuning). It is suitable for piano  
solos. This setting is selected when the power is turned on.  
This temperament makes the 5th and  
3rd intervals pure. It is unsuited to play-  
ing melodies and cannot be transposed,  
but is capable of beautiful sonorities.  
Just (Maj)  
When set to “OFF,” the standard tuning curve is used. It is  
suitable when playing in an ensemble with other  
instruments.  
Just intonation differs between major  
and minor keys. The same results as ma-  
jor can be obtained in a minor key.  
Just (Min)  
Arabic  
This tuning is suitable for the music of  
Arabia.  
This temperament is a modification of  
meantone temperament and just intona-  
tion, allowing more freedom of modula-  
tion. Performances are possible in all  
keys (III).  
Kirnberger  
This temperament is based on the theo-  
ries of the Greek philosopher Pythago-  
ras, and has pure fourths and fifths.  
Chords containing a third will sound im-  
pure, but melodies will sound good.  
Pythagorean  
1 4 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Ch a n g in g Ho w Ra p id ly So u n d s Are  
Ex p re sse d Acco rd in g to th e Fo rce  
Use d to Pla y th e Ke y s  
Ad ju stin g th e Re so n a n t So u n d s  
(Strin g Re so n a n ce ) (KR-7 )  
When the keys are pressed on an acoustic piano, the strings  
for keys that are already pressed also vibrate  
sympathetically. The function used to reproduce this  
resonance is called “String Resonance.”  
(Ha m m e r Re sp o n se ) (KR-7 )  
You can adjust the timing with which sounds are produced  
according to the force used to play the keys. This function is  
called “Hammer Resonance.”  
fig.d-p-streso.eps_50  
When a key is pressed on an acoustic piano, it causes a  
hammer to move and strike the strings, producing sound.  
The hammers move more slowly when the keys are played  
gently, meaning that sounds are produced just slightly later  
than when you play the keyboard with greater force.  
When the Hammer Response function is on, the interval  
between the time a key is pressed and the time sound is  
produced varies according to the force used to play the key.  
The more gently the key is pressed, the more delayed the  
timing of the sound.  
Touch <ON> to turn the String Resonance function on.  
Response>.  
fig.d-p-hmreso.eps_50  
Touch the screen slider to adjust the amount of effect  
applied.  
Moving the slider to “Max” increases the amount of  
resonance effect applied. Moving the slider to “Min” reduces  
the amount of effect applied.  
Touch <OFF> to cancel the effect.  
Touch <ON> to turn the Hammer Response function on.  
Touch the screen slider to adjust the time it takes for a key to  
sound after it is pressed.  
The more the slider is moved to “Slow,” the more delayed  
the sound is when the keys are played softly. Conversely,  
sounds are produced more quickly when the keys are played  
with greater force.  
Touch <OFF> to cancel the effect.  
1 4 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Ad ju stin g th e Ke y b o a rd To u ch  
(Ke y To u ch )  
You can vary the touch of the keyboard when you play the  
Ch a n g in g th e Se ttin g s fo r  
O n e -To u ch Arra n g e r  
keys.  
Pro ce d u re  
1 . Press the One Touch Program [Arranger] button to  
fig.d-p-key.eps_50  
display the Basic screen.  
fig.d-arrbasic.eps_50  
Display  
Explanation  
2 . Touch <Functions>.  
Notes sound at an unchanging volume level,  
regardless of how lightly or forcefully you  
play the keyboard.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-funcmenu1.eps_50  
Fixed  
This sets the keyboard to a light touch. You  
can achieve fortissimo (ff) play with a less  
forceful touch than usual, so the keyboard  
feels lighter. This setting makes it easier for  
children, whose hands have less strength.  
Light  
This sets the keyboard to the standard touch.  
You can play with the most natural touch.  
This setting is closest to the response of an  
acoustic piano.  
Medium  
This sets the keyboard to a heavy touch. You  
have to play the keyboard more forcefully  
than usual in order to play fortissimo (ff), so  
the keyboard touch feels heavier. This set-  
ting allows you to add more expression  
when playing dynamically.  
Parame-  
Description  
ter Name  
Heavy  
Key  
Touch  
Sets the key at which the keyboard is  
Split Point  
Touch any of the icons <Fixed>, <Light>, <Medium>, or  
<Heavy>, to set the key touch for the keyboard.  
One  
Touch  
Setting  
Selects the setting to be specified when the  
One Touch Program [Arranger] button is  
To make fine adjustments, touch the slider in the screen.  
Move the slider to the right to add resistance, and to the right  
to make the key touch lighter.  
Pedal  
Setting  
Arranger  
Config  
Sets the way the Automatic Accompaniment  
Tuning  
3 . Touch the name of the parameter to be set.  
Refer to the corresponding page for each function.  
4 . Touch <Exit> to return to the Basic screen.  
1 4 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Ch a n g in g th e Ke y b o a rd ’s Sp lit  
Ch a n g in g Mu sic Sty le s W ith o u t  
Ch a n g in g th e To n e o r Te m p o  
(O n e To u ch Se ttin g )  
Normally, when you select a Music Style, the Tone and  
tempo settings suitable for that Music Style are selected  
automatically. However, you can also set it so the tempo and  
Tone settings dont change when you change Music Styles.  
Po in t (Sp lit Po in t)  
This sets the point (the split point) where the keyboard is  
divided when specifying chords in the left hand while using  
the Automatic Accompaniment and when playing split  
The setting is at “F#3” when the KR-7/ 5 is powered up.  
fig.splitpoint.e  
fig.d-1touchset.eps_50  
F 3 (Split Point)  
B1  
B6  
The key you chose for the split point belongs to the left-hand  
section of the keyboard.  
fig.d-splitpoint.eps_50  
Display  
Explanation  
Suitable  
Tone  
The suitable tone for a Music Style is  
selected automatically.  
Suitable  
Tempo  
The suitable tempo for a Music Style is  
selected automatically.  
Other  
Setting  
Other settings (Style Orchestrator, phrases  
(KR-7), etc.) are changed automatically.  
Touch either <C3>, <F#3>, <C4>, or <F#4> in the lower part  
of the screen.  
Touch each icon to switch individual settings on and off.  
All items are set to ON when you turn on the power.  
Parameters switched to OFF (highlighted in black) do not  
change, even when the Music Style is changed.  
The key you chose becomes the split point.  
To set another key as the split point, touch  
the screen, then specify the key.  
in  
You can set the split point within a range of B1 to B6.  
1 4 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
<KR-5 >  
Assig n in g Fu n ctio n s to Pe d a ls  
a n d Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa d s (Pe d a l  
Se ttin g / Use r Fu n ctio n s)  
1 . Press the [Style Orchestrator/User Function]  
button and the indicator light goes out.  
You can assign a variety of functions to the left and center  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-usrfunc.eps_50  
pedals and to the performance pads.  
You can call up the assigned functions just by pressing the  
corresponding pedal or pad.  
Assig n in g Fu n ctio n s to Pe d a ls  
fig.d-pedalset.eps_50  
2 . Touch  
to assign functions to each of the  
Performance Pads.  
If you set the pedal as a dedicated switch for selecting User  
Programs, the function assigned to the pedal cannot be used.  
Touch  
to assign functions to each of the pedals.  
* Pressing the One Touch Program [Piano] button restores the  
Assig n in g Fu n ctio n s to Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa d s  
<KR-7 >  
1 . Press the [User Function] button and watch the  
indicator light up.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-usrfunc.eps_50  
2 . Touch  
to assign functions to each of the  
Performance Pads.  
If you set the pedal as a dedicated switch for selecting User  
Programs, the function assigned to the pedal cannot be used.  
1 4 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Fu n ctio n s th a t ca n b e a ssig n e d (Pe d a ls,  
Function  
Explanation  
Pe rfo rm a n ce Pa d s)  
This starts Automatic Accompaniment with  
a fade-in (where the volume gets progres-  
sively louder), ends it with a fade-out  
(where the volume gets progressively soft-  
er), then stops.  
Fade In/  
Out  
Function  
Explanation  
Toggles the Leading Bass function* on or off.  
The function stays on as long as the pedal to  
which this is assigned is pressed.  
When assigned to a Performance Pad, this is  
alternately switched on and off each time the  
pad is pressed.  
Leading  
Bass  
Rotary  
Slow/Fast  
This switches the speed of the rotary effect*  
when you perform with an organ Tone.  
While the pedal or Performance Pad is held  
down, the pitch of the sound drops tempo-  
rarily, returning to the original pitch when  
the pedal or Pad is released. This can be ef-  
fective for simulating the performance of in-  
struments like a Hawaiian guitar.  
Only the accompaniments rhythm part is  
played. The next time you specify a chord  
with the keyboard, the No Chord function is  
cancelled, and all of the accompaniment  
parts are played.  
Glide  
No Chord  
Break  
Compos-  
er Start/  
Stop  
Performs the same function as the [  
During the performance of Automatic  
Accompaniment, the accompaniment stops  
for one measure only.  
Press the pedal or the Pad turns the score ap-  
pearing on the KR display to the next page  
while the performance of a song is stopped.  
Page  
Fwd 1  
Fill In To  
Variation  
Performs the same function as the Fill In [To  
Fill In To  
Original  
Performs the same function as the Fill In [To  
Press the pedal or the Pad turns the score ap-  
pearing on the KR display to the preceding  
page while the performance of a song is  
stopped.  
Page  
Bwd 1  
A fill-in is inserted, but the accompaniment  
pattern after that doesnt change.  
Fill In  
Press the pedal or the Pad turns the score ap-  
pearing on the external display to the next  
page while the performance of a song is  
stopped.  
Page  
Fwd 2  
(KR-7)  
This plays a fill-in half a measure long, then  
switches to the Variation accompaniment  
pattern.  
Half Fill In  
Variation  
This plays a fill-in half a measure long, then  
switches to the Original accompaniment  
pattern.  
Press the pedal or the Pad turns the score ap-  
pearing on the external display to the pre-  
ceding page while the performance of a song  
is stopped.  
Half Fill In  
Original  
Page  
Bwd 2  
(KR-7)  
Original/  
Variation  
This changes the accompaniment pattern  
without inserting a fill-in.  
Punch In/  
Out  
During Punch-in Recording, this starts and  
When this function is used during Automat-  
ic Accompaniment, the accompaniment re-  
Arranger  
Reset  
You can set the tempo according to the inter-  
val at which the pedal or pad is pressed  
Tap  
Tempo  
Performs the same function as the [Intro/  
are played.  
Intro 1/  
Ending 1  
* What is the leading bass function?  
Performs the same function as the [Intro/  
are played.  
The function that sounds the lowest note of a fingered chord  
as the bass tone is called “Leading Bass.” When this function  
is turned on, the Bass Tone changes when chord inversions  
are used. Usually the tonic of the chord you play sounds as  
the bass tone.  
Intro 2/  
Ending 2  
Arranger  
Start/Stop  
Performs the same function as the [Start/  
Orches-  
trator Up  
This changes the accompaniment to a more  
* What is the rotary effect?  
Orches-  
trator  
Down  
This adds a sort of spinning effect to the organ sound, similar  
to the sound when a rotary speaker is used.  
Changes the accompaniment to a simpler ar-  
Changing the speed increases or decreases the speed of this  
spinning effect.  
Melody  
Intelli-  
gence  
Turns the Melody Intelligence function on  
1 4 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Fu n ctio n s th a t ca n b e a ssig n e d (Pe d a ls  
Ch a n g in g th e Be n d Ra n g e  
O n ly )  
(Pe d a l Se ttin g )  
The effect of smoothly raising or lowering the pitch of a  
Function  
Explanation  
played note is called the “bender effect.”  
Pressing the pedal during playback of a song  
stops the playback. When the pedal is  
released, playback resumes from the begin-  
ning of the measure that was playing when  
the pedal was pressed. When the pedal is  
pressed in rapid succession, the playback  
will resume backs up the same number of  
measures as the number of times the pedal is  
pressed.  
With the KR-7/ 5, you can assign the bender function to a  
pedal, then apply the bender effect by depressing and  
releasing the pedal.  
You can also make a setting that determines how much the  
pitch of the note changes when you apply the bender. The  
maximum range of change in pitch is called the “bend  
range.”  
Replay  
fig.d-pedalset.eps_50  
Upper  
Soft  
The pedal functions as a sostenuto pedal  
Upper  
Sostenuto (p. 20).  
Lower  
Applies a damper pedal effect to the sounds  
Damper  
in the left-hand side of the keyboard.  
This raises the pitch of notes you play on the  
keyboard.  
Bend Up  
Bend  
Down  
This lowers the pitch of notes you play on the  
keyboard.  
When the pedal is pressed during a layer per-  
formance, the Tone volume changes between  
two levels, depending on how firmly the  
pedal is pressed.  
Pressing the pedal with “Pedal EX1” selected  
increases the layer Tone volume. The layer  
Tone is played at a fixed volume, regardless  
of how forcefully the keys are played.  
Touch <Bend Range>  
setting.  
to adjust the bend range  
You can set this to any value within a range of 1 to 12 (in  
half-tone steps, up to one octave).  
Pedal EX1  
Pressing the pedal with “Pedal EX2” selected  
increases the layer Tone volume.  
Pedal EX2  
Pedal EX3  
Pressing the pedal with “Pedal EX3” selected  
increases the layer Tone volume, while the  
volume of the left-hand Tone is decreased.  
The layer Tone is played at a fixed volume,  
regardless of how forcefully the keys are  
played.  
Pressing the pedal with “Pedal EX4” selected  
Pedal EX4 increases the layer Tone volume, while the  
volume of the right-hand Tone is decreased.  
* The effect may not be applied correctly when you press a pedal  
if “Pedal EX1–4” is assigned to more than one pedal.  
Using the “Bend Up” or “Bend Down” function during a  
right-hand side of the keyboard. Additionally, the range in  
which the pitch can change when the Bender effect is used is  
1 4 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Ch a n g in g Ho w Ch o rd s Are  
Pla y e d a n d Sp e cifie d  
(Arra n g e r Co n fig )  
Parame-  
ter Name  
Value  
Description  
The function that allows  
the KR-7/ 5 to recognize  
accompaniment chords  
when you press only one  
or two keys during Auto-  
matic Accompaniment is  
called the “Chord Intelli-  
When set to “Off,” play  
all of the notes to specify  
chords.  
This changes the settings determining how Music Styles are  
played, and how the keys are pressed to specify chords.  
W h a t a re th e Ch o rd To n e a n d Ba ss To n e ?  
Chord  
Intelli  
ON, OFF  
When the Automatic Accompaniment is stopped, and Sync  
play in the left-hand side of the keyboard. This is called the  
“chord tone,” and the root of the chord that is played at the  
same time is called the “bass tone.”  
fig.d-arrset.eps_50  
Pla cin g a Ma rk e r in th e Mid d le  
o f a Me a su re  
A marker is normally placed at the start of the selected  
measure, but you can also set it so that a marker is placed at a  
position partway through a measure.  
1 . Press the [Menu] button.  
The Menu screen appears.  
2 . Touch <Marker>.  
Touch  
of each item to make settings.  
The Marker screen appears.  
3 . Touch <Option>.  
Parame-  
ter Name  
Value  
Description  
A screen like the following appears.  
fig.d-funcmenu2.eps_50  
All Music Style parts are  
played.  
Accomp  
Accomp  
Only Music Style rhythm  
parts, chord Tones, and  
bass Tones are played.  
Chord&Bs  
OFF,  
Acoustic Bs.,  
A. Bass+Cymbl,  
Fingered Bs.,  
Picked Bs.,  
Fretless Bs.,  
Slap Bass,  
Organ Bass,  
Synth Bass 101,  
Thum Voice  
Bass  
Tone  
4 . Touch <Resolution>  
to choose the marker  
Selects the bass Tone or  
chord Tone. When set to  
“Off,” no tone is played.  
setting.  
OFF, E.Piano 1,  
E. Piano 2,  
Soft E. Piano,  
Hard E. Piano,  
Slow Strings,  
Strings,  
Indication  
Description  
This lets you place a marker at the  
beginning of the measure.  
Measure  
Beat  
Chord  
Tone  
This lets you place a marker at the  
beginning of the beat.  
Choir,  
Doos Voice  
5 . Touch <Exit> to go back to the Marker screen.  
1 5 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Se ttin g s fo r th e Co u n td o w n  
Ch a n g in g th e Se ttin g s fo r th e  
Co u n t-In a n d Co u n td o w n  
1 . Press the [Metronome] button.  
2 . Touch <Count In> or <Countdown>.  
fig.d-funcmenu2.eps_50  
The “Count In settings screen” or the “Countdown  
settings screen” appears.  
3 . Touch  
of each item to make settings.  
4 . Touch <Exit> to return to the Metronome screen.  
Se ttin g s fo r th e Co u n t-In  
Parame-  
ter Name  
Value  
Description  
fig.d-funcmenu2.eps_50  
Countdown will be added  
(ON) or not (OFF).  
Switch  
ON, OFF  
Voice (JPN),  
Voice (ENG)  
Specify the countdown  
sound.  
Sound  
Part  
Specify the track or part  
that will determine the be-  
ginning of the perfor-  
mance when added a  
countdown.  
Both Track  
Lower Track  
Upper Track  
Part 1–16  
Parame-  
ter Name  
Value  
Description  
Count-in will be added  
(ON) or not (OFF).  
Switch  
ON, OFF  
Stick, Click,  
Electronic,  
Voice (JPN),  
Voice (ENG),  
Wood Block,  
Triangle Casta-  
nets,  
Specify the count-in  
sound.  
Sound  
Hand Clap  
Animal  
Specify the length (number  
of measures) of the count-  
in.  
Mea-  
sures  
1, 2  
When “Repeat” is turned  
ON on the Marker screen  
whether the count-in will  
sound each time the range  
between the markers is re-  
peated, or only the first  
time.  
Repeat  
First, Every  
1 5 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
3 . Touch the name of the parameter you want to set.  
O th e r Se ttin g s  
Refer to the corresponding page for each function.  
You can change the tuning, the language shown on the  
4 . Touch <Exit> to return to the Functions screen.  
display, and other settings to make the KR-7/ 5 easier to use.  
Ch a n g in g Sta n d a rd Pitch  
Pro ce d u re  
1 . Switch to the Basic screen, or press the One Touch  
(Ma ste r Tu n e )  
“Standard pitch” generally refers to the pitch that is heard  
when you play middle A. When performing in an ensemble  
with other instruments, adjust the standard pitch so that the  
instruments of the ensemble match. Tuning all the  
Program [Piano] button.  
2 . Touch <Functions>.  
When you touch <Functions> on the Basic screen, the  
first page displayed shows the parameters for the  
instruments to a standard pitch is called “master tuning.”  
When you touch <Functions> on the Piano screen, the  
parameters for the piano performance settings continue  
into the second page for the KR-7, with the KR-5 settings  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-tuning.eps_50  
A “Functions screen” like the following appears.  
fig.d-funcmenu2.eps_50  
Touch  
to change the pitch.  
Display of  
the KR-7  
Standard pitch can be set to any value from 415.3–466.2 Hz.  
The setting is at “440.0 Hz” when the KR-7/ 5 is powered up.  
Parameter  
Description  
Ch a n g in g th e La n g u a g e (La n g u a g e )  
Master Tune  
Five choices are available for the language used in displaying  
information on the screen.  
Selects the language used in the  
Language  
Opening  
Message  
Sets the message that appears when  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
MIDI Ensemble  
fig.d-lang.eps_50  
ExternalDisplay Selects the content to be shown on the  
(KR-7)  
User Image  
Display (KR-7)  
Selects the image data and display  
MIDI Settings  
Program  
Change  
Remains the beat indicator off at all  
Beat Indicator  
Stores edited settings and other data to  
Memory Backup  
Touch  
to select the language.  
Restores the content stored with  
Memory Backup to the original factory  
Available settings  
Factory Reset  
Touch Screen  
English, Japanese, German, French, Spanish  
Allows for calibration of the touch  
* German, Spanish, and French are displayed for some  
functions. Other screens will be displayed in English.  
1 5 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Ch a n g in g th e Se ttin g s fo r Sh o w in g  
Im a g e s w ith th e Ex te rn a l Disp la y  
(Ex te rn a l Disp la y ) (KR-7 )  
Ch a n g in g th e Scre e n Me ssa g e  
W h e n th e Po w e r Is Tu rn e d O n  
(O p e n in g Me ssa g e )  
You can modify this screen to show your favorite phrase  
This selects the content shown on the external display  
connected to the KR-7.  
when the power is turned on.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-openmsg.eps_50  
fig.d-extdisp.eps_50  
Use  
to move the cursor.  
Touch the parameter  
to make the settings.  
When you touch the character icon, the character is input  
where at the position.  
Settings  
Value  
Setting  
Description  
When you touch the icon for the character to be input, the  
character appears at the cursor position. For example,  
touching the <ABC> icon in succession cycles you through the  
available choices in that character group (ABCA...).  
The display of scores, lyrics,  
score + keyboard, and image  
data are switched automati-  
cally.  
Auto  
Each touch of <A-a-0-!> cycles the type of characters through  
“English (upper case),” “English (lower case),” “numerals,”  
“symbols,” then back to “English (upper case).”  
The Score screen is normally  
displayed.  
Score  
Mode  
The Lyrics screen is normally  
displayed. However, lyrics  
are displayed only when  
playing back music files that  
contains lyrics data.  
When you touch <Del>, the character at the cursor position is  
deleted.  
Lyrics  
When you touch <Ins>, a space is inserted at the cursor  
position.  
Score and  
Keyboard  
The score and keyboard are  
displayed.  
When you have finished inputting the characters, touch  
<Execute>.  
Bitmap,  
Selects the screen’s back-  
ground color.  
Bitmap” displays a image  
data set in “User Image Dis-  
* Never turn off the power while the display indicates  
<Executing...>. Doing so will damage the KR-7/5’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
White, Black,  
Red, Yellow,  
Green, Blue,  
Cyan,  
Back-  
ground  
If you touch <All Clear> at the bottom of the screen and then  
touch <Execute>, the display reverts to the screen that  
normally appears when you turn on the power to the  
instrument.  
Magenta  
White, Black,  
Red, Yellow,  
Green, Blue,  
Cyan,  
Line  
Color  
Selects the color used for  
lines and text in the display.  
Magenta  
White, Black,  
Red, Yellow,  
Green, Blue,  
Cyan,  
Selects the color used for the  
bouncing ball on the score  
and lyrics displays.  
Bounc-  
ing Ball  
Magenta  
1 5 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
3 . Touch the name of the stored image data.  
Se le ctin g Im a g e s To Be Sh o w n o n  
th e KR-7 a n d Ex te rn a l Disp la y s  
(Use r Im a g e Disp la y ) (KR-7 )  
When you touch <Preview>, you can then show the  
selected image data on the display selected in Step 1.  
You can have image data from computers and other devices  
shown on the onboard display, or on an external display  
youve connected. You can store two types of image data,  
“KR-display-use” data, and “external-display-use” data.  
4 . Touch <Save>.  
The selected image data is stored.  
5 . Touch <Exit> to return to the previous screen.  
To clear the stored image data, touch <Erase>.  
KR-display-use” images appear on the KR-7’s display when  
the instrument’s power is turned on. Refer to the procedure in  
instrument so the “external-display-use” image is displayed  
on the external display.  
Im a g e d a ta th a t KR-7 ca n d isp la y  
320 x 240 pixels (for KR display)  
Size  
640 x 480 pixels (for external display)  
Color  
1/ 4/ 8 bit (2/ 16/ 256 colors)  
BMP format  
Display>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-usrimage.eps_50  
Format  
* The KR-7/5 cannot deal with compressed  
image data.  
1–8 characters in length (lowercase is ok). A  
filename extension of “.BMP” (uppercase  
characters) must be added after the name.  
The following characters can be used to  
name an image.  
A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U  
V W X Y Z a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s  
t u v w x y z 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 # $ % & ‘ ( ) -  
@ ~ { } ^ _ !  
Name  
* If you use a character that cannot be used  
in a name, it will be replaced by another  
character when displayed.  
Se le ctin g th e d isp la y to b e se t  
1 . Touch <KR Display> or <Ext. Display>.  
Select the setting either for “KR-display-use” or  
“external-display-use” images.  
Se le ctin g th e im a g e s to b e d isp la y e d  
First, take a floppy disk to which the image data stored  
in the KR-7 has been saved, and insert the disk in the  
disk drive.  
2 . Touch <File>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-usrimage2.eps_50  
1 5 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Tu rn in g O ff th e Be a t In d ica to r  
Re sto rin g th e Fa cto ry Se ttin g s  
(Be a t In d ica to r)  
(Fa cto ry Re se t)  
The beat indicator normally flashes in time with the  
metronome, Music Style, or song tempo. However, if you  
wish, it can be set to remain off at all times.  
settings. This operation is referred to as “Factory Reset.”  
* When you perform a Factory Reset, all settings that have been  
stored in memory up to then are erased and reset to their  
factory defaults.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-memory.eps_50  
This operation does not return the touch screen calibration  
settings to the original factory condition. To return the touch  
screen calibration settings to the original factory settings, refer  
When you want to restore the content registered to the KR-7’s  
When you want to restore the content registered to the KR-5’s  
Touch  
to turn the setting ON, or OFF (so the beat  
indicator remains off).  
Re m e m b e rin g th e Se ttin g s  
Eve n W h e n th e Po w e r is  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-factory.eps_50  
Tu rn e d O ff (Me m o ry Ba ck u p )  
Normally, the various settings revert to their default values  
when the power is turned off. However, you can specify that  
the settings will be remembered even when the power is  
turned off. This function is called “Memory Backup.”  
For more on the settings stored using Memory Backup, refer to  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-memory.eps_50  
Touch <Execute>.  
The confirmation message appears on screen.  
Touch <OK> to restore the original factory settings.  
When the setting is changed, the previous screen returns.  
When you touch <Cancel>, the settings are left untouched,  
and youre returned to the previous screen.  
* Never turn off the power while the display indicates  
<Executing...>. Doing so will damage the KR-7/5’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
Touch <Execute>.  
The confirmation message appears on screen.  
Touch <OK> to store the setting.  
When the setting has been stored in memory, the previous  
screen will reappear.  
* Never turn off the power while the display indicates  
<Executing...>. Doing so will damage the KR-7/5’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
1 5 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
Ca lib ra tin g th e To u ch Scre e n  
Cle a rin g th e “ Fa vo rite s”  
(KR-5 )  
(To u ch Scre e n )  
If youve been using the touch screen for some time, the  
pointer may be shifted, making the KR-7/ 5 react incorrectly.  
You should correct this displacement when necessary by  
performing calibration (repositioning).  
1 . Press the [Disk] button.  
2 . Touch <File>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-touchpanel.eps_50  
3 . Touch <Clear Favorites>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-touchpanel.eps_50  
Touch <Execute>.  
Touch the points indicated.  
4 . Touch <OK>.  
* Do this carefully, because touching a location that’s different  
from the one indicated for the pointer may make the  
displacement even worse. Be sure to touch the pointer  
accurately.  
All of the content in the Favorites is deleted.  
If you touch <Cancel>, the deletion is cancelled, and  
youre returned to the previous screen.  
* Never turn off the power while the display indicates  
<Executing...>. Doing so will damage the KR-5’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
When the calibration is finished, touch <Write> to store the  
settings.  
* If you don’t write them to memory, the calibration settings  
will be discarded as soon as the power is switched off.  
Carrying out this operation does not initialize any settings  
other than the “Favorites.” To restore settings other than those  
for the “Favorites” to the original factory settings, carry out  
Re tu rn in g th e to u ch scre e n ca lib ra tio n se ttin g s  
to th e o rig in a l fa cto ry se ttin g s  
If you touch <Factory Reset> in the above screen, the touch  
screen calibration settings revert to the original factory  
settings.  
Fo rm a ttin g th e Use r Me m o ry  
(KR-7 )  
The KR-7 features an internal storage area where you can  
save recorded performances and User Styles. This space is  
called the “User Memory.”  
The following content is stored to the user memory.  
To delete all of the content held in the user memory and  
restore the original factory settings, carry out the following  
procedure.  
1 5 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                           
Ch a p te r 8 Va rio u s Se ttin g s  
fig.d-touchpanel.eps_50  
1 . Press the [Disk] button.  
Even when you press the Music Style [User] button  
(User/ Disk screen) or the [User Program] button, the  
rest of the procedure is the same.  
2 . Touch <File>.  
3 . Touch <Format User Memory>.  
A screen like the one shown below appears.  
fig.d-touchpanel.eps_50  
3 . Touch <ON> or <OFF>.  
When set to “ON,” the Quick Tour starts when you turn  
on the power. The demo stops as soon as you carry out  
any kind of operation. If no operation is performed for  
5–10 minutes after that, the automatic demo starts again.  
When set to “OFF,” the Quick Tour does not start unless  
you touch the Quick Tour screen icon.  
4 . Touch <Exit> to return to the Quick Tour screen.  
4 . Touch <OK>.  
* For more information about Quick Tour, refer to the Quick  
Start.  
All of the content in the user memory is deleted.  
If you touch <Cancel>, the deletion is cancelled, and  
youre returned to the previous screen.  
* Never turn off the power while the display indicates  
<Executing...>. Doing so will damage the KR-7’s internal  
memory, making it unusable.  
Disa b lin g Fu n ctio n s O th e r  
Th a n Pia n o Pe rfo rm a n ce  
(Pa n e l Lo ck )  
Carrying out this operation does not initialize any settings  
other than the user memory settings. To restore settings other  
than those for the user memory to the original factory settings,  
The “Panel Lock” function locks the KR-7/ 5 in a state where  
only piano performance can be used, and all buttons will be  
disabled. This prevents the settings from being inadvertently  
modified even if children press the buttons accidentally.  
* In the Panel Lock state, only the grand piano sound can be  
played.  
Au to m a tica lly Sta rtin g th e  
Q u ick To u r  
1 . Turn down the volume all the way.  
You can set the instrument so that the Quick Tour starts  
automatically with no operation required.  
2 . Press the [Power] switch to turn off the power.  
3 . While holding down the [Wonderland/Game] button,  
1 . Hold down the [Wonderland/Game] button and press  
press the [Power] switch and turn on the power.  
the [Part Balance] button.  
Then, continue to hold down the button for a few  
seconds.  
The Quick Tour screen appears.  
2 . Touch <Option>.  
All buttons except for piano play are disabled.  
Adjust the volume. When you play the keyboard, the  
grand piano sound will be heard.  
To undo the Panel Lock function, turn the volume down  
to the minimum, and turn on the power once again.  
1 5 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 9 Co n n e ctin g Ex te rn a l De vice s  
You can connect the KR-7/ 5 to external devices such as  
Co n n e ctin g MIDI De vice s  
audio equipment and MIDI instruments.  
By connecting an external MIDI device and exchanging  
performance data, you can control one device from the other.  
You can connect a MIDI sequencer and record performance  
For instance, you can output sound from the other  
data from the KR-7/ 5, or play performance data from the  
instrument or switch Tones on the other instrument.  
KR-7/ 5 on the sequencer. Also, when you connect a MIDI  
W h a t’s MIDI?  
sound module, you can perform on the KR-7/ 5 and hear the  
MIDI, short for “Musical Instrument Digital Interface,” was  
sounds played through the MIDI sound module.  
developed as a universal standard for the exchange of  
performance data between electronic instruments and  
The KR-7/ 5 has high-quality built-in stereo speakers, but  
you can also hook it up a stereo system for an even more  
impressive sound.  
computers.  
The KR-7/ 5 is equipped with MIDI connectors and a  
Computer connector to let it exchange performance data  
with external devices. These connectors can be used to  
connect the KR-7/ 5 to an external device for even greater  
versatility.  
You can also connect it to a tape recorder or other recording  
equipment and record your performances.  
* A separate publication titled “MIDI Implementation” is also  
available. It provides complete details concerning the way  
MIDI has been implemented on this unit. If you should require  
this publication (such as when you intend to carry out byte-  
level programming), please contact the nearest Roland Service  
Center or authorized Roland distributor.  
You can use a sequencer program (such as Roland Visual-  
MT) to record performance data from the KR-7/ 5 and play  
performance data from the program on the KR-7/ 5.  
Co n n e cto rs  
fig.09-  
MIDI  
Out  
In  
MIDI O u t Co n n e cto r  
Connect this to the MIDI In connector on an external MIDI  
device using a MIDI cable (sold separately).  
Performance data when you play the keyboard or depress a  
pedal is sent from this connector to the external MIDI  
connector.  
MIDI In Co n n e cto r  
Connect this to the MIDI Out connector on an external MIDI  
device using a MIDI cable (sold separately).  
This receives MIDI messages that are sent from external  
MIDI devices. The KR-7/ 5 receiving MIDI messages can  
output sounds, exchange tones and perform other  
operations.  
* There are two MIDI In connectors, on the bottom panel and on  
the rear panel of the unit. You can’t use both MIDI In  
connectors at the same time.  
* External MIDI devices can’t be used for remotely changing the  
Tones played by the KR-7/5’s keyboard.  
1 5 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Ch a p te r 9 Co n n e ctin g Ex te rn a l De vice s  
Ma k in g th e Co n n e ctio n s  
* To prevent malfunction and/or damage to speakers or other  
devices, always turn down the volume, and turn off the power  
on all devices before making any connections.  
Pe rfo rm in g in En se m b le w ith  
MIDI In stru m e n ts  
(MIDI En se m b le )  
You can connect an electronic percussion device or other  
MIDI instrument to the KR-7/ 5s MIDI In connector for  
ensemble playing. Making the MIDI settings for the  
instrument connected to the MIDI In connector is easy. The  
sounds from the connected MIDI instrument are played from  
the KR-7/ 5’s speaker.  
1 . Turn the volume all the way down on the KR-7/5 and  
on the device youre about to connect.  
2 . Switch off the power to the KR-7/5 and the device  
youre about to connect.  
3 . Set the Computer switch on the underside of the unit to  
1 . Switch to the Basic screen, or press the One Touch  
“MIDI.”  
Program [Piano] button.  
4 . Use a MIDI cable (sold separately) to connect the MIDI  
2 . Touch <Functions>.  
connectors to each other.  
Please refer to the connection examples below.  
3 . Touch <MIDI Ensemble>.  
A screen like the following appears.  
fig.09-04.eps  
5 . Switch on the power to the KR-7/5 and the connected  
device.  
6 . Adjust the volume level on the KR-7/5 and the  
connected device.  
7 . You should also set the MIDI settings as needed.  
For details on the MIDI-related settings, refer to  
Co n n e ctio n Ex a m p le s:  
Se tu p w ith a MIDI Se q u e n ce r  
fig.09-10  
4 . Select the method for using the MIDI In connector.  
Roland MT Series  
Displayed  
Normal  
Meaning  
Out  
MIDI  
In  
Normal setting. Make changes in Tone and  
other settings from the connected device.  
KR-7/5  
Select this when you have percussion pads  
(such as Rolands SPD-20 Total Percussion  
Pad) connected to the KR-7/ 5s MIDI In con-  
nector. You do not need to make any MIDI  
settings on the KR-7/ 5. Select pad Tones and  
make other settings from the connected pads  
(for further details, refer to the Owners  
Manual provided with the pads).  
MIDI  
Out  
In  
Pedal  
Input  
Output  
(
)
(
)
R
L
Mono  
R
L
Mono  
Pad  
Stereo  
Stereo  
* When the KR-7/5 is connected to a MIDI sequencer, set it to  
Local OFF. Refer to “Disconnecting the Keyboard from the  
Select this when you have a keyboard (such  
as a Roland A-37 or AX-7 MIDI Keyboard  
Controller) connected to the KR-7/ 5s MIDI  
In connector. You can select tones for the  
connected keyboard from the KR-7/ 5. No  
MIDI settings need be made on the KR-7/ 5.  
Co n n e ctin g w ith a MIDI So u n d Mo d u le  
fig.09-  
Keyboard  
Sound Module  
MIDI  
THRU  
OUT  
IN  
5 . When “Keyboard” is selected in Step 4 above, use  
KR-7/5  
MIDI  
Out  
In  
Pedal  
Input  
Output  
to select the Tone.  
(
)
(
)
R
L
Mono  
R
L
Mono  
The connected keyboard plays using the selected Tone.  
Stereo  
Stereo  
1 5 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Ch a p te r 9 Co n n e ctin g Ex te rn a l De vice s  
Ma k in g th e Se ttin g s  
MIDI Se ttin g s  
1 . Switch to the Basic screen, or press the One Touch  
With the KR-7/ 5, you can make MIDI settings like those  
described below.  
Program [Piano] button.  
2 . Touch <Functions>.  
“MIDI Setting Screen”  
fig.09-04.eps  
3 . Touch <MIDI Setting> or <Program Change>.  
4 . Touch  
to make the setting for each  
item.  
Touch <Exit> to return to the Functions screen.  
Se le ctin g th e Tra n sm it Ch a n n e l  
(Tx Ch a n n e l)  
MIDI organizes things into “channels,” which are numbered  
from 1 through 16. Simply connecting a cable is not enough  
for communication to take place. The connected devices must  
be set to use the same MIDI channels. Otherwise, no sound  
will be produced, and no sounds can be selected.  
Display  
Description  
Chooses the MIDI send channel  
Tx Channel  
Switches Local Control on or off  
Local Control  
Select the transmit channel (1–16) of the KR-7/ 5.  
The channel setting is at “1” when the KR-7/ 5 is powered up.  
If the keyboard has been split into right-hand and left-hand  
sections, messages from the left-hand section are fixed at “3.”  
“Program Change Screen”  
fig.09-04.eps  
The KR-7/ 5 receives messages on all channels from 1  
through 16.  
Disco n n e ctin g th e In te rn a l  
So u n d Ge n e ra to r a n d  
Ke y b o a rd (Lo ca l Co n tro l)  
When connecting a MIDI sequencer, set Local Control to  
“OFF.” The setting is at “Local Control ON” when the KR-7/  
5 is powered up.  
As illustrated, information describing what has been played  
on the keyboard is passed to the sound module over two  
different routes, (1) and (2). As a result, you hear overlapping  
or intermittent sounds. To prevent this from happening,  
route (1) must be disabled, by setting the unit to what is  
Display  
Description  
Sends Bank Select MSB messages.  
Bank Select MSB  
Sends Bank Select LSB messages.  
Bank Select LSB  
Program Change  
known as “Local Off.”  
fig.09-  
Sends Program Change messages  
Local On  
(1)  
Sequencer  
Memory  
MIDI  
OUT  
MIDI  
IN  
Sound  
Generator  
MIDI  
OUT  
MIDI  
IN  
Soft Tru On  
(2)  
Each note played is sounded twice  
1 6 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                   
Ch a p te r 9 Co n n e ctin g Ex te rn a l De vice s  
Local On: The keyboard and internal sound generator are  
Se n d in g Re co rd e d  
connected.  
fig.09-  
Pe rfo rm a n ce Da ta to a MIDI  
De vice (Co m p o se r MIDI O u t)  
Sound is emitted  
When Composer Out is active, you can send performance  
data recorded with the KR-7/ 5 to a connected MIDI device  
or computer.  
Sound Generator  
Local On  
When you turn on the power, this is set to “OFF” (data is not  
sent).  
1 . Press the [Menu] button.  
2 . Touch <Composer MIDI Out>.  
fig.09-04.eps  
Local Off: The keyboard and internal sound generator are  
separated. No sound will be produced by the keyboard when  
it is played.  
fig.09-  
No sound produced  
Sound Generator  
Local Off  
3 . Touch  
to set ON or OFF.  
When connecting a unit in the Roland MT series, you don’t  
need to switch off Local Control. MT units transmit Local Off  
messages when their power is switched on. If you first switch  
on the KR-7/5, then the MT-series device, Local Control is  
automatically switched off on the KR-7/5.  
4 . Touch <Exit> to return to the Menu screen.  
Se n d in g To n e Ch a n g e Me ssa g e s  
(Pro g ra m Ch a n g e / Ba n k Se le ct  
MSB/ Ba n k Se le ct LSB)  
A Program Change is a message that means “change to the  
Tone of the specified number.” The device that receives this  
changes to the Tone of the corresponding number.  
When you choose a Program Change message (Program  
Number), the Program Number will be transmitted to the  
MIDI device connected to the KR-7/ 5. The MIDI device that  
receives the Program Number changes the tone to the  
corresponding Program Number.  
Normally, the Tone is selected from the 128 Tones available.  
Some MIDI devices, however, have more than 128 Tones.  
With such devices, the Tone is selected through a  
combination of Program Change messages and Bank Select  
messages. There are two parts of a Bank Select message: the  
MSB (Controller 0, with a value of 0–127) and the LSB  
(Controller 32, with a value of 0–127).  
* Some MIDI instruments can’t handle Bank Select messages.  
Others can handle Bank Selects, but do not recognize the LSB  
part.  
1 6 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Ch a p te r 9 Co n n e ctin g Ex te rn a l De vice s  
2 . Turn off the power to the KR-7/5 and other connected  
Co n n e ctin g to Au d io  
Eq u ip m e n t  
equipment.  
3 . Use audio cables (sold separately) to make the  
When you connect the KR-7/ 5 to audio equipment, you can  
play the sounds from the KR-7/ 5 through the speakers on  
the audio equipment or record your performances on a tape  
recorder or other recording device.  
connection.  
4 . Switch on the KR-7/5.  
5 . Switch on the connected device.  
When connecting, please use audio cables (sold separately)  
with standard phone plugs.  
6 . Adjust the volume level on the KR-7/5 and the  
connected device.  
Co n n e cto rs  
fig.09-  
Recording KR-7/ 5 Performances on a Recording Device  
Input  
Output  
7 . Start recording with the connected device.  
(
)
(
)
R
L Mono  
R
L Mono  
8 . Play the keyboard.  
Stereo  
Stereo  
9 . When the performance ends, stop recording on the  
connected equipment.  
O u tp u t Ja ck s  
You can connect audio equipment using audio cables (sold  
separately) and play the sounds from the KR-7/ 5 through the  
speakers on the connected equipment, or record your  
performances on a tape recorder or other recording device.  
Pla y in g Au d io Eq u ip m e n t So u n d s Th ro u g h th e  
Sp e a k e rs o n th e KR-7 / 5  
fig.09-  
Output R/L  
(Line Out)  
If the input of the connected device is monaural, you must  
use the L (Mono) jack.  
KR-7/5  
In p u t Ja ck s  
MIDI  
Out  
In  
Pedal  
Input  
Output  
You can connect another sound source, such as audio  
equipment or an electronic instrument, using audio cables  
(sold separately). Play the sounds from the connected device  
through the speakers on the KR-7/ 5.  
(
)
(
)
R
L Mono  
R
L Mono  
Stereo  
Stereo  
1 . Turn the volume all the way down on the KR-7/5 and  
If the input of the connected device is monaural, you must  
use the L (Mono) jack.  
on the device youre about to connect.  
2 . Turn off the power to the KR-7/5 and other connected  
Ma k in g th e Co n n e ctio n s  
equipment.  
* To prevent malfunction and/or damage to speakers or other  
devices, always turn down the volume, and turn off the power  
on all devices before making any connections.  
3 . Use audio cables (sold separately) to make the  
connection.  
4 . Turn on the connected equipment.  
Pla y in g So u n d s fro m th e KR-7 / 5 Th ro u g h th e  
Sp e a k e rs o n Au d io Eq u ip m e n t o r Re co rd in g Yo u r  
Pe rfo rm a n ce s o n a Re co rd in g De vice  
5 . Turn on the KR-7/5.  
fig.09-  
6 . Adjust the volume level on the KR-7/5 and the  
Input R/L  
(Line In, Aux In)  
connected device.  
After use, turn off the power using the following procedure.  
KR-7/5  
1 . Turn the volume all the way down on the KR-7/5 and  
MIDI  
Out  
In  
Pedal  
Input  
Output  
on the device youre about to connect.  
(
)
(
)
R
L Mono  
R
L Mono  
2 . Turn off the KR-7/5.  
Stereo  
Stereo  
3 . Turn off the connected equipment.  
1 . Turn the volume all the way down on the KR-7/5 and  
on the device youre about to connect.  
1 6 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Ch a p te r 9 Co n n e ctin g Ex te rn a l De vice s  
Co n n e ct to th e Co m p u te r  
Co n n e ctin g a Co m p u te r  
Co n n e cto r  
You can connect a computer on which a sequencing program  
such as Roland Visual MT is installed and save songs  
recorded on the KR-7/ 5 on the computer.  
Co n n e ct to th e MIDI Co n n e cto rs  
You can use a USB MIDI interface cable (sold separately) to  
connect the KR-7/ 5 to your computer.  
If the KR-7/ 5 is connected to a computer in which sequencer  
software such as Rolands Visual MT” is installed, a song  
youve recorded on the KR-7/ 5 can be saved on your  
computer.  
Co n n e cto rs  
fig.09-  
Computer  
-
PC 2  
Co n n e ctio n e x a m p le s  
-
PC 1  
Mac  
MIDI  
* To prevent malfunction and/or damage to speakers or other  
devices, always turn down the volume, and turn off the power  
on all devices before making any connections.  
Co m p u te r Co n n e cto r  
You can connect a computer to this connector to exchange  
performance data.  
* In order to make connections to your computer, you must  
install “MIDI driver” software on your computer. For details,  
refer to the owner’s manual for your MIDI interface.  
Use a computer cable (sold separately) to make the  
connection.  
The type of cable required will depend on your computer.  
Use a USB MIDI interface cable to connect the USB  
connector of your computer to the MIDI connectors of  
the KR-7/ 5.  
Co m p u te r Sw itch  
The setting for this switch is made depending on the  
computer connected— Mac/ PC-1/ PC-2.  
When this switch is set to MIDI, this connector cannot be  
used.  
Set the Computer switch on the KRs bottom panel to  
“MIDI,” then turn on the power to the KR.  
fig.comp.e  
USB Connector  
of your Computer  
Ma k in g th e Co n n e ctio n s  
* To prevent malfunction and/or damage to speakers or other  
devices, always turn down the volume, and turn off the power  
on all devices before making any connections.  
UM-1 etc.  
Computer  
MIDI IN  
MIDI OUT  
KR-7/5  
MIDI  
Out  
In  
Pedal  
Input  
Output  
1 . Turn off the KR-7/5 and the computer.  
(
)
(
)
R
L
Mono  
R
L
Mono  
2 . Using a compatible computer cable (sold separately),  
connect the Computer connector on the underside of  
the KR-7/5 with the computers serial port.  
Stereo  
Stereo  
3 . Set the computer switch on the underside of the KR-7/5  
to match the type of computer connected.  
Please refer to the connection examples below.  
* Change the setting of the Computer switch only after the  
power to the unit is off.  
4 . Turn on the KR-7/5.  
5 . Turn on the computer.  
6 . Make the settings for baud rate (transmission speed)  
for the computer and the software.  
For more information on this procedure, please refer to  
the owners manual for your computer.  
7 . You should also make the settings for the MIDI send  
1 6 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Ch a p te r 9 Co n n e ctin g Ex te rn a l De vice s  
Co n n e ctio n Ex a m p le s:  
Co n n e ctio n w ith a n Ap p le Ma cin to sh co m p u te r  
Use a computer cable (sold separately) to connect the  
Computer connector on the KR-7/ 5 to the modem port (or  
printer port) on the Apple Macintosh. Set the Computer  
switch to “Mac.”  
When using the Macintosh “Patch Bay” utility, specify 1  
MHz as the Interface Type (MIDI Interface Clock).  
fig.09-  
Apple Macintosh  
Modem Port  
Computer  
-
PC 2  
Computer cable (sold separately)  
-
PC 1  
Macintosh IIci  
Mac  
MIDI  
Co n n e ctio n w ith a n IBM PC  
Use a computer cable (sold separately) to connect the  
Computer connector on the KR-7/ 5 to the COM1 or COM2  
serial port on the IBM PC. Set the Computer switch to “PC-  
2.”  
fig.09-  
IBM PC/AT  
RS-232C  
Computer  
-
PC 2  
-
PC 1  
Computer cable (sold separately)  
Mac  
MIDI  
1 6 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ch a p te r 9 Co n n e ctin g Ex te rn a l De vice s  
MEMO  
1 6 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ap p e n d ice s  
Tro u b le sh o o tin g  
If you think theres a problem, read this first.  
Case  
Cause/Remedy  
Case  
Cause/Remedy  
The power doesn’t  
come on.  
Is the power cord connected and plugged in  
N o so u n d is h e a rd  
The button doesn’t  
work.  
connected device turned all the way down?  
Turn the power off, then back on.  
The KR-7/ 5 uses a liquid-crystal screen, so  
text may not be displayed when the ambient  
temperature is below freezing.  
Nothing appears  
on screen.  
Has the Balance knob been moved all the way  
to the right or left?  
Has the volume been set to “0” using the Part  
No sound is heard.  
Vertical lines ap-  
pear in the screen/  
Color is “washed  
out” at the edges of  
the screen  
These occur due to the nature of a liquid crys-  
tal display, and do not indicate a malfunction.  
They can be minimized by adjusting the  
Are all sliders in the Equalizer screen at the  
Has the footage been adjusted so that all fre-  
quency components arent sounded? (p. 15 in  
the Quick Start)  
The positioning of the touch screen may be-  
come displaced if some time has passed since  
correct the positioning.  
The touch screen  
doesn’t respond  
correctly.  
Have all devices been switched on?  
No sound is heard  
(when a MIDI in-  
strument is con-  
nected).  
Adjust the adjuster underneath the pedal so  
that the pedal presses firmly against the floor  
Does the MIDI channel match the connected  
The pedal rattles  
Is the Computer switch on the bottom of the  
Is the pedal connected correctly?  
Make sure the pedal cord extending from the  
stand is securely connected to the pedal  
The MIDI connectors and the computer con-  
nector cannot be used at the same time.  
Confirm that the computer switch is set to  
“MIDI” when a MIDI device is connected to  
the MIDI connector, and to either “MAC,”  
“PC-1,” “PC-2,” when a computer is connect-  
You cannot use a  
connected MIDI  
device and com-  
puter simulta-  
neously  
Depressing a ped-  
al has no effect, or  
the pedal effect  
doesn’t stop.  
Has a different function been assigned to the  
pedal?  
Normal pedal operation is automatically en-  
abled when the One Touch Program [Piano]  
Has Local Control been set to “Off”?  
When Local Control is set to Off, no sound is  
produced by playing the keyboard.  
No sound is heard  
when the keyboard  
is played.  
The volume level  
of the instrument  
connected to Input  
jacks is too low.  
Could you be using a connection cable that  
contains a resistor?  
The maximum number of notes that the KR-7  
can play simultaneously is 128, and that the  
KR-5 can play is 64. Frequent use of the damp-  
er pedal during automatic accompaniment or  
when playing along with a song on floppy  
disk may result in performance data with too  
many notes, causing some notes to drop out.  
Use a connection cable that does not contain a  
resistor.  
Not all played  
notes are sound-  
ed.  
Is the external displays power turned on?  
Are you using a display that is compatible  
with the KR?  
Th e so u n d is stra n g e  
Images not shown  
on external display  
when external dis-  
play is connected  
Sounds are heard  
twice (doubled)  
when the keyboard  
is played.  
When the KR-7/ 5 is connected to an external  
sequencer, set it to the Local OFF mode  
set so its Soft Thru feature is OFF.  
Are the KRs settings correct?  
set the “External Display” image. Also refer to  
“Changing the Settings for Showing Images  
1 6 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Tro u b le sh o o tin g  
Case  
Cause/Remedy  
Case  
Cause/Remedy  
When listening through headphones:  
Some of the more flamboyant and effervescent  
piano tones feature an ample high-end compo-  
nent, which may make the sound appear to  
have metallic reverberation added. Since this  
reverberation becomes particularly audible  
when supplemented by heavy reverb, you  
may be able to diminish the problem by reduc-  
ing the amount of reverb applied to the sound.  
When listening through speakers:  
The tuning or pitch  
of the keyboard or  
song is off.  
Are the settings for the “Temperament” and  
Is the setting for the “Master Tune” correct?  
A High-pitched  
It’s not possible to apply more than one effect  
at the same time, so when a performance has  
been recorded on multiple tracks or when  
playing along with a song as its played back,  
the desired effect may not be applied.  
whine is produced  
Effects cannot be  
applied to Tones.  
Here, a different cause (such as resonance  
produced by the KR-7/ 5) would be suspect.  
Consult your Roland dealer or nearest Roland  
Service Center.  
Have the Chord Tone and Bass Tone been  
A note doesn’t stop  
playing  
Some Chord Tone and Bass Tone notes may  
be sounded continuously.  
When listening through speakers:  
Playing at loud volumes may cause instru-  
ments near the KR-7/ 5 to resonate. Reso-  
nation can also occur with fluorescent light  
tubes, glass doors, and other objects. In partic-  
ular, this problem occurs more easily when  
the bass component is increased, and when  
the sound is played at higher volumes. Use  
the following measures to suppress such res-  
onance.  
During automatic accompaniment, changing  
the Music Style automatically changes the  
Tones and tempo of the upper part of the key-  
board to match the new Music Style. If you  
want to change only the Music Style without  
also altering the tempo and Tone, check out  
“Changing Music Styles Without Changing  
The bass range  
sounds odd, or  
there is a vibrating  
resonance  
The Tone has  
changed.  
• Place speakers so they are 10–15 cm from  
walls and other surfaces.  
When a performance made along with a Mu-  
sic Files tune has been recorded, recording the  
performance to button [1/ Whole] may make  
the Tones for buttons [3/ Lower] and [4/ Up-  
per] change as well.  
• Reduce the volume.  
• Move the speakers away from any resonat-  
ing objects.  
When listening through headphones:  
Here, a different cause (such as resonance  
produced by the KR-7/ 5) would be suspect.  
Consult your Roland dealer or nearest Roland  
Service Center.  
Since the KR-7/ 5’s piano sounds faithfully re-  
produce the sense of spaciousness and rever-  
beration of an actual acoustic pianos sound, a  
certain amount of reverberation is still percep-  
tible, even with the reverb effect deactivated.  
Reverberation still  
audible even with  
Reverb turned off  
Th e a u to m a tic a cco m p a n im e n t d o e sn ’t p la y  
co rre ctly  
On an acoustic piano, notes in the upper one  
and a half octaves of the keyboard continue to  
sound until they decay naturally, regardless  
of the damper pedal. There is a difference in  
the timbre as well. Roland pianos faithfully  
simulate such characteristics of the acoustic  
piano. On the KR-7/ 5, the range that is unaf-  
fected by the damper pedal will change de-  
pending on the Key Transpose setting.  
Touch <Exit> several times to return to the  
Can’t select a tone  
or Music Style  
In the upper range,  
the sound changes  
abruptly beyond a  
certain key  
Music Style.  
Has the Balance knob been moved all the way  
Have you pressed the One Touch Program  
Automatic accom-  
paniment is not  
heard.  
[Arranger] button?  
If the One Touch Program [Arranger] button  
has not been pressed, only the rhythm pattern  
Is the 16-track Sequencer screen displayed?  
Has Chord Intelligence been switched off?  
Chord Intelligence  
can’t be used.  
Is the setting for “Piano Style Arranger”  
1 6 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tro u b le sh o o tin g  
Case  
Cause/Remedy  
Case  
Cause/Remedy  
In certain cases, such as when playing Music  
Styles on disks, the accompaniment may lag  
when excessive amounts of performance data  
are used.  
If you select a part that does not contain perfor-  
mance data, notes will not be displayed in the  
Accompaniment  
tempo becomes  
unstable  
The score screen feature is particularly unsuit-  
able for the display of difficult, complex musi-  
cal works that demand accurate notation.  
Score is not indi-  
cated properly in  
the display.  
Song doesn’t play back correctly  
Does the screen indicate message, like “OK to  
Song doesn’t play  
back  
The internal songs cannot be played back  
while recorded performance data remains in  
the KR-7/ 5’s memory. Try playing back the  
song after deleting the performance data.  
In the score screen, some lyrics or notes could  
extend beyond the edges of the screen, and  
not be displayed.  
Is the light for the Track button extinguished?  
In certain cases, such as when playing songs  
on disks, the song may lag when excessive  
amounts of performance data are used.  
Song becomes  
unstable  
Only the sound of a  
particular instru-  
ment in a song  
does not play  
If the button light is out, the music on that  
track is not heard. Press the track button so  
the light is illuminated.  
Can’t record  
Has one of the track buttons for recording  
Have song settings been changed for each Part  
Has the setting for “Punch-in Recording”  
made?  
Some music files may contain settings that  
stop play at a point partway through the song.  
Pressing the [  
(Reset)] button  
doesn’t return to  
the beginning of  
the song.  
Press the [  
(Reset)] button several times  
Can’t record  
more to return to the beginning of the tune.  
It is not possible to record while the score is  
being generated. Once the unit has finished  
generating the score (i.e., when the measure  
number in the screen is no longer highlight-  
ed), try the operation once again.  
The fast-forward and reverse buttons are ig-  
nored while music files is being read in. Wait  
until processing finishes.  
The [  
and [  
(Fwd)]  
(Bwd)]  
If you select an internal song in which the  
tempo changes during the song, and then  
record, the tempo will change in the same  
way for the performances that are recorded  
on the other tracks. The tempo of the metro-  
nome will also change in the same way.  
If you attempt to play back performance data  
that contains more data than the entire capac-  
ity of the KR-7/ 5’s memory, you may find  
that operations other than playback (such as  
rewind or fast forward) become unavailable.  
buttons don’t work.  
Tempo of recorded  
song or metro-  
nome is off  
There are two types of SMF music files: for-  
mat 0 and format 1. If the song uses SMF for-  
mat 1 data, there will be a slight delay until  
playback starts. Refer to the booklet that came  
with the music files youre using to determine  
the format type.  
If you record additional material without  
erasing the previously recorded song, the  
song will be recorded at the first-recorded  
tempo. Please erase the previously recorded  
There is a slight  
delay before play-  
back of a song on  
floppy disk starts.  
Any performance that has been recorded is  
deleted when the power to the KR-7/ 5 is  
turned off or a song is selected. A perfor-  
mance cannot be restored once its been delet-  
ed. Be sure to save it on a floppy disk or User  
Memory before you turn off the power  
With some music files, the lyrics cannot be  
displayed correctly.  
The recorded per-  
formance has dis-  
appeared.  
If you press a button while the lyrics are being  
shown in the display, the lyrics will disap-  
pear. To recall them, touch <lyrics> in the Pi-  
ano or Basic screen, or press the  
Lyrics are not indi-  
cated properly in  
the display.  
[
(Play/ Stop)] button.  
In the score screen, some lyrics or notes could  
extend beyond the edges of the screen, and  
not be displayed.  
1 6 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Erro r Me ssa g e s  
Indica-  
tion  
Meaning  
Indica-  
tion  
Meaning  
To protect the copyright, this music file cannot be  
saved as an SMF.  
The selected image data cannot be displayed. If it  
cannot be made to appear either on the KR-7s dis-  
play or the external display, you will need to pre-  
pare image data that can be used with the KR-7  
Error 00:  
Also, the music file can not be saved. If you want to  
save it, please save on the same floppy disk.  
Error 17:  
Error 30:  
You can only read the music file. It can not be saved  
on a floppy disk or user memory (KR-7).  
Error 01:  
Error 02:  
The internal memory capacity of the KR-7/ 5 is full.  
delete the song or the User style data stored on the  
KR-7/ 5 memory.  
The protect tab on the floppy disk is set to the Pro-  
tect position (p. 6). Change it to the Write position.  
Repeat the procedure.  
The KR-7/ 5 cannot deal with the excessive MIDI  
data sent from the external MIDI device. Reduce the  
amount of MIDI data sent to the KR-7/ 5.  
This floppy disk cannot store the format or save any  
data.  
Error 40:  
Error 41:  
Error 03:  
Error 04:  
Insert a different disk and repeat the procedure.  
A MIDI cable or computer cable has been discon-  
nected. Connect it properly and securely.  
The data cannot be saved onto this floppy disk be-  
cause the format is different. Use the floppy disk in  
the same format.  
An excessive amount of performance data has been  
sent to KR-7/ 5 in one time and therefore could not  
be recorded. Change the tempo more slowly to  
record the performance again.  
A new song cannot be written on this song. Select a  
different song number or use a different floppy  
disk, and repeat the procedure.  
Error 42:  
Error 43  
Error 51:  
Error 05:  
Error 10:  
The Computer switch is set to a wrong position or  
the computer is set wrongly. Switch off the KR-7/ 5  
then set the Computer switch to the correct position  
and set the computer correctly. After that, switch on  
the KR-7/ 5 again.  
No floppy disk is connected to the disk drive.  
Insert the disk correctly, and repeat the procedure.  
There is not sufficient space left on the floppy disk  
or User memory (KR-7) for the data to be saved.  
Insert a different floppy disk or delete files on user  
memory, and repeat the procedure.  
Error 11:  
Error 12:  
There may be a problem with the system. Repeat  
the procedure from the beginning. If it is not solved  
after you have tried several times, contact the Ro-  
land service center.  
The floppy disk inserted into the disk drive cant be  
read. Be sure youre using Roland SMF Music Files  
or other music files compatible with Roland digital  
on floppy disk, you need to format the floppy disk  
The floppy disk was removed from the disk drive  
while reading or writing was in progress. Insert the  
floppy disk and repeat the procedure.  
Error 13:  
Error 14:  
This floppy disk or user memory (KR-7) is damaged  
and cannot be used. Insert a different disk and re-  
peat the procedure or format the user memory  
This song or music style cannot be read. Please use  
a Roland SMF Music Files or Roland Digital Piano  
use User Programs that have been saved with the  
Error 15:  
Error 16:  
The KR-7/ 5 cannot read the floppy disk or user  
memory (KR-7) quickly enough. Press the  
[
[
(Play/ Stop)] button, then press the  
(Reset)] button and [ (Play/ Stop)] but-  
ton to play the song.  
1 6 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To n e List (KR-7 )  
SynthBass101  
Jungle Bass  
Modular Bass  
WireStr Bass  
ResoSH Bass  
SH101 Bass  
Mute PickBs.  
Mr.Smooth  
Open Hard  
Dazed Guitar  
Acid Guitar  
Hawaiian Gt.  
Ukulele  
Power Brass  
St. Brass ff  
AltoSax Soft  
English Horn  
EX Tp&Shake  
BrassSection  
Bs Clarinet  
Tenor Sax f  
Brite Brass  
Brass ff  
Natural Lead  
2600 SubOsc  
SquareWave2  
Org Bells  
[Pia n o ]  
[O rg a n ]  
Grand Piano1  
PianoStrings  
Piano Choir  
Tremolo Dyno  
Jazzy Vib+Gt  
Suitcase  
Jazz Organ  
Full Organ 1  
Lower Organ  
Theater Org.  
Diapason 8'  
Bandneon  
Oohs Chord  
Fantasia  
Crystal  
Harpvox  
Vibraphone  
Harpsi.Doubl  
Marimba  
Perc. Organ  
Full Organ 2  
Lower Organ2  
Church Organ  
Rock Organ1  
Blues Harp  
Pop Organ  
L-Organ  
CC Solo  
Vox Sweep  
Brightness  
Syn.Square  
JP8 Square  
FM Lead  
OrchestraBrs  
Grow Sax  
Steel Drums  
Honky-Tonk  
Stage Rhodes  
Ballad Piano  
Wurly  
Baritone Sax  
Alto Sax  
Banjo  
Koto  
EX Trumpet  
Tp Shake  
FM Lead 2  
Mg Lead  
Shamisen  
Dyno Rhodes  
Rock Piano  
Honky-tonk 2  
Clav.  
Trem.Flute  
Accordion  
Tenor Sax  
GS Bari Sax  
SuperF.Horns  
Fr.Horn Solo  
Jump Brass  
Soft Brass  
DeepSynBrass  
Trombone  
Trombone 2  
Tuba  
Dual Sqr&Saw  
P5 Saw Lead  
Rhythmic Saw  
Waspy Synth  
JP8 Pulse  
Cheese Saw  
SynVox  
Nason flt 8'  
Organ Flute  
Jazz Organ2  
Jazz Organ3  
Jazz Organ4  
CheeseOrgan  
Full Organ 3  
Full Organ 4  
Rotary Org.S  
Rotary Org.F  
Rock Organ2  
Pipe Org. Bs  
Organ Bass  
Metalic Org.  
VS Organ  
[Strin g s]  
Velo Strings  
Dolce Strings  
SlowStrings2  
Tremolo Str  
Suspense Str  
EX Orchestra  
Choir Str  
Harpsi.Singl  
Harpsichord  
UprightPiano  
Grand Piano2  
Bell Piano  
Clear Bells  
Soft Crystal  
Digi Bells  
Piano Oohs  
Bright Piano  
E. Grand  
Piccolo  
Nylon Harp  
Nylon+Rhodes  
Fantasia 2  
Soft Pad  
Harp Strings  
Warm Strings  
Violin  
Pan Flute  
MIDI Piano1  
E.Piano 1  
GS Pan Flute  
Blow Pipe  
Bottle Blow  
BottleBlow2  
Bassoon  
Slow Strings  
Cello  
St.FM EP  
P5 Poly  
FM+SA EP  
Hard FM EP  
Harpsi.o  
Reso Saw  
RAVE Vox  
Fat & Perky  
Heaven II  
St. Harp  
DecayStrings  
Legato Str  
Strings  
Organ 1  
Recorder  
Coupled Hps.  
Soft Marimba  
EG+Rhodes 1  
EG+Rhodes 2  
Hard Rhodes  
Vibra Bells  
Celesta  
Organ 2  
Trumpet  
Digi Church  
French Horn  
Synth Brass1  
Synth Brass2  
Shakuhachi  
Brass 1  
JP8 Sqr Pad  
Sweep Pad 2  
Big Panner  
Ai-yai-a  
Oct Strings  
PizzicatoStr  
Mellow Pizz.  
Bell Strings  
Orchestra  
OrchestraHit  
Warm JP Str  
Slow Violin  
Contrabass  
Timpani  
[Gu ita r / Ba ss]  
Echo Pan 2  
Falling Down  
Poly King  
EX Ac.Guitar  
Flamenco Gtr  
Steel Guitar  
Jazz Guitar  
Requint Gtr  
12str Guitar  
Nylon+Steel  
Nylon Guitar  
Mandolin  
Brass 2  
Glockenspiel  
Soft E.Piano  
60's E.Piano  
E.Piano 2  
Ocarina  
Octave Stack  
Warm Pad  
Rising Osc  
RandomEnding  
Piano 1  
[Vo ice ]  
Xylophone  
Music Box  
Balafon  
Syn.Strings1  
Syn.Strings2  
Syn.Slow Str  
Strings 2  
Boys Choir  
Kid’s Choir  
Piano 1w  
Jazz Scat  
Detuned EP 1  
Detuned EP 2  
Hard E.Piano  
Hard Clav.  
Soft Clav.  
Piano 1d  
Gut Guitar  
Rich Choir  
Piano 2  
Acoustic Bs.  
A.Bass+Cymbl  
JC E.Guitar  
DistortionGt  
Rock Rhythm  
Rock Rhythm2  
Overdrive Gt  
Power Guitar  
Power Gt.2  
Muted Dis.Gt  
Fingered Bs.  
Picked Bs.  
JP Saw Str  
OB Strings  
Euro Hit  
Holy Voices  
Jz Scat Vib  
Opera Voice  
Jz Scat Doet  
Humming  
Piano 2w  
Piano 3  
Piano 3w  
6th Hit  
Reso Clav.  
Phase Clav.  
Pop Vibe.  
GS Honkytonk  
Honky-tonk 2  
GS E.Piano1  
GS E.Piano2  
60's E.Piano  
E.Piano 1v  
E.Piano 2v  
Detuned EP 1  
Detuned EP 2  
GS Harpsi  
Coupled Hps.  
Harpsi.w  
Bass Hit  
Philly Hit  
Dreamy Choir  
Doos Voice  
Doot Accent  
Dat Accent  
Bop Accent  
Thum Voice  
HollowReleas  
Choir Oohs  
VoiceAah Fem  
Choir Aahs  
Warm SqrPad  
New Age Pad  
Sugar Key  
Pop Celesta  
Tubular-bell  
Santur  
[Sa x / Bra ss]  
Kalimba  
Super Tenor  
EX Tenor Sax  
Sax Section  
Romantic Tp  
TromboneSoft  
AltoSax + Tp  
Flute  
Air Grand  
Piano 1  
Fretless Bs.  
Slap Bass  
Piano 2  
Piano 3  
Steel Vox  
Muted Gt.  
Harpsi.o  
Muted Gt.2  
Mellow Gt.  
Soprano Sax  
Clarinet  
Soft Clav.  
Celesta  
5th Dist.  
LM PureLead  
LM Square  
JP SuperSaw  
MutedTrumpet  
Oboe  
Glockenspiel  
Music Box  
Viberaphone  
Feedback Gt2  
Synth Bass 1  
Synth Bass 2  
Flugel Horn  
1 7 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To n e List (KR-7 )  
Vibe.w  
Choir  
Taisho Koto  
Kalimba  
Marimba*  
Ocarina*  
GS Marimba  
Marimba  
Pop Voice  
SynVox  
Xylophone*  
Tubularbell*  
Santur*  
Square Wave*  
Saw Wave*  
Doctor Solo*  
SynCalliope*  
ChifferLead*  
Charang*  
Bagpipe  
Xylophone  
Tubular-bell  
Church Bell  
Carillon  
OrchestraHit  
GS Trumpet  
Trombone  
Trombone 2  
Tuba  
Fiddle  
Shanai  
Organ 1*  
Tinkle Bell  
Agogo  
Organ 2*  
Pop Organ 1*  
Rock Organ2*  
ChurchOrg.1*  
Reed Organ*  
AccordionFr*  
Harmonica*  
Bandoneon*  
Nylon-strGt*  
Steel-strGt*  
Jazz Guitar*  
Clean Gt.*  
Muted Gt.*  
Funk Gt.*  
Santur  
Steel Drums  
Woodblock  
Castanets  
Taiko  
Solo Vox*  
5th SawWave*  
Bass & Lead*  
Fantasia*  
Organ 1  
MutedTrumpet  
French Horn  
Fr.Horn 2  
Brass 1  
Organ 2  
Pop Organ  
Detuned Or.1  
Detuned Or.2  
Church Org.1  
Church Org.2  
Church Org.3  
Full Organ 4  
Jazz Organ  
Rock Organ 2  
Reed Organ  
Accordion Fr  
Accordion It  
GS Harmonica  
Bandoneon  
GS Nylon Gt.  
Nylon Guitar  
Nylon Gt.o  
Ukulele  
Concert BD  
Melo. Tom 1  
Melo. Tom 2  
Synth Drum  
808 Tom  
Elec Perc.  
Reverse Cym.  
Gt.FretNoise  
Gt.Cut Noise  
String Slap  
Breath Noise  
Fl.Key Click  
Seashore  
Rain  
Warm Pad*  
Polysynth*  
Space Voice*  
Bowed Glass*  
Metal Pad*  
Halo Pad*  
Sweep Pad*  
Ice Rain*  
Brass 2  
Synth Brass1  
Synth Brass2  
Synth Brass3  
Synth Brass4  
AnalogBrass1  
AnalogBrass2  
GS Sop.Sax  
Alto Sax  
OverdriveGt*  
Dist.Guitar*  
Gt.Harmo*  
Acoustic Bs*  
Fingered Bs*  
Picked Bs.*  
Fretless Bs*  
Slap Bass 1*  
Slap Bass 2*  
SynthBass 1*  
SynthBass 2*  
Rubber Bass*  
Violin*  
Soundtrack*  
Crystal*  
Tenor Sax  
GS Bari Sax  
GS Oboe  
English Horn  
Bassoon  
Syn Mallet*  
Atmosphere*  
Brightness*  
Goblin*  
Thunder  
Echo Drops*  
Star Theme*  
Sitar*  
Clarinet  
Wind  
Piccolo  
Stream  
Steel-str.Gt  
12-str.Gt  
GS Flute  
Bubble  
Banjo*  
Recorder  
Bird  
Shamisen*  
Koto*  
Mandolin  
GS Pan Flute  
Bottle Blow  
Shakuhachi  
Whistle  
Dog  
Jazz Guitar  
Hawaiian  
Horse-Gallop  
Bird 2  
Kalimba*  
Viola*  
Bagpipe*  
Clean Gt.  
Telephone 1  
Telephone 2  
DoorCreaking  
Door  
Cello*  
Fiddle*  
Chorus Gt.  
Muted Gt.  
Ocarina  
Contrabass*  
Tremolo Str*  
Pizzicato*  
Harp*  
Shanai*  
Square Wave  
Square  
Tinkle Bell*  
Agogo*  
Funk Gt.  
Funk Gt.2  
Sine Wave  
Saw Wave  
Saw  
Scratch  
Steel Drums*  
Woodblock*  
Taiko*  
Overdrive Gt  
DistortionGt  
Feedback Gt.  
Gt.Harmonics  
Gt.Feedback  
GS Ac.Bass  
GS Fing.Bass  
Picked Bs  
Windchime  
Helicopter  
Car-Engine  
Car-Stop  
Car-Pass  
Car-Crash  
Siren  
Timpani*  
Strings*  
Doctor Solo  
Syn.Calliope  
Chiffer Lead  
Charang  
SlowStrings*  
Syn.Str 1*  
Syn.Str 2*  
Choir Aahs*  
Pop Voice*  
SynVox*  
Melo.Tom 1*  
Synth Drum*  
ReverseCym.*  
Fret Noise*  
BreathNoise*  
Seashore*  
Bird*  
Solo Vox  
5th Saw Wave  
Bass & Lead  
Fantasia  
Train  
Fretless Bs.  
Slap Bass  
Slap Bass 2  
SynthBass101  
Synth Bass 1  
Synth Bass 2  
Synth Bass 3  
Synth Bass 4  
Rubber Bass  
Violin  
Jetplane  
Orche.Hit*  
Trumpet*  
Starship  
Telephone 1*  
Helicopter*  
Applause*  
Gun Shot*  
Warm Pad  
Polysynth  
Space Voice  
Bowed Glass  
Metal Pad  
Halo Pad  
Burst Noise  
Applause  
Laughing  
Screaming  
Punch  
Trombone*  
Tuba*  
M.Trumpet*  
FrenchHorns*  
Brass 1*  
*
Tone with a “*”  
Heart Beat  
Footsteps  
Gun Shot  
Machine Gun  
Lasergun  
Explosion  
Piano 1*  
SynthBrass1*  
SynthBrass2*  
A.Brass 1*  
Soprano Sax*  
Alto Sax*  
symbol appended to  
their name may not  
play back  
Sweep Pad  
Ice Rain  
Slow Violin  
Viola  
Soundtrack  
Crystal  
satisfactorily on  
other GS sound  
generating devices.  
Cello  
Syn Mallet  
Atmosphere  
Brightness  
Goblin  
Tenor Sax*  
BaritoneSax*  
Oboe*  
Contrabass  
Trem. Str  
Piano 2*  
PizzicatoStr  
GS Harp  
Piano 3*  
EnglishHorn*  
Bassoon*  
Echo Drops  
Echo Bell  
Echo Pan  
Star Theme  
Sitar  
Honky-tonk*  
E.Piano 1*  
E.Piano 2*  
Harpsichord*  
Clav.*  
Timpani  
Clarinet*  
GS Strings  
Orchestra  
Piccolo*  
Flute*  
GS Sl.Str  
Recorder*  
Pan Flute*  
Bottle Blow*  
Shakuhachi*  
Whistle*  
Syn.Strings1  
Syn.Strings2  
Syn.Strings3  
Choir Aahs  
Sitar 2  
Celesta*  
Banjo  
Glocken*  
Music Box*  
Vibraphone*  
Shamisen  
Koto  
1 7 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To n e List (KR-5 )  
Mute PickBs.  
Mr.Smooth  
Open Hard  
Dazed Guitar  
Acid Guitar  
Ukulele  
Synth Brass3  
Trombone2  
Piccolo  
Heaven II  
[Pia n o ]  
[O rg a n ]  
JP8 Sqr Pad  
Sweep Pad 2  
Big Panner  
Ai-yai-a  
Grand Piano1  
PianoStrings  
Piano Choir  
Dyno Rhodes  
Harpsichord  
Suitcase  
Jazz Organ  
Full Organ 1  
Lower Organ  
Theater Org.  
Nason flt 8'  
Bandneon  
Pan Flute  
GS Pan Flute  
Blow Pipe  
Bottle Blow  
Bassoon  
Echo Pan 2  
Falling Down  
Poly King  
Koto  
Shamisen  
Vibraphone  
Harpsi.Doubl  
Marimba  
Organ Flute  
Jazz Organ2  
Full Organ 2  
Full Organ 3  
Lower Organ2  
Church Organ  
Rock Organ1  
Harmonica  
Pop Organ  
Accordion  
Recorder  
Warm Pad  
RandomEnding  
Piano 1  
French Horn  
Synth Brass1  
Synth Brass2  
Oct SynBrass  
Shakuhachi  
Brass 1  
[Strin g s]  
Steel Drums  
Honky-tonk 2  
Stage Rhodes  
Ballad Piano  
Tremolo Dyno  
Jazzy Vib+Gt  
Wurly  
Piano 1w  
Strings  
Piano 1d  
Slow Strings  
Choir Str  
Piano 2  
Piano 2w  
Harp Strings  
Trem. Str  
Brass 2  
Piano 3  
Ocarina  
Piano 3w  
Violin  
GS Honkytonk  
Honky-tonk 2  
GS E.Piano1  
GS E.Piano2  
60's E.Piano  
E.Piano 1v  
E.Piano 2v  
Detuned EP 1  
Detuned EP 2  
GS Harpsi  
Coupled Hps.  
Harpsi.w  
Cello  
Rock Piano  
Clav.  
Trem.Flute  
Jazz Organ3  
Jazz Organ4  
Full Organ 4  
Rotary Org.S  
Rotary Org.F  
Rock Organ2  
Pipe Org. Bs  
Organ Bass  
Metalic Org.  
VS Organ  
Warm Strings  
DecayStrings  
Orchestra  
Oct Strings  
St. Harp  
[Vo ice ]  
Honky-Tonk  
Bright Piano  
Harpsi.Singl  
UprightPiano  
Grand Piano2  
Bell Piano  
Jazz Scat  
Dreamy Choir  
Boys Choir  
Holy Voices  
HollowReleas  
Rich Choir  
Dat Accent  
Bop Accent  
Thum Voice  
Pop Voice  
Org Bells  
Velo Strings  
Legato Str  
PizzicatoStr  
SlowStrings2  
Bell Strings  
OrchestraHit  
Warm JP Str  
Slow Violin  
Contrabass  
Timpani  
Piano Oohs  
E. Grand  
MIDI Piano1  
E.Piano 1  
Organ 1  
Harpsi.o  
FM+SA EP  
St.FM EP  
Organ 2  
Soft Clav.  
Digi Church  
Celesta  
Humming  
Hard FM EP  
Soft Marimba  
EG+Rhodes 1  
EG+Rhodes 2  
Hard Rhodes  
Harpsi.o  
Glockenspiel  
Music Box  
Viberaphone  
Vibe.w  
Doos Voice  
Choir Oohs  
Choir Aahs  
Warm SqrPad  
New Age Pad  
LM PureLead  
LM Square  
Natural Lead  
2600 SubOsc  
SquareWave2  
Fantasia  
Syn.Strings1  
Syn.Strings2  
Strings 2  
[Gu ita r / Ba ss]  
Steel Guitar  
Nylon Guitar  
Jazz Guitar  
Nylon+Steel  
12str Guitar  
Nylon Gt.o  
GS Marimba  
Marimba  
OB Strings  
Euro Hit  
Coupled Hps.  
Vibra Bells  
Celesta  
Xylophone  
Tubular-bell  
Church Bell  
Carillon  
6th Hit  
Bass Hit  
Glockenspiel  
Soft E.Piano  
60's E.Piano  
E.Piano 2  
Hawaiian Gt.  
Banjo  
Santur  
[Sa x / Bra ss]  
Organ 1  
JC E.Guitar  
Muted Gt.  
Crystal  
EX Tenor Sax  
Soprano Sax  
Flute  
Organ 2  
Harpvox  
E.Piano 3  
Pop Organ  
Detuned Or.1  
Detuned Or.2  
Church Org.1  
Church Org.2  
Church Org.3  
Full Organ 4  
Jazz Organ  
Rock Organ 2  
Reed Organ  
Accordion Fr  
Accordion It  
GS Harmonica  
Bandoneon  
GS Nylon Gt.  
Nylon Guitar  
Nylon Gt.o  
Ukulele  
Acoustic Bs.  
A.Bass+Cymbl  
DistortionGt  
Steel Vox  
CC Solo  
Xylophone  
Music Box  
Balafon  
Brightness  
Syn.Square  
JP8 Square  
FM Lead  
Trumpet  
MutedTrumpet  
AltoSax + Tp  
Oboe  
Detuned EP 1  
Detuned EP 2  
Hard E.Piano  
Hard Clav.  
Soft Clav.  
Rock Rhythm  
Rock Rhythm2  
Overdrive Gt  
Power Guitar  
Power Gt.2  
Muted Dis.Gt  
Fingered Bs.  
Picked Bs.  
FM Lead 2  
Mg Lead  
Clarinet  
TromboneSoft  
Soft Brass  
Baritone Sax  
Tuba  
Dual Sqr&Saw  
P5 Saw Lead  
Rhythmic Saw  
Waspy Synth  
JP8 Pulse  
Reso Clav.  
Phase Clav.  
Pop Vibe.  
Romantic Tp  
Power Brass  
St. Brass ff  
English Horn  
BrassSection  
Blow Sax  
Pop Celesta  
Tubular-bell  
Santur  
Fretless Bs.  
Slap Bass  
Cheese Saw  
SynVox  
Muted Gt.2  
Mellow Gt.  
Clear Bells  
Soft Crystal  
Digi Bells  
Kalimba  
Air Grand  
5th Dist.  
Piano 1  
Brite Brass  
Brass ff  
Feedback Gt2  
Synth Bass 1  
Synth Bass 2  
SynthBass101  
Jungle Bass  
Modular Bass  
WireStr Bass  
ResoSH Bass  
SH101 Bass  
Nylon Harp  
Nylon+Rhodes  
Fantasia 2  
Soft Pad  
Piano 2  
Steel-str.Gt  
12-str.Gt  
Piano 3  
EX Trumpet  
Grow Sax  
Alto Sax  
Mandolin  
Jazz Guitar  
Hawaiian  
P5 Poly  
Tenor Sax  
GS Bari Sax  
Flugel Horn  
Fr.Horn Solo  
Reso Saw  
RAVE Vox  
Fat & Perky  
Clean Gt.  
Chorus Gt.  
Muted Gt.  
1 7 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To n e List (KR-5 )  
Funk Gt.  
Square  
Door  
Pizzicato*  
Harp*  
Agogo*  
Funk Gt.2  
Sine Wave  
Saw Wave  
Saw  
Scratch  
Steel Drums*  
Woodblock*  
Taiko*  
Overdrive Gt  
DistortionGt  
Feedback Gt.  
Gt.Harmonics  
Gt.Feedback  
GS Ac.Bass  
GS Fing.Bass  
Picked Bs  
Fretless Bs.  
Slap Bass  
Slap Bass 2  
SynthBass101  
Synth Bass 1  
Synth Bass 2  
Synth Bass 3  
Synth Bass 4  
Rubber Bass  
Violin  
Windchime  
Helicopter  
Car-Engine  
Car-Stop  
Timpani*  
Strings*  
Doctor Solo  
Syn.Calliope  
Chiffer Lead  
Charang  
SlowStrings*  
Syn.Str 1*  
Syn.Str 2*  
Choir Aahs*  
Pop Voice*  
SynVox*  
Melo.Tom 1*  
Synth Drum*  
ReverseCym.*  
Fret Noise*  
BreathNoise*  
Seashore*  
Bird*  
Car-Pass  
Car-Crash  
Siren  
Solo Vox  
5th Saw Wave  
Bass & Lead  
Fantasia  
Train  
Jetplane  
Orche.Hit*  
Trumpet*  
Starship  
Telephone 1*  
Helicopter*  
Applause*  
Gun Shot*  
Warm Pad  
Polysynth  
Space Voice  
Bowed Glass  
Metal Pad  
Halo Pad  
Sweep Pad  
Ice Rain  
Burst Noise  
Applause  
Trombone*  
Tuba*  
Laughing  
M.Trumpet*  
FrenchHorns*  
Brass 1*  
Screaming  
Punch  
*
Tone with a “*”  
Heart Beat  
Footsteps  
Gun Shot  
Machine Gun  
Lasergun  
SynthBrass1*  
SynthBrass2*  
A.Brass 1*  
Soprano Sax*  
Alto Sax*  
symbol appended to  
their name may not  
play back  
Slow Violin  
Viola  
Soundtrack  
Crystal  
satisfactorily on  
other GS sound  
generating devices.  
Cello  
Syn Mallet  
Atmosphere  
Brightness  
Goblin  
Explosion  
Piano 1*  
Tenor Sax*  
BaritoneSax*  
Oboe*  
Contrabass  
Trem. Str  
Piano 2*  
PizzicatoStr  
GS Harp  
Piano 3*  
EnglishHorn*  
Bassoon*  
Clarinet*  
Echo Drops  
Echo Bell  
Echo Pan  
Star Theme  
Sitar  
Honky-tonk*  
E.Piano 1*  
E.Piano 2*  
Harpsichord*  
Clav.*  
Timpani  
GS Strings  
Orchestra  
Piccolo*  
Flute*  
GS Sl.Str  
Recorder*  
Pan Flute*  
Bottle Blow*  
Shakuhachi*  
Whistle*  
Syn.Strings1  
Syn.Strings2  
Syn.Strings3  
Choir Aahs  
Choir  
Sitar 2  
Celesta*  
Banjo  
Glocken*  
Shamisen  
Koto  
Music Box*  
Vibraphone  
Marimba*  
Xylophone*  
Tubularbell*  
Santur*  
Taisho Koto  
Kalimba  
Ocarina*  
Pop Voice  
SynVox  
Square Wave*  
Saw Wave*  
Doctor Solo*  
SynCalliope*  
ChifferLead*  
Charang*  
Bagpipe  
OrchestraHit  
GS Trumpet  
Trombone  
Trombone 2  
Tuba  
Fiddle  
Shanai  
Organ 1*  
Tinkle Bell  
Agogo  
Organ 2*  
Pop Organ 1*  
Rock Organ2*  
ChurchOrg.1*  
Reed Organ*  
AccordionFr*  
Harmonica*  
Bandoneon*  
Nylon-strGt*  
Steel-strGt*  
Jazz Guitar*  
Clean Gt.*  
Muted Gt.*  
Funk Gt.*  
OverdriveGt*  
Dist.Guitar*  
Gt.Harmo*  
Acoustic Bs*  
Fingered Bs*  
Picked Bs.*  
Fretless Bs*  
Slap Bass 1*  
Slap Bass 2*  
SynthBass 1*  
SynthBass 2*  
Rubber Bass*  
Violin*  
Steel Drums  
Woodblock  
Castanets  
Taiko  
Solo Vox*  
5th SawWave*  
Bass & Lead*  
Fantasia*  
MutedTrumpet  
French Horn  
Fr.Horn 2  
Brass 1  
Concert BD  
Melo. Tom 1  
Melo. Tom 2  
Synth Drum  
808 Tom  
Elec Perc.  
Reverse Cym.  
Gt.FretNoise  
Gt.Cut Noise  
String Slap  
Breath Noise  
Fl.Key Click  
Seashore  
Rain  
Warm Pad*  
Polysynth*  
Space Voice*  
Bowed Glass*  
Metal Pad*  
Halo Pad*  
Sweep Pad*  
Ice Rain*  
Brass 2  
Synth Brass1  
Synth Brass2  
Synth Brass3  
Synth Brass4  
AnalogBrass1  
AnalogBrass2  
GS Sop.Sax  
Alto Sax  
Soundtrack*  
Crystal*  
Tenor Sax  
GS Bari Sax  
GS Oboe  
Syn Mallet*  
Atmosphere*  
Brightness*  
Goblin*  
English Horn  
Bassoon  
Thunder  
Echo Drops*  
Star Theme*  
Sitar*  
Clarinet  
Wind  
Piccolo  
Stream  
GS Flute  
Bubble  
Banjo*  
Recorder  
Bird  
Shamisen*  
Koto*  
GS Pan Flute  
Bottle Blow  
Shakuhachi  
Whistle  
Dog  
Horse-Gallop  
Bird 2  
Kalimba*  
Viola*  
Bagpipe*  
Telephone 1  
Telephone 2  
DoorCreaking  
Cello*  
Fiddle*  
Ocarina  
Contrabass*  
Tremolo Str*  
Shanai*  
Square Wave  
Tinkle Bell*  
1 7 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dru m Se t List  
*
*
-----: No sound.  
[EXC]: will not sound simultaneously with other percussion instruments of the same number.  
POP Set  
ROCK Set  
JAZZ BRUSH Set  
VOX DRUM Set (KR-7)  
21  
23  
24  
26  
28  
29  
31  
33  
35  
36  
38  
40  
41  
43  
45  
47  
R&B Snare  
R&B Snare  
R&B Snare  
R&B Snare  
22  
Rock Snare  
Rock Snare  
Pop Snare m  
Pop Snare Ghost  
Pop Snare m  
Finger Snap  
707 Claps  
Hand Clap  
Hand Clap2  
Hand Clap  
Pop Pedal HH  
Gospel Hand Clap  
Snare Roll  
Pop Kick  
Pop Kick  
Pop Side Stick  
Pop Sanre s  
Pop Snare Ghost  
Pop Snare s  
Pop Low Tom f  
Pop CHH 1  
Pop Low Tom  
Pop CHH 2  
Pop Mid Tom f  
Pop OHH  
Pop Snare m  
Pop Snare m  
Pop Snare m  
Pop Snare Ghost  
Pop Snare m  
Finger Snap  
707 Claps  
Hand Clap  
Hand Clap2  
Hand Clap  
Pop Pedal HH  
Gospel Hand Clap  
Snare Roll  
Rock Kick  
Rock Kick  
Rock Side Stick  
Rock Sanre s  
Rock Snare Ghost  
Rock Snare s  
Rock Low Tom f  
Rock CHH 1  
Rock Low Tom  
Rock CHH 2  
Rock Mid Tom f  
Rock OHH  
Rock Mid Tom  
Rock High Tom f  
Rock Crash Cymbal  
Rock High Tom  
Rock Ride Cymbal 1  
Pop Chinees Cymbal  
Pop Ride Bell  
Tambourine 2  
Splash Cymbal  
Cha Cha Cowbell  
Chinees Cymbal  
Vibra-slap 2  
Pop Ride Cymbal 3  
High Bongo 2  
Low Bongo 2  
Mute Conga  
High Conga 2  
Low Conga 2  
High Timbale 2  
Low Timbale 2  
High Agogo  
Pop Snare m  
Pop Snare m  
Pop Snare m  
Pop Snare Ghost  
Pop Snare m  
Finger Snap  
707 Claps  
Hand Clap  
Hand Clap2  
Hand Clap  
Pop Pedal HH  
Gospel Hand Clap  
Snare Roll  
Pop Kick  
Pop Kick  
Jazz Snare Swing  
Jazz Sanre  
Pop Snare Swing  
Jazz Sanre  
Jazz Low Tom f  
Pop CHH 1  
Jazz Low Tom  
Pop CHH 2  
Jazz Mid Tom f  
Pop OHH  
Jazz Mid Tom  
Jazz High Tom f  
Jazz Crash Cymbal 1  
Jazz High Tom  
Jazz Ride Cymbal 1  
Jazz Chinees Cymbal  
Jazz Ride Cymbal 2  
Tambourine 2  
Splash Cymbal  
Cha Cha Cowbell  
Jazz Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap 2  
Pop Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo 2  
Low Bongo 2  
Mute Conga  
High Conga 2  
Rock Snare  
Rock Snare  
Pop Snare m  
Pop Snare Ghost  
Pop Snare m  
Finger Snap  
707 Claps  
Hand Clap  
Hand Clap2  
Hand Clap  
Pop Pedal HH  
Gospel Hand Clap  
Vox Dut  
25  
27  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
30  
32  
34  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
Vox Dom  
Vox Tuush  
Vox Hehho  
Vox Doyear  
Vox Thu!  
Vox That  
Vox Aahhh  
Vox Tu  
Vox Dooh  
Vox Ptu  
Vox Down  
Vox Pa  
Vox Bom  
C2  
37  
39  
42  
44  
46  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
Pop Mid Tom  
Pop High Tom f  
Vox Toear  
Vox Aahhu  
Vox Toya  
C3 48  
50  
49  
51  
Pop Crash Cymbal 1  
Pop High Tom  
Pop Ride Cymbal 1  
Pop Chinees Cymbal  
Pop Ride Bell  
Tambourine 2  
Splash Cymbal  
Cha Cha Cowbell  
Pop Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap 2  
Pop Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo 2  
Low Bongo 2  
Mute Conga  
High Conga 2  
Low Conga 2  
Vox Thu  
52  
Vox Cheey  
Vox Cymm  
Vox Tub  
Vox Pruru  
Vox Tut  
53  
54  
56  
58  
55  
57  
Vox Tyun  
Vox Tdum  
Vox Afahhhh  
High Bongo 2  
Low Bongo 2  
Mute Conga  
High Conga 2  
Low Conga 2  
High Timbale 2  
Low Timbale 2  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Shaker 3  
59  
C4 60  
62  
61  
63  
64  
Low Conga 2  
High Timbale 2  
Low Timbale 2  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Shaker 3  
High Timbale 2  
Low Timbale 2  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Shaker 3  
65  
66  
68  
70  
67  
Low Agogo  
Shaker 3  
Shaker 4  
Short Hi Whistle  
69  
Shaker 4  
Short Hi Whistle  
Shaker 4  
Short Hi Whistle  
Shaker 4  
Short Hi Whistle  
71  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
C5 72  
74  
73  
75  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
76  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
77  
78  
80  
82  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
79  
81  
83  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
C6 84  
86  
85  
87  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
Cana  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
Cana  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
Cana  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
Cana  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
88  
Falamenco Hi-Timbale  
Falamenco Lo-Timbale  
Falamenco Tmbl Flam  
Shekere 1  
Falamenco Hi-Timbale  
Falamenco Lo-Timbale  
Falamenco Tmbl Flam  
Shekere 1  
Falamenco Hi-Timbale  
Falamenco Lo-Timbale  
Falamenco Tmbl Flam  
Shekere 1  
Falamenco Hi-Timbale  
Falamenco Lo-Timbale  
Falamenco Tmbl Flam  
Shekere 1  
89  
90  
92  
94  
91  
93  
Shekere 2  
Shekere 2  
Shekere 2  
Shekere 2  
Low Bongo Mute  
High Bongo Mute  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Low Bongo Mute  
High Bongo Mute  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Low Bongo Mute  
High Bongo Mute  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Low Bongo Mute  
High Bongo Mute  
-----  
-----  
-----  
95  
96  
98  
C7  
97  
99  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
100  
101  
Falamenco HC  
Falamenco HC  
Bongo Cowbell  
-----  
Bongo Cowbell  
-----  
Falamenco HC  
Falamenco HC  
Bongo Cowbell  
-----  
Bongo Cowbell  
-----  
Falamenco HC  
Falamenco HC  
Bongo Cowbell  
-----  
Bongo Cowbell  
-----  
Falamenco HC  
Falamenco HC  
Bongo Cowbell  
-----  
Bongo Cowbell  
-----  
102  
104  
103  
105  
1 7 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Dru m Se t List  
*
*
-----: No sound.  
[EXC]: will not sound simultaneously with other percussion instruments of the same number.  
STANDARD Set  
ROOM Set  
POWER Set  
ELECTORONIC Set  
21  
23  
24  
26  
28  
29  
31  
33  
35  
36  
38  
40  
41  
43  
45  
47  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
22  
25  
27  
Slap  
Slap  
Slap  
Slap  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Std Kick 2’  
Kick 1  
Side Stick  
Std Snr 1  
Hand Clap  
Std Snr 2  
Low Tom 2  
Closed Hi-hat 1’  
Low Tom 1  
Pedal Hi-hat 1’  
Mid Tom 2  
Open Hi-hat 1’  
Mid Tom 1  
High Tom 2  
Crash Cymbal 1  
High Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Kick1  
Room Kick  
Side Stick  
Room Snr 1  
Hand Clap  
Std Snr 1  
Room Low Tom 2’  
Closed Hi-hat 1’  
Room Low Tom 1’  
Pedal Hi-hat 1’  
Room Mid Tom 2’  
Open Hi-hat 1’  
Room Mid Tom 1’  
Room Hi Tom 2’  
Crash Cymbal 1  
Room Hi Tom 1’  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Std Kick 2  
MONDO Kick  
Side Stick  
Gated SD  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Std Kick 2  
Elec BD  
Side Stick  
Elec SD  
Hand Clap  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
30  
32  
34  
C2  
37  
39  
Hand Clap  
Snare Drum 2  
Room Low Tom 2  
Closed Hi-hat 1  
Room Low Tom 1  
Pedal Hi-hat 1  
Room Mid Tom 2  
Open Hi-hat 1  
Room Mid Tom 1  
Room Hi Tom 2  
Crash Cymbal 1  
Room Hi Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
Gated SD  
Elec Low Tom 2  
Closed Hi-hat 1  
Elec Low Tom 1  
Pedal Hi-hat 1  
Elec Mid Tom 2  
Open Hi-hat 1  
Elec Mid Tom 1  
Elec Hi Tom 2  
Crash Cymbal 1  
Elec Hi Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Reverse Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
42  
44  
46  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
C3 48  
50  
49  
51  
52  
53  
54  
56  
58  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
55  
57  
59  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
C4 60  
62  
61  
63  
64  
65  
66  
68  
70  
67  
69  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
71  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
C5 72  
74  
73  
75  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
76  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
77  
78  
80  
82  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
79  
81  
83  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
C6 84  
86  
85  
87  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
88  
1 7 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dru m Se t List  
*
*
-----: No sound.  
[EXC]: will not sound simultaneously with other percussion instruments of the same number.  
JAZZ  
GS STANDARD Set  
TR-808 Set  
DANCE Set  
BRUSH Set  
21  
23  
24  
26  
28  
29  
31  
33  
35  
36  
38  
40  
41  
43  
45  
47  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
22  
25  
27  
Slap  
Slap  
Slap  
Slap  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Std Kick 2  
808 Bass Drum 1  
808 Rim Shot  
808 Snare Drum  
Hand Clap  
Snare Drum 2  
808 Low Tom 2  
808 CHH  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Dance Snr 1  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Kick 1  
808 Bass Drum 2  
808 Rim Shot  
TR-909 Snr  
Hand Clap  
Dance Snr 2  
808 Low Tom 2  
808 CHH [EXC1]  
808 Low Tom 1  
808 CHH [EXC1]  
808 Mid Tom 2  
808 OHH [EXC1]  
808 Mid Tom 1  
808 Hi Tom 2  
808 Cymbal  
808 Hi Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
808 Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
808 High Conga  
808 Mid Conga  
808 Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Std Kick 2  
Std Kick 1  
Side Stick  
Snare Drum 1  
Hand Clap  
Snare Drum 2  
Low Tom 2  
Closed Hi-hat 1  
Low Tom 1  
Pedal Hi-hat 1  
Mid Tom 2  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Kick 2  
Kick 1  
Side Stick  
Brush Tap  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
30  
32  
34  
C2  
37  
39  
Brush Slap  
Brush Swirl  
Brush Low Tom 2  
Closed Hi-hat 2  
Brush Low Tom 1  
Pedal Hi-hat 2  
Brush Mid Tom 2  
Open Hi-hat 2  
Brush Mid Tom 1  
Brush Hi Tom 2  
Crash Cymbal 1  
Brush Hi Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
42  
44  
46  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
808 Low Tom 1  
808 CHH  
808 Mid Tom 2  
808 OHH [EXC1]  
808 Mid Tom 1  
808 Hi Tom 2  
808 Cymbal  
808 Hi Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
808 Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
808 High Conga  
808 Mid Conga  
808 Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
Open Hi-hat 1  
Mid Tom 1  
High Tom 2  
Crash Cymbal 1  
High Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
C3 48  
50  
49  
51  
52  
53  
54  
56  
58  
55  
57  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
59  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
C4 60  
62  
61  
63  
64  
65  
66  
68  
70  
67  
69  
Cabasa  
808 Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
808 Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
71  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
C5 72  
74  
73  
75  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
808 Claves  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
808 Claves  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
76  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
77  
78  
80  
82  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
79  
81  
83  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
C6 84  
86  
85  
87  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
88  
1 7 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dru m Se t List  
*
*
-----: No sound.  
[EXC]: will not sound simultaneously with other percussion instruments of the same number.  
ORCHESTRA Set  
GS ROOM Set  
GS BRUSH Set  
21  
23  
24  
26  
28  
29  
31  
33  
35  
36  
38  
40  
41  
43  
45  
47  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
High Q  
Slap  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Std Kick 2  
22  
Bar Chime  
Snare Roll  
Finger Snap  
Close Hi-hat  
Pedal Hi-hat  
Open Hi-hat  
Ride Cymbal  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Concert BD 2  
Concert BD 1  
Side Stick  
Concert SD  
Castanets  
Concert SD  
Timpani F  
Timpani F#  
Timpani G  
Timpani G#  
Timpani A  
25  
27  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
Slap  
Scratch Push  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Std Kick 2  
Std Kick 1  
Side Stick  
Snare Drum 1  
Hand Clap  
Snare Drum 2  
Room Low Tom 2  
Closed Hi-hat 1  
Room Low Tom 1  
Pedal Hi-hat 1  
Room Mid Tom 2  
Open Hi-hat 1  
Room Mid Tom 1  
Room Hi Tom 2  
Crash Cymbal 1  
Room Hi Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
30  
32  
34  
Std Kick 1  
Side Stick  
Brush Tap  
C2  
37  
39  
Brush Slap  
Brush Swirl  
Low Tom 2  
Closed Hi-hat 1  
Low Tom 1  
Pedal Hi-hat 1  
Mid Tom 2  
Open Hi-hat 1  
Mid Tom 1  
High Tom 2  
Crash Cymbal 1  
High Tom 1  
Ride Cymbal 1  
Chinese Cymbal  
Ride Bell  
42  
44  
46  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
[EXC1]  
Timpani A#  
Timpani B  
Timpani c  
Timpani c#  
Timpani d  
Timpani d#  
Timpani e  
C3 48  
50  
49  
51  
52  
Timpani f  
53  
54  
56  
58  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
Concert Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
Tambourine  
Splash Cymbal  
Cowbell  
Crash Cymbal 2  
Vibra-slap  
55  
57  
59  
Concert Cymbal 1  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
Ride Cymbal 2  
High Bongo  
Low Bongo  
Mute High Conga  
Open High Conga  
Low Conga  
High Timbale  
Low Timbale  
High Agogo  
Low Agogo  
Cabasa  
C4 60  
62  
61  
63  
64  
65  
66  
68  
70  
67  
69  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
Maracas  
Short Hi Whistle  
71  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
[EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
Long Low Whistle [EXC2]  
C5 72  
74  
73  
75  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
Short Guiro  
Long Guiro  
Claves  
[EXC3]  
[EXC3]  
76  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
High Wood Block  
Low Wood Block  
Mute Cuica  
Open Cuica  
Mute Triangle  
Open Triangle  
Shaker  
77  
78  
80  
82  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC4]  
[EXC5]  
[EXC5]  
79  
81  
83  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
Jingle Bell  
Bell Tree  
Castanets  
C6 84  
86  
85  
87  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
Applause  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
Mute Surdo  
Open Surdo  
-----  
[EXC6]  
[EXC6]  
88  
1 7 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SFX Se t List  
*
*
-----: No sound.  
[EXC]: will not sound simultaneously with other percussion instruments of the same number.  
SFX Set 1 (KR-7)  
SFX Set 1 (KR-5)  
SFX Vox Set (KR-7)  
21  
23  
24  
26  
28  
29  
31  
33  
35  
36  
38  
40  
41  
43  
45  
47  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
-----  
Uno  
Dos  
Tres  
Quatro  
One  
Two  
Three  
22  
25  
27  
Four  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Female Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Male Yodel  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Boys Amen  
Ole!  
30  
32  
34  
C2  
-----  
-----  
High Q  
Slap  
Scratch Push [EXC7]  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
-----  
-----  
High Q  
Slap  
Scratch Push [EXC7]  
Scratch Pull  
Sticks  
37  
39  
[EXC7]  
[EXC7]  
42  
44  
46  
Square Click  
Square Click  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Guitar sliding Finger  
Guitar cutting noise (up)  
Guitar cutting noise (down)  
String slap of double bass  
Fl.Key Click  
Laughing  
Screaming  
Punch  
Heart Beat  
Footsteps1  
Footsteps2  
Applause  
Door Creaking  
Door  
Metronome Click  
Metronome Bell  
Guitar sliding Finger  
Guitar cutting noise (up)  
Guitar cutting noise (down)  
String slap of double bass  
Fl.Key Click  
Laughing  
Screaming  
Punch  
Heart Beat  
Footsteps1  
Footsteps2  
Applause  
Door Creaking  
Door  
C3 48  
50  
49  
51  
52  
53  
54  
56  
58  
55  
57  
59  
C4 60  
62  
Scratch  
Scratch  
61  
63  
Wind Chimes  
Car-Engine  
Car-Stop  
Car-Pass  
Car-Crash  
Siren  
Train  
Jetplane  
Helicopter  
Starship  
Wind Chimes  
Car-Engine  
Car-Stop  
Car-Pass  
Car-Crash  
Siren  
Train  
Jetplane  
Helicopter  
Starship  
64  
65  
66  
68  
70  
Ole!  
Ole!  
Ole!  
Ole!  
67  
69  
71  
Ole!  
Gun Shot  
Machine Gun  
Lasergun  
Explosion  
Dog  
Gun Shot  
Machine Gun  
Lasergun  
Explosion  
Dog  
Ole!  
Ole!  
Ole!  
Ole!  
C5 72  
74  
73  
75  
76  
Ole!  
Horse-Gallop  
Birds  
Rain  
Thunder  
Wind  
Horse-Gallop  
Birds  
Rain  
Thunder  
Wind  
Ole!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
77  
78  
80  
82  
79  
81  
Seashore  
Stream  
Seashore  
Stream  
83  
Bubble  
Cat  
Bird  
BabyLaughing  
Boeeeen  
Bubble  
Cat  
Bird  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Yeah!  
Woo!  
Woo!  
Woo!  
Woo!  
Woo!  
Woo!  
C6 84  
86  
85  
87  
BabyLaughing  
Boeeeen  
Glass & Glam  
Ice Ring  
Crack Bottle  
Pour Bottle  
Car Horn  
R.Crossing  
SL 1  
88  
Glass & Glam  
Ice Ring  
89  
90  
92  
94  
Crack Bottle  
Pour Bottle  
Car Horn  
R.Crossing  
SL 1  
91  
93  
95  
SL 2  
Seal  
Fancy Animal  
-----  
SL 2  
Seal  
Fancy Animal  
Elephant  
Woo!  
Woo!  
Woo!  
Woo!  
96  
98  
C7  
97  
99  
100  
101  
-----  
-----  
Small Club  
-----  
-----  
Bike  
Woo!  
Woo!  
Ichi  
Ni  
San  
Shi  
Car Engine 2  
Small Club  
-----  
-----  
-----  
102  
104  
103  
105  
-----  
1 7 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Effe cts List  
Display  
Description  
Display  
Description  
Applies a light chorus effect with slow  
undulations  
Applies both overdrive and chorus  
effects.  
Overdrive  
-> Chorus  
GS Chorus 1  
GS Chorus 2  
GS Chorus 3  
GS Chorus 4  
Applies a light chorus effect with quick  
undulations  
Applies both overdrive and flanger  
effects.  
Overdrive  
-> Flanger  
Applies a deep chorus effect with slow  
undulations  
Applies both overdrive and delay  
effects.  
Overdrive -> Delay  
Applies a deep chorus effect with quick  
undulations  
Applies both distortion and chorus  
effects.  
Distortion  
-> Chorus  
GS Feedback  
Chorus  
Applies both distortion and flanger  
effects.  
Distortion  
-> Flanger  
A soft sound with a flanger effect  
An effect that sounds like a jet planes  
ascent/ descent  
Applies both distortion and delay  
effects.  
GS Flanger  
Distortion -> Delay  
GS Short Delay  
A short echo effect  
Applies  
a
resonance effect when the  
Sympathetic  
Resonance  
damper pedal is depressed.  
GS Short Delay  
(Feedback)  
A short echo with many repetitions  
* Following types are selected on the KR-7  
Stereo Chorus  
Hexa Chorus  
Tremolo Chorus  
Space D  
A stereo chorus.  
Produces a chorus with strong undula-  
Wave Chorus  
2 Band Chorus  
Space Chorus  
tions.  
A multilayer chorus.  
Applies different chorus effects in the  
treble and bass bands.  
A chorus with a tremolo effect.  
A clear chorus.  
A chorus with extremely small undula-  
tions.  
Rotary  
Adds a rotary-speaker effect.  
Delays the sound with a stereo effect.  
Stereo Delay  
Chorus -> Flanger  
Rhodes Multi  
Applies both chorus and flanger effects.  
The optimal effect for an electric piano.  
Adds a wavering effect to the delayed  
sound.  
Modulation Delay  
Triple Tap Delay  
Applies an effect that combines com-  
pressor, chorus, and delay.  
Clean Guitar  
Multi 1  
A three-way delay.  
A four-way delay.  
Quadruple  
Tap Delay  
Applies an effect that combines Auto  
Wah, Equalizer, chorus, and delay.  
Clean Guitar  
Multi 2  
Phaser  
Adds undulations to the sound.  
Adds metallic reverberations.  
Tremolo  
Produces cyclical changes in volume.  
Stereo Flanger  
Makes the sonic position of the sound  
move to the left or right.  
Auto Pan  
A flanger that varies the pitch in a  
stepwise fashion.  
Step Flanger  
This effect connect a chorus and a delay  
in parallel.  
Chorus/Delay  
Chorus/Flanger  
Rotary Multi  
Enhancer  
Overdrive  
Distortion  
Auto Wah  
Compressor  
Adds modulation to the sound.  
This effect connect  
flanger in parallel.  
a
chorus and  
a
Applies soft distortion to the sound.  
Applies hard distortion to the sound.  
Changes the tone in a cyclical manner.  
Suppresses fluctuations in volume.  
Applies an effect that combines rotary,  
Equalizer, and overdrive.  
Applies an effect that combines Ring  
Modulator, Equalizer, Pitch Shifter,  
Phaser, and Delay.  
Cuts off the reverberations before they  
fade away completely.  
Keyboard Multi  
Gate Reverb  
Adds two pitch-shifted sounds to the  
original sound (two-voice pitch shifter).  
2V Pitch Shifter  
FB Pitch Shifter  
The pitch will change in steps (feedback  
pitch shifter).  
Applies both enhancer and chorus  
effects.  
Enhancer  
-> Chorus  
Applies both enhancer and flanger  
effects.  
Enhancer  
-> Flanger  
Enhancer -> Delay  
Chorus -> Delay  
Flanger -> Delay  
Applies both enhancer and delay effects.  
Applies both chorus and delay effects.  
Applies both flanger and delay effects.  
1 7 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mu sic Sty le List (KR-7 )  
[Po p / Ro ck ]  
[Ba lla d / Aco u stic]  
[O ld ie s/ Co u n try ]  
[Go sp e l/ La tin ]  
[Tra d / Kid s]  
AmericanPop1  
AmericanPop2  
Easy Listen  
Shuffle Pop  
ShufleFusion  
Contemporary  
Funky Pop  
’70s 1  
Scat Ballad  
Piano Pop  
Guitar Trio  
6/8 Ballad  
Slow Pop  
Rock'n'Roll1  
Oldies 1  
Rhumba 1  
Salsa  
Raindrops  
Music Hall  
Slow Waltz  
Kids Shuffle  
Kids  
Rock'n'Roll2  
Country Gtr.  
HonkyTonkin'  
Slow Oldies  
Slow Dance  
Twist  
BossaNova 3  
Gospel  
Soft Gospel  
Gospel Shout  
Mambo 1  
Latin Festa  
ChaCha 2  
Anthem  
Symph.Ballad  
Piano Night  
Guitar Pop  
Swing Ballad  
Pop Ballad  
Latin Guitar  
Soulful Sax  
8BeatBallad1  
8BeatBallad2  
Soft Ballad  
12/8 Ballad  
Chapel  
Kids Dance  
Broadway  
Stage Waltz  
Waltzing  
’70s 2  
Oldies 2  
Cool Al  
CountryBalad  
OldtimeCntry  
D Country  
Rock'n'Roll3  
Surf'fun  
Circus  
Asian Pop  
Swing Pop  
Groovin  
Gospel Pop  
P.Gospel  
Samba 1  
Samba 2  
BossaNova 1  
BossaNova 2  
Fast Bossa  
Slow Bossa  
LatinTrumpet  
Mambo 2  
Rhumba 2  
ChaCha 1  
Son  
Little Steps  
Parade  
MarchingBand  
Polka  
Medium Pop  
Michael'sPop  
OrchestraPop  
Light Pop  
JB Soul  
March  
Blues  
Irish  
’50s R&B  
Tejano  
’70s 8-Beat  
British Pop  
’60s R&B  
Crystal  
Summer Days  
PianoRagtime  
Charleston  
Bluegrass  
Country  
Celtic  
Piano Latin  
Piano Waltz  
ClasiclPolka  
PianoClasic1  
PianoClasic2  
Guitar Bossa  
Gtr.Fast Pop  
Guitar Waltz  
Harp  
Party Waltz  
Vienna Waltz  
Musette  
Fusion  
West Coast  
Rollin'  
Scotland  
Japan  
CountryWaltz  
Train Beat  
Country Song  
P.Country  
Light Fusion  
Shuffle Rock  
Power Pop  
Power Rock  
Hard Rock  
Heavy Metal  
HipHop  
Calypso  
Ireland  
Tango  
Festival  
Plena  
Cinema  
Bomba  
WesternMovie  
Balloon Trip  
Black&White  
SFX Movie  
Western  
Strings  
Merengue  
Slow Beguine  
Beguine  
P.Pop 1  
[Big Ba n d /  
Sw in g ]  
P.Classic 1  
P.Slow Waltz  
P.Night  
Techno  
Latin Pop  
Latin  
LooseBigBand  
Scat Swing 2  
Big Serenade  
Fast Swing  
Jazzy Choir  
Organ Swing  
Dixie  
Screen  
P.Bossa Nova  
P.Pop 2  
Fanfare  
SimpleMarch1  
SimpleMarch2  
Simple Waltz  
Kids 4/4  
P.Stride  
P.Concerto 1  
P.Classic 2  
P.Ballad 1  
P.Ballad 2  
P.Swing Pop  
P.Waltz  
Kids 6/8  
Jazz Waltz  
Dixieland  
Lullaby 4/4  
Brush Swing  
Jazz Quintet  
Big Band Pop  
Big Band  
P.Concerto 2  
P.Concerto 3  
P.Swing  
Hula  
P.Boogie  
Hawaiian  
P.Slow Swing  
P.'50s Rock  
P.Latin  
Cool Swing  
Scat Swing 1  
A Cappella  
Medium Swing  
Slow Swing  
Piano Jazz  
Swing'in  
Foxtrot 1  
Foxtrot 2  
Boogie  
Piano Boogie  
PianoShuffle  
Stride Piano  
1 8 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Mu sic Sty le List (KR-5 )  
[Po p / Ro ck ]  
[Ba lla d / Aco u stic]  
[O ld ie s/ Co u n try ]  
[Go sp e l/ La tin ]  
[Tra d / Kid s]  
AmericanPop1  
Funky Pop  
Easy Listen  
Asian Pop  
ShufleFusion  
Contemporary  
’70s 1  
Soulful Sax  
8BeatBallad1  
Pop Ballad  
Symph.Ballad  
6/8 Ballad  
Piano Night  
Guitar Trio  
12/8 Ballad  
Chapel  
Oldies 1  
Merengue  
Rhumba 1  
Slow Bossa  
Gospel  
Raindrops  
Broadway  
Slow Waltz  
Kids Shuffle  
Kids  
Rock'n'Roll1  
Twist  
Country Gtr.  
CountryBalad  
CountryWaltz  
Surf'fun  
Gospel Shout  
P.Gospel  
Son  
Kids Dance  
Waltzing  
’70s 2  
Rock'n'Roll2  
Slow Dance  
Bluegrass  
P.Country  
Train Beat  
Slow Oldies  
JB Soul  
Rhumba 2  
Latin  
Balloon Trip  
Festival  
Cool Al  
Groovin  
Crystal  
Anthem  
Circus  
Swing Pop  
British Pop  
Shuffle Pop  
Medium Pop  
Michael'sPop  
OrchestraPop  
Light Pop  
Piano Latin  
Piano Waltz  
PianoClasic1  
PianoClasic2  
Gtr.Fast Pop  
Guitar Pop  
Guitar Waltz  
P.Pop 1  
Gospel Pop  
Slow Beguine  
Mambo 1  
Mambo 2  
Samba 1  
BossaNova 1  
BossaNova 2  
Fast Bossa  
Latin Festa  
LatinTrumpet  
Latin Pop  
Salsa  
Little Steps  
Lullaby 4/4  
MarchingBand  
March  
Blues  
Vienna Waltz  
Tejano  
’50s R&B  
Summer Days  
PianoRagtime  
Charleston  
Country  
Celtic  
’70s 8-Beat  
’60s R&B  
Scotland  
P.Classic 1  
P.Slow Waltz  
P.Night  
Cinema  
Fusion  
WesternMovie  
Black&White  
Ireland  
West Coast  
Rollin'  
P.Bossa Nova  
P.Pop 2  
Power Pop  
Power Rock  
Shuffle Rock  
Hard Rock  
Techno  
[Big Ba n d /  
Sw in g ]  
ChaCha 1  
Calypso  
Kids 4/4  
P.Stride  
Kids 6/8  
P.Concerto 1  
P.Classic 2  
P.Ballad 1  
P.Ballad 2  
P.Swing Pop  
P.Waltz  
Tango  
Western  
LooseBigBand  
Scat Swing 2  
Big Serenade  
Jazz Quintet  
A Cappella  
Organ Swing  
Big Band  
Bomba  
SFX Movie  
Screen  
Beguine  
Musette  
Japan  
Fanfare  
P.Concerto 2  
P.Concerto 3  
P.Swing  
SimpleMarch1  
SimpleMarch2  
Simple Waltz  
Hawaiian  
Scat Swing 1  
Cool Swing  
Brush Swing  
Jazz Waltz  
P.Boogie  
P.Slow Swing  
P.'50s Rock  
P.Latin  
Fast Swing  
Medium Swing  
Slow Swing  
Dixieland  
Big Band Pop  
Foxtrot 1  
Piano Boogie  
PianoShuffle  
Stride Piano  
1 8 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch o rd List  
*
*
symbol : Indicates the constituent note of chords.  
symbol : Chord shown with an “”can be played by pressing just the key marked with the “” (p. 52).  
C
C#  
D
E
E
E
E
E
E
E
F
Cmaj7  
C7  
C#maj7  
C#7  
Dmaj7  
D7  
maj7  
Emaj7  
E7  
Fmaj7  
F7  
7
Cm  
C#m  
Dm  
m
Em  
Fm  
Cm7  
Cdim  
C#m7  
C#dim  
Dm7  
Ddim  
m7  
dim  
Em7  
Edim  
Fm7  
Fdim  
Cm7 ( 5 )  
C#m7 ( 5 )  
C#aug  
Dm7 ( 5 )  
E
E
E
E
E
E
m7 ( 5 )  
Em7 ( 5 )  
Fm7 ( 5 )  
Caug  
Daug  
aug  
Eaug  
Faug  
Csus4  
C7sus4  
C6  
C#sus4  
C#7sus4  
C#6  
Dsus4  
D7sus4  
D6  
sus4  
7sus4  
6
Esus4  
E7sus4  
E6  
Fsus4  
F7sus4  
F6  
Cm6  
C#m6  
Dm6  
m6  
Em6  
Fm6  
1 8 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Ch o rd List  
*
*
symbol : Indicates the constituent note of chords.  
symbol : Chord shown with an “”can be played by pressing just the key marked with the “” (p. 52).  
F#  
G
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
A
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
B
F#maj7  
F#7  
Gmaj7  
G7  
maj7  
Amaj7  
A7  
maj7  
Bmaj7  
B7  
7
7
F#m  
Gm  
m
Am  
m
Bm  
F#m7  
F#dim  
F#m7 ( 5 )  
F#aug  
F#sus4  
Gm7  
Gdim  
Gm7 ( 5 )  
Gaug  
Gsus4  
m7  
Am7  
Adim  
Am7 ( 5 )  
Aaug  
Asus4  
m7  
Bm7  
Bdim  
Bm7 ( 5 )  
Baug  
Bsus4  
dim  
dim  
m7 ( 5 )  
aug  
sus4  
m7 ( 5 )  
aug  
sus4  
F#7sus4  
F#6  
G7sus4  
G6  
A
A
7sus4  
A7sus4  
A6  
B
B
7sus4  
B7sus4  
B6  
6
6
F#m6  
Gm6  
A
m6  
Am6  
B
m6  
Bm6  
1 8 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In te rn a l So n g List  
Fo lk s  
Ja zzy  
© 1993 Roland Corporation  
© 1993 Roland Corporation  
© 1993 Roland Corporation  
© 1993 Roland Corporation  
© 1998 Roland Corporation  
© 1994 Roland Corporation  
© 1993 Roland Corporation  
© 1993 Roland Corporation  
© 1998 Roland Corporation  
© 1998 Roland Corporation  
© 1998 Roland Corporation  
© 1992 Roland Corporation  
© 1998 Roland Corporation  
© 1994 Roland Corporation  
© 1992 Roland Corporation  
© 2002 Roland Corporation  
© 1998 Roland Corporation  
© 1992 Roland Corporation  
© 1992 Roland Corporation  
© 1992 Roland Corporation  
© 1994 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1998 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
Annie Laurie  
Londonderry Air  
AmazingGrace  
Ave Maria  
Secret Agent  
Late Night Chopin  
Fly Free  
Sun Daze  
Clock  
Keepers Tale  
CountOnBlues  
OneDown&Easy  
A PreludeTo:  
BachsBoppin'  
HungarianRag  
KismetsSalsa  
Matthew  
Entertainer  
Greensleeves  
Hallelujah!  
Jingle Bells  
Les patineurs, Valse  
Little Brown Jug  
Marchin' In  
Silent Night, Holy Night  
Stagecoach  
RollOverLudwig  
Kid s  
EZ Cla ssica l  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
Frog Song  
© 1993 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1997 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 1994 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
Air sul G  
HoneybeeMarch  
Jingle Bell  
Fantasie-impromptu op.66  
Grande valse brillante  
Gymnopedie 1  
Liebestraume 3  
Mondschein  
Little Fox  
Little Row  
LondonBridge  
Mary Lamb  
OldMacDonald  
The Cuckoo  
Twinkle  
Nocturne 9-2  
Petit chien  
Prelude28-15  
Traumerei  
TurkishMarch  
Ungarische Tanze V  
1 8 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
In te rn a l So n g List  
Pra ctice  
Pra ctice  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
© 2000 Roland Corporation  
Beyer 15  
The Hunt  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
© 1999 Roland Corporation  
Beyer 21  
TenderFlower  
Shepherdess  
Farewell  
Beyer 25  
Beyer 29  
Beyer 34  
Consolation  
AustrianDance  
Ballad  
Beyer 38  
Beyer 42  
Beyer 46  
Sighing  
Beyer 51  
Chatterbox  
Restlessness  
Ave Maria  
Beyer 55  
Beyer 60  
Beyer 64  
Tarantella  
Beyer 67  
AngelHarmony  
Gondola Song  
The Return  
The Swallow  
KnightErrant  
Invention 1  
Invention 2  
Invention 3  
Invention 4  
Invention 5  
Invention 6  
Invention 7  
Invention 8  
Invention 9  
Invention 10  
Invention 11  
Invention 12  
Invention 13  
Invention 14  
Invention 15  
Beyer 73  
Beyer 78  
Beyer 81  
Beyer 90  
Beyer 93  
Beyer 98  
Beyer 103  
Czerny100- 1  
Czerny100-10  
Czerny100-20  
Czerny100-30  
Czerny100-38  
Czerny100-43  
Czerny100-60  
Czerny100-75  
Czerny100-86  
Czerny100-96  
Openness  
Arabesque  
Pastoral  
SmallGathering  
Innocence  
Progress  
Clear Stream  
Gracefulness  
1 8 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In te rn a l So n g List  
Ma ste rp ie ce s  
Ma ste rp ie ce s  
Song files of this genre corresponds to the included  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
Standchen  
collection of printed music entitled “Roland 60 Classical  
Piano Masterpieces.”  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1992 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
Humoreske  
Blumenlied  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 1997 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1997 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1998 Roland Corporation  
© 2001 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1995 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
Sonate No.15  
Alpenglockchen  
Menuett Gdur (Beethoven)  
Venezianisches Gondellied  
Alpenabendrote  
Farewell to the Piano  
Brautchor  
Liebestraume 3  
Etude op10-3  
Je te veux  
Valse op64-1  
Golliwog'sCakewalk  
FantaisieImpromptu  
Arabesque 1  
Waterloo  
WienerMarsch  
Blauen Donau  
Le Coucou  
Auf Flugeln des Gesanges  
Mazurka No.5  
Menuett Gdur (Bach)  
Spinnerlied  
Gymnopedie 1  
Gavotte  
Etude op25-1  
Heidenroslein  
ClairDeLune  
ZigeunerTanz  
Etude op10-5  
Cinquantaine  
Dr.GradusAdParnassum  
Grande Valse Brillante  
La priere d'une Vierge  
Course en Troika  
ToTheSpring  
Csikos Post  
Dolly'sDreaming Awakening  
La Violette  
Frohlicher Landmann  
Sonatine36-1 (Clementi)  
Sonatine20-1 (Kuhlau)  
SonatineNo.5 (Beethoven)  
Valse op64-2  
RadetzkyMarsch  
Traumerei  
MomentsMusicaux 3  
Prelude op28-15  
HarmoniousBlacksmith  
Ungarische Tanze 5  
*
All rights reserved. Unauthorized use of this material for  
purposes other than private, personal enjoyment is a violation of  
applicable laws.  
Turkischer Marsch  
(Beethoven)  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
© 1996 Roland Corporation  
NocturneNo.2  
Fruhlingslied  
Praludium  
Jagerlied  
MenuetAntique  
Fur Elise  
Turkischer Marsch (Mozart)  
1 8 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rh y th m Pa tte rn List  
Pa tte rn s Th a t Ca n Be  
Se le cte d w ith th e  
[Rh y th m ] Bu tto n  
Beat  
Pattern Name  
8-Beat 6  
16-Beat 4  
16-Beat 5  
Rock 3  
Rock 4  
4/4 Simple  
5/4  
Pattern Name (Beat) Measures  
Shuffle2(4/4)  
Brush (4/4)  
1
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
2
1
1
2
1
1
2
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
4
4
4
4
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Triplet(4/4)  
4/4  
March 1(4/4)  
March 2(4/4)  
Tango 1(4/4)  
Tango 2(4/4)  
Mambo 1(4/4)  
Mambo 2(4/4)  
House 1(4/4)  
House 2(4/4)  
House 3(4/4)  
BossaNova(4/4)  
Samba 1(4/4)  
Samba 2(4/4)  
Rhumba (4/4)  
Beguine(4/4)  
8-Beat4(4/4)  
8-Beat5(4/4)  
8-Beat6(4/4)  
16-Beat4(4/4)  
16-Beat5(4/4)  
Rock 3 (4/4)  
Rock 4 (4/4)  
4/4Simple(4/4)  
5/4 (5/4)  
Beat  
Pattern Name  
March  
5/4  
6/4  
7/4  
3/8  
2/2  
0/4  
Swing  
6/4  
Stick  
7/4  
March  
3/8  
2/4  
3/4  
Country  
Samba  
Ballad  
March  
6/8  
Waltz 1  
Swing  
Waltz 2  
6/8 Simple  
9/8  
Waltz 3  
9/8  
Country Waltz  
Gospel  
12/8  
12/8  
Jazz Waltz  
3/4 Simple  
8-Beat 1  
8-Beat 2  
8-Beat 3  
16-Beat 1  
16-Beat 2  
16-Beat 3  
Rock 1  
Pa tte rn s Th a t Ca n Be  
Se le cte d w ith th e Ed it  
Fu n ctio n s  
Pattern Name (Beat) Measures  
March (2/2)  
2
8
1
2
8
4
4
4
1
2
4
4
1
2
2
4
2
2
4
2
2
4
1
2
Rock 2  
6/4 (6/4)  
Swing (2/2)  
Swing 1  
Swing 2  
Shuffle 1  
Shuffle 2  
Brush  
7/4 (7/4)  
Stick (0/4)  
3/8 (3/8)  
March (2/4)  
Ballad (6/8)  
March (6/8)  
Swing (6/8)  
6/8Simple(6/8)  
9/8 (9/8)  
Country(2/4)  
Samba (2/4)  
Waltz 1(3/4)  
Waltz 2(3/4)  
Waltz 3(3/4)  
CntryWltz (3/4)  
Gospel (3/4)  
JazzWaltz (3/4)  
3/4 Simple (3/4)  
8-Beat1 (4/4)  
8-Beat2(4/4)  
8-Beat3(4/4)  
16-Beat1(4/4)  
16-Beat2(4/4)  
16-Beat3(4/4)  
Rock 1 (4/4)  
Rock 2 (4/4)  
Swing 1(4/4)  
Swing 2(4/4)  
Shuffle1(4/4)  
Triplet  
March 1  
March 2  
Tango 1  
Tango 2  
Mambo 1  
Mambo 2  
House 1  
House 2  
House 3  
Bossa Nova  
Samba 1  
Samba 2  
Rhumba  
Beguine  
8-Beat 4  
8-Beat 5  
4/4  
12/8 (12/8)  
CountIn1(4/4)  
CountIn2(3/4)  
C.InSwing(4/4)  
Fill In1(4/4)  
Fill In2(4/4)  
Fill In3(4/4)  
Ending 1(4/4)  
Ending 2(4/4)  
Ending 3(4/4)  
1 8 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Pa ra m e te rs Sto re d to In te rn a l Me m o ry  
Pa ra m e te rs Sto re d in th e Use r Pro g ra m  
Pa ra m e te rs Sto re d in Me m o ry Ba ck u p  
Parameters that switch immediately after the User Pro-  
gram name is touched when <Option> on the User Pro-  
gram screen is set to “Delayed”  
Octave Shift  
Tone  
Parameters  
Effects: On/ Off, Type, Depth  
Rotary effect (Slow/ Fast),  
Organ  
One-Touch Piano Settings:  
Footage (Upper, Lower), Percussion  
Lid, Tuning (Tuning, Key, Stretch Tunings),  
Resonance (Type (KR-7), Depth),  
Key Touch,  
Selected  
Right-hand  
Tone, Octave Shift,  
Tone, Layer  
String Resonance (On/ Off, Depth) (KR-7),  
Hamper Response (On/ Off, Depth) (KR-7)  
Effect (Type, Depth, On/ Off)  
Tone,  
Left-hand Tone  
Metronome: Sound  
Count-In: Measures, Sound  
Countdown: Sound  
Language  
System  
Bass Tone, Chord Tone  
Parameters  
Part Balance  
Keyboard Parts  
Melody  
On/ Off, Type  
Intelligent  
Opening Message  
Touch Screen  
Split On/ Off, Layer On/ Off,  
Lower On/ Off,  
Keyboard Mode  
Pedal Settings  
Track Assign  
Keyboard Transpose, Split Point  
Reverb: On/ Off, Type, Depth  
Functions assigning to the left pedal and  
center pedal  
Style Orchestrator/ User Function (KR-5),  
User Function, Phrase (KR-7),  
Style Orchestrator values assigning the Pads  
(KR-5)  
Performance  
Pad Settings  
Keyboard settings  
(One-Touch Piano/ One-Touch Arranger/ Others)  
Reverb  
On/ Off, Type, Depth  
On/ Off, Echo (Type, Depth),  
Vocal Effects  
Transformer Type, Harmonist Type,  
Transformer/ Harmonist, Music Files Part  
(KR-7)  
Bend Range  
MIDI Settings for  
User Program  
PC Number, Bank Select LSB,  
Bank Select MSB, Program Change  
Equalizer  
On/ Off, Each Sliders level, Master Level  
(KR-7)  
Parameters that switch after the User Program name is  
touched for a few moments when <Option> on the User  
Program screen is set to “Delayed”  
Music Style  
Tempo  
Part Balance  
Accompaniment Part  
Accompaniment On/ Off,  
Chord Intelligence On/ Off,  
Leading Bass On/ Off, Original/ Variation,  
Sync Start On/ Off,  
Arranger  
Settings  
<Accomp> setting for  
Arranger Configuration,  
Style Orchestrator, Division  
1 8 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Mu sic File s Th a t th e KR-7 / 5 Ca n Use  
W h a t Are Mu sic File s?  
Ab o u t th e KR-7 / 5 So u n d  
Ge n e ra to r  
The KR-7/ 5 come equipped with GM 2/ GS sound generators.  
Music Files contain information describing the details of a  
musical performance, such as “the C3 key on a keyboard was  
pressed for this amount of time, using this amount of  
force.”By inserting the floppy disk into the disk drive on the  
Ge n e ra l MIDI  
KR-7/ 5, the performance information is sent from the floppy  
The General MIDI is a set of recommendations which seeks to  
disk to the piano, and played faithfully by the piano. This is  
provide a way to go beyond the limitations of proprietary designs,  
different than a CD, since the music file does not contain a  
and standardize the MIDI capabilities of sound generating devices.  
recording of the sound itself. This makes it possible to erase  
Sound generating devices and music files that meets the General  
certain parts, or to change instruments, tempos and keys  
MIDI standard bears the General MIDI logo. Music files bearing the  
freely, allowing you to use it in many different ways.  
General MIDI logo can be played back using any General MIDI  
sound generating unit to produce essentially the same musical  
performance.  
Re g a rd in g Co p y rig h t  
Use of the song data supplied with the Data Disk attached to  
this product for any purpose other than private, personal  
enjoyment without the permission of the copyright holder is  
prohibited by law. Additionally, this data must not be  
copied, nor used in a secondary copyrighted work without  
the permission of the copyright holder.  
Ge n e ra l MIDI 2  
The upwardly compatible General MIDI 2 recommendations pick up  
where the original General MIDI left off, offering enhanced  
expressive capabilities, and even greater compatibility. Issues that  
were not covered by the original General MIDI recommendations,  
such as how sounds are to be edited, and how effects should be  
handled, have now been precisely defined. Moreover, the available  
sounds have been expanded. General MIDI 2 compliant sound  
generators are capable of reliably playing back music files that carry  
either the General MIDI or General MIDI 2 logo.  
Th e KR-7 / 5 a llo w s y o u to u se  
th e fo llo w in g m u sic file s  
Floppy disks saved on a Roland MT Series, or Roland Piano  
Digital HP-G/ R and KR Series instrument  
In some cases, the conventional form of General MIDI, which does  
not include the new enhancements, is referred to as “General MIDI  
1” as a way of distinguishing it from General MIDI 2.  
Roland Digital Piano Compatible Music Files  
Rolands original music file is made specifically for practicing the  
piano. Some follow an instructional curriculum, allowing for a  
complete range of lessons, such as “practicing each hand  
separately” or “listening to only the accompaniment.”  
GS Fo rm a t  
The GS Format is Rolands set of specifications for standardizing the  
performance of sound generating devices. In addition to including  
support for everything defined by the General MIDI, the highly  
compatible GS Format additionally offers an expanded number of  
sounds, provides for the editing of sounds, and spells out many  
details for a wide range of extra features, including effects such as  
reverb and chorus. Designed with the future in mind, the GS Format  
can readily include new sounds and support new hardware features  
when they arrive. Since it is upwardly compatible with the General  
MIDI, Rolands GS Format is capable of reliably playing back GM  
Scores equally as well as it performs GS music files (music files that  
have been created with the GS Format in mind). This product  
supports both the General MIDI 2 and the GS Format, and can be  
used to play back music data carrying either of these logos.  
SMF Music Files (720KB/ 1.44MB format)  
SMFs (Standard MIDI Files) use a standard format for music file  
that was formulated so that files containing music file could be  
widely compatible, regardless of the manufacturer of the  
listening device. An enormous variety of music is available,  
whether it be for listening, for practicing musical instruments, for  
Karaoke, etc.  
*
If you wish to purchase SMF Music Files, please consult the  
retailer where you purchased your KR-7/5.  
SMF w ith Ly rics  
“SMF with Lyrics” refers to SMF (Standard MIDI File) that  
contains the lyrics. When Music Files carrying the “SMF with  
Lyrics” logo are played back on a compatible device (one  
bearing the same logo), the lyrics will appear in its display.  
XG lite  
XG is a tone generator format of YAMAHA Corporation, that  
defines the ways in which voices are expanded or edited and the  
structure and type of effects, in addition to the General MIDI 1  
specification. XGlite is a simplified version of XG tone generation  
format. You can play back any XG music files using an XGlite tone  
generator. However, keep in mind that some music files may play  
back differently compared to the original files, due to the reduced set  
of control parameters and effects.  
1 8 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
MIDI Im p le m e n ta tio n Ch a rt  
DIGITAL PIANO  
Model KR-7/5  
Date : Apr. 1, 2002  
Version : 1.00  
MIDI Implementation Chart  
Transmitted  
Recognized  
Remarks  
Function...  
Basic  
Channel  
Default  
Changed  
1
1–16  
1–16  
116  
Default  
Messages  
Altered  
Mode 3  
x
Mode 3  
Mode 3, 4 (M=1)  
* 2  
Mode  
**************  
Note  
Number :  
15–113  
**************  
0–127  
0–127  
True Voice  
Note ON  
Note OFF  
O
x
O
x
Velocity  
8n v=64  
*1  
*1  
After  
Touch  
Key’s  
Ch’s  
x
x
O
O
Pitch Bend  
O
O
0, 32  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
Bank select  
Modulation  
Portamento time  
Data entry  
1
O
*1  
*1  
*1  
5
6, 38  
7
O
O
O
Volume  
10  
O
Panpot  
*1  
*1  
11  
O
Expression  
Hold 1  
Control  
Change  
64  
O
65  
O
Portamento  
Sostenuto  
*1  
66  
O
67  
O
Soft  
84  
O
Portamento control  
Effect1 depth  
Effect3 depth  
NRPN LSB, MSB  
RPN LSB, MSB  
*1  
91  
O (Reverb)  
93  
O (Chorus)  
98, 99  
100, 101  
O
O
*1  
*1  
Prog  
Change  
0–127  
**************  
O
0–127  
: True #  
Program number 1–128  
System Exclusive  
O
O
: Song Pos  
: Song Sel  
: Tune  
x
x
x
x
x
x
System  
Common  
System  
Real Time  
: Clock  
: Commands  
O
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
O
x
O (120, 126, 127)  
: All sound off  
O
:
Reset all controllers  
Aux  
Message  
O
: Local Control  
: All Notes OFF  
: Active Sense  
: Reset  
O (123–125)  
O
x
* 1 O x is selectable by SysEx.  
* 2 Recognized as M=1 even if M=1.  
Notes  
Mode 1 : OMNI ON, POLY  
Mode 2 : OMNI ON, MONO  
O : Yes  
X : No  
Mode 3 : OMNI OFF, POLY Mode 4 : OMNI OFF, MONO  
1 9 0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ma in Sp e cifica tio n s  
KR-7  
KR-5  
<Keyboard>  
88 keys (Progressive hammer action keyboard with  
Keyboard  
88 keys (Progressive hammer action keyboard)  
escapement)  
Touch Sensitivity  
Keyboard Mode  
100 levels  
Whole, Split (adjustable split point), Layer, Arranger, Piano Style Arranger, Manual Drums / SFX  
<Sound Source> Conforms to GM2 / GS / XG Lite  
Max. Polyphony  
128 voices  
64 voices  
Tones  
6 groups 683 variations  
6 groups 646 variations  
(Tone Search by terms and  
by letters)  
(including 16 drum sets, 2 SFX sets)  
(including 15 drum sets, 1 SFX set)  
Temperament  
Stretched Tuning  
Master Tuning  
Transpose  
8 types, selectable tonic  
2 types  
415.3 Hz–466.2 Hz (adjustable in increments of 0.1 Hz)  
Key Transpose (-6–+5 in units of semitone), Playback Transpose (-24–+24 in units of semitone)  
Reverb (16 types, 127 levels),  
Chorus (8 types, 127 levels),  
Reverb (8 types, 127 levels),  
Effects  
Sympathetic Resonance, Rotary and 45 other types,  
Advanced 3D,  
Chorus (8 types, 127 levels),  
Sympathetic Resonance, Rotary and 32 other types  
Physical Damper Simulation (Advanced Resonance)  
Equalizer  
5 bands, Master level  
<Arranger>  
Music Styles  
(Style Search by terms  
and by letters)  
6 groups 204 styles x 4 types (Style Orchestrator)  
Over 130 sets x 4 presets  
6 groups 165 styles x 4 types (Style Orchestrator)  
Music Assistant  
(Search by terms and  
by letters)  
Over 100 sets x 4 presets  
Style Converter  
Programmable Music  
Styles  
Style Converter, Style Composer  
24 types  
Melody Intelligence  
Start/ Stop, Intro/ Ending (2 types for each styles), Sync. Start, Fill In (Variation, Original), Arranger Reset,  
Countdown, Count-In, Melody Intelligence, Break, Leading Bass, No Chord, Fade in/ out,  
Half Fill In (Variation, Original), Chord Intelligence, Style Orchestrator  
Control  
<User Programs>  
Internal  
36  
Disk  
Max. 99 sets  
<Rhythm Partner> Metronome, Rhythm  
Tempo  
Quarter note = 20–250  
Beat  
2/ 2, 0/ 4, 2/ 4, 3/ 4, 4/ 4, 5/ 4, 6/ 4, 7/ 4, 3/ 8, 6/ 8, 9/ 8, 12/ 8  
Volume  
10 levels  
Metronome Pattern  
Metronome Sound  
Rhythm Pattern  
<Composer>  
Tracks  
11 patterns  
8 types  
59 patterns  
5 tracks / 16 tracks  
Song  
1 song  
Note Storage  
Resolution  
Recording Method  
Edit  
Approx. 30,000 notes  
120 ticks per quarter note  
Realtime (Replace, Mix, Auto Punch In, Manual Punch In, Loop, Tempo), Step (Chord Sequencer), Beat Map  
Copy, Quantize, Delete, Insert, Erase, Transpose, Part Exchange, Note Edit, PC Edit  
1 9 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ma in Sp e cifica tio n s  
KR-7  
KR-5  
Song Select, Reset, Play/ Stop, Rec, Bwd, Fwd, All Song Play, Random Play, Track Select, Count-in,  
Countdown, Playback Balance, Marker Set, Repeat, Tempo Mute  
Control  
Touch the Notes, Replay, Select Various Tones,  
Touch the Notes, Replay, Select Various Tones,  
Song Stylist, Session Partner,  
Other Functions  
Wonderland/ Game, Quick Tour, Audition,  
Wonderland/ Game, Quick Tour, Audition,  
Panel Lock  
Panel Lock  
<Disk Drive / Disk Storage> 3.5 inch Micro Floppy Disk  
Disk Format  
Files  
720K bytes (2DD), 1.44M bytes (2HD)  
Max. 99 songs, Max. 99 User Styles, Max. 99 User Program Sets  
Approx. 120,000 notes (2DD), Approx. 240,000 notes (2HD)  
Song: Standard MIDI Files (Format 0/ 1), Roland Original Format (i-Format)  
Music Style: MSA, MSD, MSE  
Note Storage  
Playable Software  
Song: Standard MIDI Files (Format 0), Roland Original Format (i-Format),  
Music Style: MSE  
Save  
<Internal Memory>  
Internal Songs  
(Song Search by terms  
and by letters)  
Over 170 songs  
Max. 200 songs on Favorites, Max. 99 User Styles,  
User Memory  
Max. 200 songs on Favorites  
Max. 99 User Program sets  
<Others>  
Rated Power Output  
Speakers  
Display  
40 W x 2  
30 W x 2  
16 cm x 2  
16 cm x 2,5 cm x 2  
Bouncing Beat Indicator, Graphical LCD 320 x 240 dot (backlit LCD)  
Grand staff / G Clef staff / F Clef staff, with note name / lyrics / chords / fingering  
English / Japanese / Germany / French / Spanish  
Score  
Language  
Lyrics  
Yes (built-in, external display, MIDI output)  
Yes (built-in, MIDI output)  
Volume, Brilliance, Volume Balance, Contrast,  
Mic Volume  
Volume, Brilliance, Volume Balance, Contrast,  
Mic Volume, Mic Echo  
Control  
One Touch Program  
One Touch Piano, One Touch Arranger  
Damper Pedal (half-pedal recognition), Soft Pedal  
(half-pedal recognition, 36 functions assignable),  
Sostenuto Pedal (36 functions assignable)  
Damper Pedal (half-pedal recognition), Soft Pedal  
(half-pedal recognition, 34 functions assignable),  
Sostenuto Pedal (34 functions assignable)  
Pedals  
Echo, Voice Transformer, Vocal Keyboard,  
Harmonist  
Vocal Effects  
Output jacks (L/ Mono, R), Input jacks (L/ Mono, R),  
Mic Input jack, Headphones jack (Stereo) x 2,  
MIDI In connector x 2, MIDI Out connector,  
Computer connector,  
Output jacks (L/ Mono, R), Input jacks (L/ Mono, R),  
Mic Input jack, Headphones jack (Stereo) x 2,  
MIDI In connector x 2, MIDI Out connector,  
Computer connector,  
Connectors  
Pedal connector (8-pin DIN type),  
Speaker connector,  
Pedal connector (8-pin DIN type)  
Ext Display connector (15-pin D-Sub type)  
Power Supply  
AC 117 V / AC 230 V / AC 240 V  
105 W  
Power Consumption  
80 W  
Dimensions (including the  
piano stand)  
1,445 (W) x 548 (D) x 902 (H) mm  
1,445 (W) x 548 (D) x 902 (H) mm  
56-15/ 16 (W) x 21-5/ 8 (D) x 35-9/ 16 (H) inches  
56-15/ 16 (W) x 21-5/ 8 (D) x 35-9/ 16 (H) inches  
1,445 (W) x 548 (D) x 1,116 (H) mm  
1,445 (W) x 548 (D) x 1,107 (H) mm  
Including the music stand  
56-15/ 16 (W) x 21-5/ 8 (D) x 43-15/ 16 (H) inches  
56-15/ 16 (W) x 21-5/ 8 (D) x 43-5/ 8 (H) inches  
Weights (including the  
piano stand)  
78 kg / 172 lbs  
70 kg / 155 lbs  
Accessories  
Quick Start, Owners Manual, Roland 60 Classical Piano Masterpieces, AC cord  
* In the interest of product improvement, the specifications and/or appearance of this unit are subject to change without prior notice.  
1 9 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In d e x  
Connecting  
Numerics  
A
Copying  
Accompaniment  
Count-In  
B
Beat  
D
Deleting  
DRUMS ..........................................................................QS 5  
E
Erasing  
C
Clef L .......................................................................................... 76  
Clef R .......................................................................................... 76  
Performance on specific tracks ....................................... 102  
QS **” refers to the page number in Quick Start.  
1 9 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In d e x  
F
L
Factory Setting  
Layer Set ......................................................................QS 14  
Lyrics ....................................................................................76, 93  
Finger Numbers ........................................................................ 76  
Footage ........................................................................QS 15  
Format  
M
[Melody Intelligence] button .................................................. 64  
MIC ................................................................................QS 5  
[Music Assistant] button ..............................................QS 10  
G
GAME ............................................................................QS 5  
H
I
K
Key .............................................................................................. 76  
Key Template ................................................................QS 3  
QS **” refers to the page number in Quick Start.  
1 9 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In d e x  
At a fixed tempo (Tempo Mute) ...................................... 84  
N
N.C. (No Chord) ..........................................................QS 13  
O
One Touch Program [Arranger] button ................................ 51  
One Touch Program [Piano] button ...................................... 24  
Organ ...........................................................................QS 14  
Q
Quick Tour  
R
Restoring the Factory Settings .............................................. 155  
P
Pedal EX ......................................................................QS 14  
Pitches ........................................................................................ 76  
QS **” refers to the page number in Quick Start.  
1 9 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In d e x  
Write User Program screen ............................................. 112  
S
[Score Display] button ............................................. QS 8, 74  
Screens  
Search  
16-track Sequencer screen ............................................... 117  
Copy User Programs screen ........................................... 115  
Countdown settings screen .............................................. 60  
Delete User Program screen ........................................... 115  
Load User Program screen ............................................. 114  
Melody Intelligence screen ............................................... 64  
Save User Program screen .............................................. 113  
[Select Various Tones] button ......................................QS 14  
[Select/ Listen to a Song] button .............................. QS 6, 69  
[Session Partner] button ...............................................QS 18  
SFX ..................................................................... QS 5, QS 14  
SONGS ...........................................................................QS 5  
[Song Stylist] button ....................................................QS 16  
Split Set ........................................................................QS 14  
[Style Orchestrator/ User Function] button .......................... 62  
QS **” refers to the page number in Quick Start.  
1 9 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In d e x  
T
V
Volume  
TONES ...........................................................................QS 5  
Touch EX .....................................................................QS 14  
W
Wonderland ...................................................................QS 5  
X
U
Transmitting PC Numbers ............................................. 116  
QS **” refers to the page number in Quick Start.  
1 9 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In fo rm a tio n  
When you need repair service, call your nearest Roland Service Center or authorized Roland distributor in your country as  
shown below.  
PAN AMA  
ITALY  
ISRAEL  
SIN GAPO RE  
AFRICA  
SUPRO MUNDIAL, S.A.  
Boulevard Andrews, Albrook,  
Panama City, REP. DE PANAMA  
TEL: 315-0101  
Roland Italy S. p. A.  
Viale delle Industrie 8,  
20020 Arese, Milano, ITALY  
TEL: (02) 937-78300  
Halilit P. Greenspoon &  
Swee Lee Company  
150 Sims Drive,  
Sons Ltd.  
SINGAPORE 387381  
TEL: 6846-3676  
8 Retzif Ha'aliya Hashnya St.  
Tel-Aviv-Yafo ISRAEL  
TEL: (03) 6823666  
EGYPT  
Al Fanny Trading Office  
9, EBN Hagar A1 Askalany Street,  
ARD E1 Golf, Heliopolis,  
Cairo 11341, EGYPT  
CRISTOFORI MUSIC PTE  
LTD  
Blk 3014, Bedok Industrial Park E,  
#02-2148, SINGAPORE 489980  
TEL: 6243-9555  
N O RW AY  
Roland Scandinavia Avd.  
Kontor Norge  
Lilleakerveien 2 Postboks 95  
Lilleaker N-0216 Oslo  
NORWAY  
PARAGUAY  
Distribuidora De  
Instrumentos Musicales  
J.E. Olear y ESQ. Manduvira  
Asuncion PARAGUAY  
TEL: (021) 492-124  
JO RDAN  
AMMAN Trading Agency  
245 Prince Mohammad St.,  
Amman 1118, JORDAN  
TEL: (06) 464-1200  
TEL: 20-2-417-1828  
REUN IO N  
Maison FO - YAM Marcel  
25 Rue Jules Hermann,  
Chaudron - BP79 97 491  
Ste Clotilde Cedex,  
TAIW AN  
ROLAND TAIWAN  
ENTERPRISE CO., LTD.  
Room 5, 9fl. No. 112 Chung Shan  
N.Road Sec.2, Taipei, TAIWAN,  
R.O.C.  
TEL: 2273 0074  
KUW AIT  
Easa Husain Al Yousifi Est.  
Abdullah Salem Street,  
Safat, KUWAIT  
PO LAN D  
P. P. H. Brzostowicz  
UL. Gibraltarska 4.  
PL-03664 Warszawa POLAND  
TEL: (022) 679 44 19  
URUGUAY  
Todo Musica S.A.  
Francisco Acuna de Figueroa 1771  
C.P.: 11.800  
Montevideo, URUGUAY  
TEL: (02) 924-2335  
REUNION ISLAND  
TEL: (0262) 218-429  
TEL: 243-6399  
TEL: (02) 2561 3339  
SO UTH AFRICA  
That Other Music Shop  
(PTY) Ltd.  
11 Melle St., Braamfontein,  
Johannesbourg, SOUTH AFRICA  
LEBAN O N  
Chahine S.A.L.  
Gerge Zeidan St., Chahine Bldg.,  
Achrafieh, P.O.Box: 16-5857  
Beirut, LEBANON  
PO RTUGAL  
THAILAN D  
VEN EZUELA  
Tecnologias Musica e Audio,  
Roland Portugal, S.A.  
Cais Das Pedras, 8/ 9-1 Dto  
4050-465 PORTO  
Theera Music Co. , Ltd.  
330 Verng NakornKasem, Soi 2,  
Bangkok 10100, THAILAND  
TEL: (02) 2248821  
Musicland Digital C.A.  
Av. Francisco de Miranda,  
Centro Parque de Cristal, Nivel  
C2 Local 20 Caracas  
TEL: (01) 20-1441  
P.O.Box 32918, Braamfontein 2017  
Johannesbourg, SOUTH AFRICA  
TEL: (011) 403 4105  
PORTUGAL  
TEL: (022) 608 00 60  
Q ATAR  
Al Emadi Co. (Badie Studio  
& Stores)  
P.O. Box 62,  
Doha, QATAR  
TEL: 4423-554  
VENEZUELA  
TEL: (212) 285-8586  
VIETN AM  
Saigon Music  
138 Tran Quang Khai St.,  
District 1  
Ho Chi Minh City  
VIETNAM  
TEL: (08) 844-4068  
Paul Bothner (PTY) Ltd.  
17 Werdmuller Centre,  
Main Road, Claremont 7708  
SOUTH AFRICA  
RO MAN IA  
FBS LINES  
Piata Libertatii 1,  
RO-4200 Gheorghehi  
TEL: (095) 169-5043  
EURO PE  
P.O.BOX 23032, Claremont 7735,  
SOUTH AFRICA  
TEL: (021) 674 4030  
AUSTRIA  
Roland Austria GES.M.B.H.  
Siemensstrasse 4, P.O. Box 74,  
A-6063 RUM, AUSTRIA  
SAUDI ARABIA  
aDawliah Universal  
Electronics APL  
Corniche Road, Aldossary Bldg.,  
1st Floor, Alkhobar,  
SAUDI ARABIA  
RUSSIA  
MuTek  
3-Bogatyrskaya Str. 1.k.l  
107 564 Moscow, RUSSIA  
TEL: (095) 169 5043  
AUSTRALIA/  
N EW ZEALAN D  
TEL: (0512) 26 44 260  
ASIA  
AUSTRALIA  
BELGIUM/ HOLLAND/  
LUXEMBO URG  
Roland Benelux N. V.  
Houtstraat 3, B-2260, Oevel  
(Westerlo) BELGIUM  
TEL: (014) 575811  
CHIN A  
Roland Shanghai Electronics  
Co.,Ltd.  
5F. No.1500 Pingliang Road  
Shanghai, CHINA  
TEL: (021) 5580-0800  
SPAIN  
Roland Electronics  
de España, S. A.  
Calle Bolivia 239, 08020  
Barcelona, SPAIN  
Roland Corporation  
Australia Pty., Ltd.  
38 Campbell Avenue  
Dee Why West. NSW 2099  
AUSTRALIA  
P.O.Box 2154, Alkhobar 31952  
SAUDI ARABIA  
TEL: (03) 898 2081  
SYRIA  
Technical Light & Sound  
TEL: (93) 308 1000  
TEL: (02) 9982 8266  
Center  
DEN MARK  
SW EDEN  
Roland Shanghai Electronics  
Co.,Ltd.  
(BEIJING OFFICE)  
10F. No.18 Anhuaxili  
Chaoyang District, Beijing,  
CHINA  
Khaled Ebn Al Walid St.  
Bldg. No. 47, P.O.BOX 13520,  
Damascus, SYRIA  
TEL: (011) 223-5384  
N EW ZEALAN D  
Roland Scandinavia A/S  
Nordhavnsvej 7, Postbox 880,  
DK-2100 Copenhagen  
DENMARK  
Roland Scandinavia A/S  
SWEDISH SALES OFFICE  
Danvik Center 28, 2 tr.  
S-131 30 Nacka SWEDEN  
TEL: (0)8 702 00 20  
Roland Corporation Ltd.  
32 Shaddock Street, Mount Eden,  
Auckland, NEW ZEALAND  
TEL: (09) 3098 715  
TEL: 3916 6200  
TURKEY  
Barkat muzik aletleri ithalat  
ve ihracat Ltd Sti  
Siraselviler Caddesi Siraselviler  
Pasaji No:74/ 20  
TEL: (010) 6426-5050  
FRAN CE  
Roland France SA  
4, Rue Paul Henri SPAAK,  
Parc de l'Esplanade, F 77 462 St.  
Thibault, Lagny Cedex FRANCE  
TEL: 01 600 73 500  
CEN TRAL/ LATIN  
AMERICA  
SW ITZERLAN D  
Roland (Switzerland) AG  
Landstrasse 5, Postfach,  
CH-4452 Itingen,  
SWITZERLAND  
TEL: (061) 927-8383  
HO N G KO N G  
Tom Lee Music Co., Ltd.  
Service Division  
22-32 Pun Shan Street, Tsuen  
Wan, New Territories,  
HONG KONG  
Taksim - Istanbul, TURKEY  
TEL: (0212) 2499324  
ARGEN TIN A  
Instrumentos Musicales S.A.  
Av.Santa Fe 2055  
(1123) Buenos Aires  
ARGENTINA  
TEL: (011) 4508-2700  
U.A.E.  
Zak Electronics & Musical  
Instruments Co. L.L.C.  
Zabeel Road, Al Sherooq Bldg.,  
No. 14, Grand Floor, Dubai, U.A.E.  
TEL: (04) 3360715  
FIN LAN D  
Roland Scandinavia As,  
Filial Finland  
Elannontie 5  
FIN-01510 Vantaa, FINLAND  
TEL: (0)9 68 24 020  
UKRAIN E  
TEL: 2415 0911  
TIC-TAC  
Mira Str. 19/ 108  
IN DIA  
P.O. Box 180  
295400 Munkachevo, UKRAINE  
TEL: (03131) 414-40  
Rivera Digitec (India) Pvt. Ltd.  
409, Nirman Kendra Mahalaxmi  
Flats Compound Off. Dr. Edwin  
Moses Road, Mumbai-400011,  
INDIA  
BRAZIL  
Roland Brasil Ltda  
Rua San Jose, 780 Sala B  
Parque Industrial San Jose  
Cotia - Sao Paulo - SP, BRAZIL  
TEL: (011) 4615 5666  
GERMAN Y  
Roland Elektronische  
Musikinstrumente HmbH.  
Oststrasse 96, 22844 Norderstedt,  
GERMANY  
UN ITED KIN GDO M  
N O RTH AMERICA  
Roland (U.K.) Ltd.  
Atlantic Close, Swansea  
Enterprise Park, SWANSEA  
SA7 9FJ,  
TEL: (022) 2493 9051  
IN DO N ESIA  
PT Citra IntiRama  
J1. Cideng Timur No. 15J-150  
Jakarta Pusat  
INDONESIA  
TEL: (021) 6324170  
CAN ADA  
Roland Canada Music Ltd.  
(Head Office)  
5480 Parkwood Way Richmond  
B. C., V6V 2M4 CANADA  
TEL: (604) 270 6626  
CO STA RICA  
JUAN Bansbach  
Instrumentos Musicales  
Ave.1. Calle 11, Apartado 10237,  
San Jose, COSTA RICA  
TEL: 258-0211  
TEL: (040) 52 60090  
UNITED KINGDOM  
TEL: (01792) 702701  
GREECE  
STOLLAS S.A.  
Music Sound Light  
155, New National Road  
Patras 26442, GREECE  
TEL: 2610 435400  
MIDDLE EAST  
KO REA  
Roland Canada Music Ltd.  
Cosmos Corporation  
1461-9, Seocho-Dong,  
Seocho Ku, Seoul, KOREA  
TEL: (02) 3486-8855  
CHILE  
Comercial Fancy S.A.  
Rut.: 96.919.420-1  
Nataniel Cox #739, 4th Floor  
Santiago - Centro, CHILE  
TEL: (02) 688-9540  
(Toronto Office)  
170 Admiral Boulevard  
Mississauga On L5T 2N6  
CANADA  
BAHRAIN  
Moon Stores  
No.16, Bab Al Bahrain Avenue,  
P.O.Box 247, Manama 304,  
State of BAHRAIN  
HUN GARY  
Roland East Europe Ltd.  
Warehouse Area DEPO’ Pf.83  
H-2046 Torokbalint, HUNGARY  
TEL: (23) 511011  
TEL: (905) 362 9707  
MALAYSIA  
BENTLEY MUSIC SDN BHD  
140 & 142, Jalan Bukit Bintang  
55100 Kuala Lumpur,MALAYSIA  
TEL: (03) 2144-3333  
TEL: 211 005  
U. S. A.  
EL SALVADO R  
Roland Corporation U.S.  
5100 S. Eastern Avenue  
Los Angeles, CA 90040-2938,  
U. S. A.  
CYPRUS  
Radex Sound Equipment Ltd.  
17, Diagorou Street, Nicosia,  
CYPRUS  
OMNI MUSIC  
IRELAN D  
Roland Ireland  
Audio House, Belmont Court,  
Donnybrook, Dublin 4.  
Republic of IRELAND  
TEL: (01) 2603501  
75 Avenida Norte y Final  
Alameda Juan Pablo  
,
PHILIPPIN ES  
Edificio No.4010 San Salvador,  
EL SALVADOR  
TEL: 262-0788  
TEL: (323) 890 3700  
G.A. Yupangco & Co. Inc.  
339 Gil J. Puyat Avenue  
Makati, Metro Manila 1200,  
PHILIPPINES  
TEL: (022) 66-9426  
IRAN  
MOCO, INC.  
No.41 Nike St., Dr.Shariyati Ave.,  
Roberoye Cerahe Mirdamad  
Tehran, IRAN  
MEXICO  
TEL: (02) 899 9801  
Casa Veerkamp, s.a. de c.v.  
Av. Toluca No. 323, Col. Olivar  
de los Padres 01780 Mexico D.F.  
MEXICO  
TEL: (021) 285-4169  
As of April 1, 2003 (Roland)  
TEL: (55) 5668-6699  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For EU Countries  
This product complies with the requirements of European Directives EMC 89/336/EEC and LVD 73/23/EEC.  
For the USA  
FEDERAL COMMUNICATIONS COMMISSION  
RADIO FREQUENCY INTERFERENCE STATEMENT  
This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential  
installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in  
accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee  
that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or  
television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the  
interference by one or more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.  
Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and  
(2) This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
Unauthorized changes or modification to this system can void the users authority to operate this equipment.  
This equipment requires shielded interface cables in order to meet FCC class B Limit.  
For Canada  
NOTICE  
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment Regulations.  
AVIS  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement sur le matériel brouilleur du Canada.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
Name  
No.  
1
Qty.  
Instrument  
Manual Set  
AC Cord Set  
1
1
1
1
2
3
4
Collection of Printed Music  
3
2
1
4
This owner’s manual is printed on recycled paper.  
02904667  
’03-5-7N  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

QSC Audio Stereo Amplifier M PL 60PFC User Guide
Radio Shack Stereo Amplifier 04A01 User Guide
Regent Sheffield Home Theater System HT 5OO User Guide
Renesas Computer Hardware H8S 2345 Series User Guide
RoyalTek GPS Receiver RN1 User Guide
Ryobi Blower RY28000 User Guide
Salem Baking Company Kitchen Grill 252801 User Guide
Sanyo Flat Panel Television DP26648 User Guide
Sears Water Heater 15331036 User Guide
Seiko Watch Y182 User Guide